]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - etc/NEWS
Adjust to new names for x-(lost|sent)-selection-functions.
[gnu-emacs] / etc / NEWS
1 GNU Emacs NEWS -- history of user-visible changes. 2003-05-21
2 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 See the end for copying conditions.
4
5 Please send Emacs bug reports to bug-gnu-emacs@gnu.org.
6 For older news, see the file ONEWS
7 You can narrow news to the specific version by calling
8 `view-emacs-news' with a prefix argument or by typing C-u C-h C-n.
9
10 Temporary note:
11 +++ indicates that the appropriate manual has already been updated.
12 --- means no change in the manuals is called for.
13 When you add a new item, please add it without either +++ or ---
14 so we will look at it and add it to the manual.
15
16 \f
17 * Installation Changes in Emacs 21.4
18
19 ** Emacs includes now support for loading image libraries on demand.
20 (Currently this feature is only used on MS Windows.) You can configure
21 the supported image types and their associated dynamic libraries by
22 setting the variable `image-library-alist'.
23
24 ---
25 ** New translations of the Emacs Tutorial are available in the following
26 languages: Brasilian, Bulgarian, Chinese (both with simplified and
27 traditional characters), French, and Italian. Type `C-u C-h t' to
28 choose one of them in case your language setup doesn't automatically
29 select the right one.
30
31 ** You can build Emacs with Gtk+ widgets by specifying `--with-x-toolkit=gtk'
32 when you run configure. This requires Gtk+ 2.0 or newer. This port
33 provides a way to display multilingual text in menus (with some caveats).
34
35 ---
36 ** Emacs can now be built without sound support.
37
38 ** The `emacsserver' program has been removed, replaced with elisp code.
39
40 ---
41 ** Emacs now supports new configure options `--program-prefix',
42 `--program-suffix' and `--program-transform-name' that affect the names of
43 installed programs.
44
45 ---
46 ** By default, Emacs now uses a setgid helper program to update game
47 scores. The directory ${localstatedir}/games/emacs is the normal
48 place for game scores to be stored. This may be controlled by the
49 configure option `--with-game-dir'. The specific user that Emacs uses
50 to own the game scores is controlled by `--with-game-user'. If access
51 to a game user is not available, then scores will be stored separately
52 in each user's home directory.
53
54 ---
55 ** Leim is now part of the Emacs distribution.
56 You no longer need to download a separate tarball in order to build
57 Emacs with Leim.
58
59 +++
60 ** The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual is now part of the distribution.
61
62 The ELisp reference manual in Info format is built as part of the
63 Emacs build procedure and installed together with the Emacs User
64 Manual. A menu item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy
65 accessible (Help->More Manuals->Emacs Lisp Reference).
66
67 ---
68 ** The Introduction to Programming in Emacs Lisp manual is now part of
69 the distribution.
70
71 This manual is now part of the standard distribution and is installed,
72 together with the Emacs User Manual, into the Info directory. A menu
73 item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy accessible
74 (Help->More Manuals->Introduction to Emacs Lisp).
75
76 ** Support for Cygwin was added.
77
78 ---
79 ** Support for FreeBSD/Alpha has been added.
80
81 ---
82 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on S390 machines was added.
83
84 ---
85 ** Support for MacOS X was added.
86 See the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
87
88 ---
89 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on X86-64 machines was added.
90
91 ---
92 ** A French translation of the `Emacs Survival Guide' is available.
93
94 ---
95 ** Building with -DENABLE_CHECKING does not automatically build with union
96 types any more. Add -DUSE_LISP_UNION_TYPE if you want union types.
97
98 \f
99 * Changes in Emacs 21.4
100
101 +++
102 ** `set-auto-mode' now gives the interpreter magic line (if present)
103 precedence over the file name. Likewise an <?xml or <!DOCTYPE declaration
104 will give the buffer XML or SGML mode, unless the file name leads to a mode in
105 `xml-based-modes'.
106
107 +++
108 ** New function `looking-back' checks whether a regular expression matches
109 the text before point. Specifying the LIMIT argument bounds how far
110 back the match can start; this is a way to keep it from taking too long.
111
112 +++
113 ** New functions `make-progress-reporter', `progress-reporter-update',
114 `progress-reporter-force-update' and `progress-reporter-done' provide
115 a simple and efficient way of printing progress messages to the user.
116
117 +++
118 ** In Enriched mode, `set-left-margin' and `set-right-margin' are now
119 by default bound to `C-c [' and `C-c ]' instead of the former `C-c C-l'
120 and `C-c C-r'.
121
122 +++
123 ** In processing a local variables list, Emacs strips the prefix and
124 suffix are from every line before processing all the lines.
125
126 +++
127 ** `apply-macro-to-region-lines' now operates on all lines that begin
128 in the region, rather than on all complete lines in the region.
129
130 ** global-whitespace-mode is a new alias for whitespace-global-mode.
131
132 +++
133 ** There are now two new regular expression operators, \_< and \_>,
134 for matching the beginning and end of a symbol. A symbol is a
135 non-empty sequence of either word or symbol constituent characters, as
136 specified by the syntax table.
137
138 ** Passing resources on the command line now works on MS Windows.
139 You can use --xrm to pass resource settings to Emacs, overriding any
140 existing values. For example:
141
142 emacs --xrm "Emacs.Background:red" --xrm "Emacs.Geometry:100x20"
143
144 will start up Emacs on an initial frame of 100x20 with red background,
145 irrespective of geometry or background setting on the Windows registry.
146
147 ** New features in evaluation commands
148
149 +++
150 *** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) called on defface reinitializes
151 the face to the value specified in the defface expression.
152
153 *** Typing C-x C-e twice prints the value of the integer result
154 in additional formats (octal, hexadecimal, character) specified
155 by the new function `eval-expression-print-format'. The same
156 function also defines the result format for `eval-expression' (M-:),
157 `eval-print-last-sexp' (C-j) and some edebug evaluation functions.
158
159 ** New input method chinese-sisheng for inputting Chinese Pinyin
160 characters.
161
162 ** New command quail-show-key shows what key (or key sequence) to type
163 in the current input method to input a character at point.
164
165 ** Convenient commands to switch buffers in a cyclic order are C-x <left>
166 (prev-buffer) and C-x <right> (next-buffer).
167
168 ** Commands winner-redo and winner-undo, from winner.el, are now bound to
169 C-c <left> and C-c <right>, respectively. This is an incompatible change.
170
171 ** Help commands `describe-function' and `describe-key' now show function
172 arguments in lowercase italics on displays that support it. To change the
173 default, customize face `help-argument-name' or redefine the function
174 `help-default-arg-highlight'.
175
176 ---
177 ** The comint prompt can now be made read-only, using the new user
178 option `comint-prompt-read-only'. This is not enabled by default,
179 except in IELM buffers. The read-only status of IELM prompts can be
180 controlled with the new user option `ielm-prompt-read-only', which
181 overrides `comint-prompt-read-only'.
182
183 The new commands `comint-kill-whole-line' and `comint-kill-region'
184 support editing comint buffers with read-only prompts.
185
186 `comint-kill-whole-line' is like `kill-whole-line', but ignores both
187 read-only and field properties. Hence, it always kill entire
188 lines, including any prompts.
189
190 `comint-kill-region' is like `kill-region', except that it ignores
191 read-only properties, if it is safe to do so. This means that if any
192 part of a prompt is deleted, then the entire prompt must be deleted
193 and that all prompts must stay at the beginning of a line. If this is
194 not the case, then `comint-kill-region' behaves just like
195 `kill-region' if read-only are involved: it copies the text to the
196 kill-ring, but does not delete it.
197
198 ** You can now use next-error (C-x `) and previous-error to advance to
199 the next/previous matching line found by M-x occur.
200
201 ** Telnet now prompts you for a port number with C-u M-x telnet.
202
203 +++
204 ** New command line option -Q.
205
206 This is like using -q --no-site-file, but in addition it also disables
207 the menu-bar, the tool-bar, the scroll-bars, tool tips, the blinking
208 cursor, and the fancy startup screen.
209
210 ** C-h v and C-h f commands now include a hyperlink to the C source for
211 variables and functions defined in C (if the C source is available).
212
213 ** When used interactively, `format-write-file' now asks for confirmation
214 before overwriting an existing file, unless a prefix argument is
215 supplied. This behavior is analogous to `write-file'.
216
217 ** You can now use Auto Revert mode to `tail' a file.
218 If point is at the end of a file buffer before reverting, Auto Revert
219 mode keeps it at the end after reverting. Similarly if point is
220 displayed at the end of a file buffer in any window, it stays at
221 the end of the buffer in that window. This allows to tail a file:
222 just put point at the end of the buffer and it stays there. This
223 rule applies to file buffers. For non-file buffers, the behavior may
224 be mode dependent.
225
226 If you are sure that the file will only change by growing at the end,
227 then you can tail the file more efficiently by using the new minor
228 mode Auto Revert Tail mode. The function `auto-revert-tail-mode'
229 toggles this mode.
230
231 ** Auto Revert mode is now more careful to avoid excessive reverts and
232 other potential problems when deciding which non-file buffers to
233 revert. This matters especially if Global Auto Revert mode is enabled
234 and `global-auto-revert-non-file-buffers' is non-nil. Auto Revert
235 mode only reverts a non-file buffer if the buffer has a non-nil
236 `revert-buffer-function' and a non-nil `buffer-stale-function', which
237 decides whether the buffer should be reverted. Currently, this means
238 that auto reverting works for Dired buffers (although this may not
239 work properly on all operating systems) and for the Buffer Menu.
240
241 ** If the new user option `auto-revert-check-vc-info' is non-nil, Auto
242 Revert mode reliably updates version control info (such as the version
243 control number in the mode line), in all version controlled buffers in
244 which it is active. If the option is nil, the default, then this info
245 only gets updated whenever the buffer gets reverted.
246
247 ** New command `Buffer-menu-toggle-files-only' toggles display of file
248 buffers only in the Buffer Menu. It is bound to `T' in Buffer Menu
249 mode.
250
251 ** M-x compile has become more robust and reliable
252
253 Quite a few more kinds of messages are recognized. Messages that are
254 recognized as warnings or informational come in orange or green, instead of
255 red. Informational messages are by default skipped with `next-error'
256 (controlled by `compilation-skip-threshold').
257
258 Location data is collected on the fly as the *compilation* buffer changes.
259 This means you could modify messages to make them point to different files.
260 This also means you can not go to locations of messages you may have deleted.
261
262 The variable `compilation-error-regexp-alist' has now become customizable. If
263 you had added your own regexps to this, you'll probably need to include a
264 leading `^', otherwise they'll match anywhere on a line. There is now also a
265 `compilation-mode-font-lock-keywords' and it nicely handles all the checks
266 that configure outputs and -o options so you see at a glance where you are.
267
268 The new file etc/compilation.txt gives examples of each type of message.
269
270 ** Compilation mode enhancements:
271
272 +++
273 *** New user option `compilation-environment'.
274 This option allows you to specify environment variables for inferior
275 compilation processes without affecting the environment that all
276 subprocesses inherit.
277
278 ** Grep has been decoupled from compilation mode setup.
279
280 *** There's a new separate package grep.el.
281
282 *** M-x grep has been adapted to new compile
283
284 Hits are fontified in green, and hits in binary files in orange. Grep buffers
285 can be saved and automatically revisited with the new Grep mode.
286
287 *** Grep commands now have their own submenu and customization group.
288
289 *** The new variables `grep-window-height', `grep-auto-highlight', and
290 `grep-scroll-output' can be used to override the corresponding
291 compilation mode settings for grep commands.
292
293 *** New option `grep-highlight-matches' highlightes matches in *grep*
294 buffer. It uses a special feature of some grep programs which accept
295 --color option to output markers around matches. When going to the next
296 match with `next-error' the exact match is highlighted in the source
297 buffer. Otherwise, if `grep-highlight-matches' is nil, the whole
298 source line is highlighted.
299
300 *** New key bindings in grep output window:
301 SPC and DEL scrolls window up and down. C-n and C-p moves to next and
302 previous match in the grep window. RET jumps to the source line of
303 the current match. `n' and `p' shows next and previous match in
304 other window, but does not switch buffer. `{' and `}' jumps to the
305 previous or next file in the grep output. TAB also jumps to the next
306 file.
307
308 ** New options `next-error-highlight' and `next-error-highlight-no-select'
309 specify the method of highlighting of the corresponding source line
310 in new face `next-error'.
311
312 ** A new minor mode `next-error-follow-minor-mode' can be used in
313 compilation-mode, grep-mode, occur-mode, and diff-mode (i.e. all the
314 modes that can use `next-error'). In this mode, cursor motion in the
315 buffer causes automatic display in another window of the corresponding
316 matches, compilation errors, etc. This minor mode can be toggled with
317 C-c C-f.
318
319 ** M-x diff uses diff-mode instead of compilation-mode.
320
321 ** M-x compare-windows now can automatically skip non-matching text to
322 resync points in both windows.
323
324 ** New command `strokes-global-set-stroke-string'.
325 This is like `strokes-global-set-stroke', but it allows you to bind
326 the stroke directly to a string to insert. This is convenient for
327 using strokes as an input method.
328
329 ** Gnus package
330
331 *** Gnus now includes Sieve and PGG
332 Sieve is a library for managing Sieve scripts. PGG is a library to handle
333 PGP/MIME.
334
335 *** There are many news features, bug fixes and improvements.
336 See the file GNUS-NEWS or the node "Oort Gnus" in the Gnus manual for details.
337
338 +++
339 ** Desktop package
340
341 *** Desktop saving is now a minor mode, desktop-save-mode. Variable
342 desktop-enable is obsolete. Customize desktop-save-mode to enable desktop
343 saving.
344
345 *** Buffers are saved in the desktop file in the same order as that in the
346 buffer list.
347
348 *** New commands:
349 - desktop-revert reverts to the last loaded desktop.
350 - desktop-change-dir kills current desktop and loads a new.
351 - desktop-save-in-desktop-dir saves desktop in the directory from which
352 it was loaded.
353
354 *** New customizable variables:
355 - desktop-save. Determins whether the desktop should be saved when it is
356 killed.
357 - desktop-file-name-format.
358 - desktop-path. List of directories in which to lookup the desktop file.
359 - desktop-locals-to-save.
360 - desktop-globals-to-clear.
361 - desktop-clear-preserve-buffers-regexp.
362
363 *** New command line option --no-desktop
364
365 *** New hooks:
366 - desktop-after-read-hook run after a desktop is loaded.
367 - desktop-no-desktop-file-hook run when no desktop file is found.
368
369 ---
370 ** The saveplace.el package now filters out unreadable files.
371 When you exit Emacs, the saved positions in visited files no longer
372 include files that aren't readable, e.g. files that don't exist.
373 Customize the new option `save-place-forget-unreadable-files' to nil
374 to get the old behavior. The new options `save-place-save-skipped'
375 and `save-place-skip-check-regexp' allow further fine-tuning of this
376 feature.
377
378 ** You can have several Emacs servers on the same machine.
379
380 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "foo")' -f server-start &
381 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "bar")' -f server-start &
382 % emacsclient -s foo file1
383 % emacsclient -s bar file2
384
385 +++
386 ** On window systems, lines which are exactly as wide as the window
387 (not counting the final newline character) are no longer broken into
388 two lines on the display (with just the newline on the second line).
389 Instead, the newline now "overflows" into the right fringe, and the
390 cursor will be displayed in the fringe when positioned on that newline.
391
392 The new user option 'overflow-newline-into-fringe' may be set to nil to
393 revert to the old behaviour of continuing such lines.
394
395 +++
396 ** The buffer boundaries (i.e. first and last line in the buffer) may
397 now be marked with angle bitmaps in the fringes. In addition, up and
398 down arrow bitmaps may be shown at the top and bottom of the left or
399 right fringe if the window can be scrolled in either direction.
400
401 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
402 `indicate-buffer-boundaries' to a non-nil value. The default value of
403 this variable is found in `default-indicate-buffer-boundaries'.
404
405 If value is `left' or `right', both angle and arrow bitmaps are
406 displayed in the left or right fringe, resp.
407
408 Value may also be an alist which specifies the presense and position
409 of each bitmap individually.
410
411 For example, ((top . left) (t . right)) places the top angle bitmap
412 in left fringe, the bottom angle bitmap in right fringe, and both
413 arrow bitmaps in right fringe. To show just the angle bitmaps in the
414 left fringe, but no arrow bitmaps, use ((top . left) (bottom . left)).
415
416 ** New command `display-local-help' displays any local help at point
417 in the echo area. It is bound to `C-h .'. It normally displays the
418 same string that would be displayed on mouse-over using the
419 `help-echo' property, but, in certain cases, it can display a more
420 keyboard oriented alternative.
421
422 ** New user option `help-at-pt-display-when-idle' allows to
423 automatically show the help provided by `display-local-help' on
424 point-over, after suitable idle time. The amount of idle time is
425 determined by the user option `help-at-pt-timer-delay' and defaults
426 to one second. This feature is turned off by default.
427
428 ** New commands `scan-buf-next-region' and `scan-buf-previous-region'
429 move to the start of the next (previous, respectively) region with
430 non-nil help-echo property and display any help found there in the
431 echo area, using `display-local-help'.
432
433 +++
434 ** Help mode now only makes hyperlinks for faces when the face name is
435 preceded or followed by the word `face'. It no longer makes
436 hyperlinks for variables without variable documentation, unless
437 preceded by one of the words `variable' or `option'. It now makes
438 hyperlinks to Info anchors (or nodes) if the anchor (or node) name is
439 enclosed in single quotes and preceded by `info anchor' or `Info
440 anchor' (in addition to earlier `info node' and `Info node').
441
442 ** The max size of buffers and integers has been doubled.
443 On 32bit machines, it is now 256M (i.e. 268435455).
444
445 +++
446 ** The -f option, used from the command line to call a function,
447 now reads arguments for the function interactively if it is
448 an interactively callable function.
449
450
451 ** sql changes.
452
453 *** The variable `sql-product' controls the highlightng of different
454 SQL dialects. This variable can be set globally via Customize, on a
455 buffer-specific basis via local variable settings, or for the current
456 session using the new SQL->Product submenu. (This menu replaces the
457 SQL->Highlighting submenu.)
458
459 The following values are supported:
460
461 ansi ANSI Standard (default)
462 db2 DB2
463 informix Informix
464 ingres Ingres
465 interbase Interbase
466 linter Linter
467 ms Microsoft
468 mysql MySQL
469 oracle Oracle
470 postgres Postgres
471 solid Solid
472 sqlite SQLite
473 sybase Sybase
474
475 The current product name will be shown on the mode line following the
476 SQL mode indicator.
477
478 The technique of setting `sql-mode-font-lock-defaults' directly in
479 your .emacs will no longer establish the default highlighting -- Use
480 `sql-product' to accomplish this.
481
482 ANSI keywords are always highlighted.
483
484 *** The function `sql-add-product-keywords' can be used to add
485 font-lock rules to the product specific rules. For example, to have
486 all identifiers ending in "_t" under MS SQLServer treated as a type,
487 you would use the following line in your .emacs file:
488
489 (sql-add-product-keywords 'ms
490 '(("\\<\\w+_t\\>" . font-lock-type-face)))
491
492 *** Oracle support includes keyword highlighting for Oracle 9i. Most
493 SQL and PL/SQL keywords are implemented. SQL*Plus commands are
494 highlighted in `font-lock-doc-face'.
495
496 *** Microsoft SQLServer support has been significantly improved.
497 Keyword highlighting for SqlServer 2000 is implemented.
498 sql-interactive-mode defaults to use osql, rather than isql, because
499 osql flushes its error stream more frequently. Thus error messages
500 are displayed when they occur rather than when the session is
501 terminated.
502
503 If the username and password are not provided to `sql-ms', osql is
504 called with the -E command line argument to use the operating system
505 credentials to authenticate the user.
506
507 *** Postgres support is enhanced.
508 Keyword highlighting of Postgres 7.3 is implemented. Prompting for
509 the username and the pgsql `-U' option is added.
510
511 *** MySQL support is enhanced.
512 Keyword higlighting of MySql 4.0 is implemented.
513
514 *** Imenu support has been enhanced to locate tables, views, indexes,
515 packages, procedures, functions, triggers, sequences, rules, and
516 defaults.
517
518 *** Added SQL->Start SQLi Session menu entry which calls the
519 appropriate sql-interactive-mode wrapper for the current setting of
520 `sql-product'.
521
522 ** M-x view-file and commands that use it now avoid interfering
523 with special modes such as Tar mode.
524
525 ** Enhancements to apropos commands:
526
527 *** The apropos commands now accept a list of words to match.
528 When more than one word is specified, at least two of those words must
529 be present for an item to match. Regular expression matching is still
530 available.
531
532 *** The new option `apropos-sort-by-scores' causes the matching items
533 to be sorted according to their score. The score for an item is a
534 number calculated to indicate how well the item matches the words or
535 regular expression that you entered to the apropos command. The best
536 match is listed first, and the calculated score is shown for each
537 matching item.
538
539 +++
540 ** The old bindings C-M-delete and C-M-backspace have been deleted,
541 since there are situations where one or the other will shut down
542 the operating system or your X server.
543
544 ** New minor mode, Visible mode, toggles invisibility in the current buffer.
545 When enabled, it makes all invisible text visible. When disabled, it
546 restores the previous value of `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
547
548 ** New command `kill-whole-line' kills an entire line at once.
549 By default, it is bound to C-S-<backspace>.
550
551 ** New commands to operate on pairs of open and close characters:
552 `insert-pair', `delete-pair', `raise-sexp'.
553
554 ** A prefix argument of C-M-q in Emacs Lisp mode pretty-printifies the
555 list starting after point.
556
557 ** Dired mode:
558
559 *** New faces dired-header, dired-mark, dired-marked, dired-flagged,
560 dired-ignored, dired-directory, dired-symlink, dired-warning
561 introduced for Dired mode instead of font-lock faces.
562
563 *** New Dired command `dired-compare-directories' marks files
564 with different file attributes in two dired buffers.
565
566 +++
567 *** New Dired command `dired-do-touch' (bound to T) changes timestamps
568 of marked files with the value entered in the minibuffer.
569
570 +++
571 *** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
572 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
573 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
574 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
575 doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
576 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
577
578 +++
579 *** Dired's v command now runs external viewers to view certain
580 types of files. The variable `dired-view-command-alist' controls
581 what external viewers to use and when.
582
583 *** In Dired, the w command now copies the current line's file name
584 into the kill ring. With a zero prefix arg, copies absolute file names.
585
586 +++
587 ** Dired-x:
588
589 *** Omitting files is now a minor mode, dired-omit-mode. The mode toggling
590 command is bound to M-o. A new command dired-mark-omitted, bound to M-O,
591 marks omitted files. The variable dired-omit-files-p is obsoleted, use the
592 mode toggling function instead.
593
594 ** Info mode:
595
596 *** A numeric prefix argument of `info' selects an Info buffer
597 with the number appended to the *info* buffer name.
598
599 *** Regexp isearch (C-M-s and C-M-r) can search through multiple nodes.
600 Failed isearch wraps to the top/final node.
601
602 *** New search commands: `Info-search-case-sensitively' (bound to S),
603 `Info-search-backward', and `Info-search-next' which repeats the last
604 search without prompting for a new search string.
605
606 *** New command `Info-history' (bound to L) displays a menu of visited nodes.
607
608 *** New command `Info-toc' (bound to T) creates a node with table of contents
609 from the tree structure of menus of the current Info file.
610
611 *** New command `info-apropos' searches the indices of the known
612 Info files on your system for a string, and builds a menu of the
613 possible matches.
614
615 *** New command `Info-copy-current-node-name' (bound to w) copies
616 the current Info node name into the kill ring. With a zero prefix
617 arg, puts the node name inside the `info' function call.
618
619 *** New face `info-xref-visited' distinguishes visited nodes from unvisited
620 and a new option `Info-fontify-visited-nodes' to control this.
621
622 *** http and ftp links in Info are now operational: they look like cross
623 references and following them calls `browse-url'.
624
625 +++
626 *** Info now hides node names in menus and cross references by default.
627 If you prefer the old behavior, you can set the new user option
628 `Info-hide-note-references' to nil.
629
630 *** Images in Info pages are supported.
631 Info pages show embedded images, in Emacs frames with image support.
632 Info documentation that includes images, processed with makeinfo
633 version 4.7 or newer, compiles to Info pages with embedded images.
634
635 +++
636 *** The default value for `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' is now nil.
637
638 ---
639 *** Info-index offers completion.
640
641 ** Support for the SQLite interpreter has been added to sql.el by calling
642 'sql-sqlite'.
643
644 ** BibTeX mode:
645 *** The new command bibtex-url browses a URL for the BibTeX entry at
646 point (bound to C-c C-l and mouse-2 on clickable fields).
647 *** The new command bibtex-entry-update (bound to C-c C-u) updates
648 an existing BibTeX entry.
649 *** New `bibtex-entry-format' option `required-fields', enabled by default.
650 *** bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries can take values `plain',
651 `crossref', and `entry-class' which control the sorting scheme used
652 for BibTeX entries. `bibtex-sort-entry-class' controls the sorting
653 scheme `entry-class'. TAB completion for reference keys and
654 automatic detection of duplicates does not require anymore that
655 bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries is non-nil.
656
657 *** If the new variable bibtex-parse-keys-fast is non-nil,
658 use fast but simplified algorithm for parsing BibTeX keys.
659
660 *** If the new variable bibtex-autoadd-commas is non-nil,
661 automatically add missing commas at end of BibTeX fields.
662
663 *** The new variable bibtex-autofill-types contains a list of entry
664 types for which fields are filled automatically (if possible).
665
666 *** The new command bibtex-complete completes word fragment before
667 point according to context (bound to M-tab).
668
669 *** The new commands bibtex-find-entry and bibtex-find-crossref
670 locate entries and crossref'd entries.
671
672 *** In BibTeX mode the command fill-paragraph (bound to M-q) fills
673 individual fields of a BibTeX entry.
674
675 ** When display margins are present in a window, the fringes are now
676 displayed between the margins and the buffer's text area, rather than
677 at the edges of the window.
678
679 ** A window may now have individual fringe and scroll-bar settings,
680 in addition to the individual display margin settings.
681
682 Such individual settings are now preserved when windows are split
683 horizontally or vertically, a saved window configuration is restored,
684 or when the frame is resized.
685
686 ** New functions frame-current-scroll-bars and window-current-scroll-bars.
687
688 These functions return the current locations of the vertical and
689 horizontal scroll bars in a frame or window.
690
691 ---
692 ** Emacs now supports drag and drop for X. Dropping a file on a window
693 opens it, dropping text inserts the text. Dropping a file on a dired
694 buffer copies or moves the file to that directory.
695
696 ** Under X, mouse-wheel-mode is turned on by default.
697
698 ** The X resource useXIM can be used to turn off use of XIM, which may
699 speed up Emacs with slow networking to the X server.
700
701 If the configure option `--without-xim' was used to turn off use of
702 XIM by default, the X resource useXIM can be used to turn it on.
703
704 ** `undo-only' does an undo which does not redo any previous undo.
705
706 ** `uniquify-strip-common-suffix' tells uniquify to prefer
707 `file|dir1' and `file|dir2' to `file|dir1/subdir' and `file|dir2/subdir'.
708
709 ** If the user visits a file larger than `large-file-warning-threshold',
710 Emacs prompts her for confirmation.
711
712 ** A UTF-7 coding system is available in the library `utf-7'.
713
714 ** GUD mode has its own tool bar for controlling execution of the inferior
715 and other common debugger commands.
716
717 ** recentf changes.
718
719 The recent file list is now automatically cleanup when recentf mode is
720 enabled. The new option `recentf-auto-cleanup' controls when to do
721 automatic cleanup.
722
723 With the more advanced option: `recentf-filename-handler', you can
724 specify a function that transforms filenames handled by recentf. For
725 example, if set to `file-truename', the same file will not be in the
726 recent list with different symbolic links.
727
728 To follow naming convention, `recentf-keep-non-readable-files-flag'
729 and `recentf-menu-append-commands-flag' respectively replace the
730 misnamed options `recentf-keep-non-readable-files-p' and
731 `recentf-menu-append-commands-p'. The old names remain available as
732 aliases, but have been marked obsolete.
733
734 ** The default for the paper size (variable ps-paper-type) is taken
735 from the locale.
736
737 ** Init file changes
738
739 You can now put the init files .emacs and .emacs_SHELL under
740 ~/.emacs.d or directly under ~. Emacs will find them in either place.
741
742 ** partial-completion-mode now does partial completion on directory names.
743
744 ** skeleton.el now supports using - to mark the skeleton-point without
745 interregion interaction. @ has reverted to only setting
746 skeleton-positions and no longer sets skeleton-point. Skeletons
747 which used @ to mark skeleton-point independent of _ should now use -
748 instead. The updated skeleton-insert docstring explains these new
749 features along with other details of skeleton construction.
750
751 ** MH-E changes.
752
753 Upgraded to MH-E version 7.82. There have been major changes since
754 version 5.0.2; see MH-E-NEWS for details.
755
756 +++
757 ** The `emacsclient' command understands the options `--eval' and
758 `--display' which tell Emacs respectively to evaluate the given elisp
759 expression and to use the given display when visiting files.
760
761 ** User option `server-mode' can be used to start a server process.
762
763 +++
764 ** The mode line position information now comes before the major mode.
765 When the file is maintained under version control, that information
766 appears between the position information and the major mode.
767
768 ** C-x s (save-some-buffers) now offers an option `d' to diff a buffer
769 against its file, so you can see what changes you would be saving.
770
771 +++
772 ** You can now customize the use of window fringes. To control this
773 for all frames, use M-x fringe-mode or the Show/Hide submenu of the
774 top-level Options menu, or customize the `fringe-mode' variable. To
775 control this for a specific frame, use the command M-x
776 set-fringe-style.
777
778 +++
779 ** There is a new user option `mail-default-directory' that allows you
780 to specify the value of `default-directory' for mail buffers. This
781 directory is used for auto-save files of mail buffers. It defaults to
782 "~/".
783
784 +++
785 ** When you are root, and you visit a file whose modes specify
786 read-only, the Emacs buffer is now read-only too. Type C-x C-q if you
787 want to make the buffer writable. (As root, you can in fact alter the
788 file.)
789
790 ** The new command `revert-buffer-with-coding-system' (C-x RET r)
791 revisits the current file using a coding system that you specify.
792
793 ** The new command `recode-file-name' changes the encoding of the name
794 of a file.
795
796 ---
797 ** `ps-print' can now print characters from the mule-unicode charsets.
798
799 Printing text with characters from the mule-unicode-* sets works with
800 ps-print, provided that you have installed the appropriate BDF fonts.
801 See the file INSTALL for URLs where you can find these fonts.
802
803 ---
804 ** The new options `buffers-menu-show-directories' and
805 `buffers-menu-show-status' let you control how buffers are displayed
806 in the menu dropped down when you click "Buffers" from the menu bar.
807
808 `buffers-menu-show-directories' controls whether the menu displays
809 leading directories as part of the file name visited by the buffer.
810 If its value is `unless-uniquify', the default, directories are
811 shown unless uniquify-buffer-name-style' is non-nil. The value of nil
812 and t turn the display of directories off and on, respectively.
813
814 `buffers-menu-show-status' controls whether the Buffers menu includes
815 the modified and read-only status of the buffers. By default it is
816 t, and the status is shown.
817
818 Setting these variables directly does not take effect until next time
819 the Buffers menu is regenerated.
820
821 +++
822 ** The commands M-x customize-face and M-x customize-face-other-window
823 now look at the character after point. If a face or faces are
824 specified for that character, the commands by default customize those
825 faces.
826
827 ** New language environments: French, Ukrainian, Tajik,
828 Bulgarian, Belarusian, Ukrainian, UTF-8, Windows-1255, Welsh, Latin-6,
829 Latin-7, Lithuanian, Latvian, Swedish, Slovenian, Croatian, Georgian,
830 Italian, Russian, Malayalam, Tamil, Russian, Chinese-EUC-TW. (Set up
831 automatically according to the locale.)
832
833 ** Indian support has been updated.
834 The in-is13194 coding system is now Unicode-based. CDAC fonts are
835 assumed. There is a framework for supporting various
836 Indian scripts, but currently only Devanagari, Malayalam and Tamil are
837 supported.
838
839 ---
840 ** New input methods: latin-alt-postfix, latin-postfix, latin-prefix,
841 ukrainian-computer, belarusian, bulgarian-bds, russian-computer,
842 vietnamese-telex, lithuanian-numeric, lithuanian-keyboard,
843 latvian-keyboard, welsh, georgian, rfc1345, ucs, sgml,
844 bulgarian-phonetic, dutch, slovenian, croatian, malayalam-inscript,
845 tamil-inscript.
846
847 ---
848 ** A new coding system `euc-tw' has been added for traditional Chinese
849 in CNS encoding; it accepts both Big 5 and CNS as input; on saving,
850 Big 5 is then converted to CNS.
851
852 ---
853 ** Many new coding systems are available by loading the `code-pages'
854 library. These include complete versions of most of those in
855 codepage.el, based on Unicode mappings. `codepage-setup' is now
856 obsolete and is used only in the MS-DOS port of Emacs. windows-1252
857 and windows-1251 are preloaded since the former is so common and the
858 latter is used by GNU locales.
859
860 ** The utf-8/16 coding systems have been enhanced.
861 By default, untranslatable utf-8 sequences are simply composed into
862 single quasi-characters. User option `utf-translate-cjk-mode' (it is
863 turned on by default) arranges to translate many utf-8 CJK character
864 sequences into real Emacs characters in a similar way to the Mule-UCS
865 system. As this loads a fairly big data on demand, people who are not
866 interested in CJK characters may want to customize it to nil.
867 You can augment/amend the CJK translation via hash tables
868 `ucs-mule-cjk-to-unicode' and `ucs-unicode-to-mule-cjk'. The utf-8
869 coding system now also encodes characters from most of Emacs's
870 one-dimensional internal charsets, specifically the ISO-8859 ones.
871 The utf-16 coding system is affected similarly.
872
873 ** New variable `utf-translate-cjk-unicode-range' controls which
874 Unicode characters to translate in `utf-translate-cjk-mode'.
875
876 ** iso-10646-1 (`Unicode') fonts can be used to display any range of
877 characters encodable by the utf-8 coding system. Just specify the
878 fontset appropriately.
879
880 ** New command `ucs-insert' inserts a character specified by its
881 unicode.
882
883 +++
884 ** Limited support for character `unification' has been added.
885 Emacs now knows how to translate between different representations of
886 the same characters in various Emacs charsets according to standard
887 Unicode mappings. This applies mainly to characters in the ISO 8859
888 sets plus some other 8-bit sets, but can be extended. For instance,
889 translation works amongst the Emacs ...-iso8859-... charsets and the
890 mule-unicode-... ones.
891
892 By default this translation happens automatically on encoding.
893 Self-inserting characters are translated to make the input conformant
894 with the encoding of the buffer in which it's being used, where
895 possible.
896
897 You can force a more complete unification with the user option
898 unify-8859-on-decoding-mode. That maps all the Latin-N character sets
899 into Unicode characters (from the latin-iso8859-1 and
900 mule-unicode-0100-24ff charsets) on decoding. Note that this mode
901 will often effectively clobber data with an iso-2022 encoding.
902
903 ** There is support for decoding Greek and Cyrillic characters into
904 either Unicode (the mule-unicode charsets) or the iso-8859 charsets,
905 when possible. The latter are more space-efficient. This is
906 controlled by user option utf-fragment-on-decoding.
907
908 ** The new command `set-file-name-coding-system' (C-x RET F) sets
909 coding system for encoding and decoding file names. A new menu item
910 (Options->Mule->Set Coding Systems->For File Name) invokes this
911 command.
912
913 ---
914 ** The scrollbar under LessTif or Motif has a smoother drag-scrolling.
915 On the other hand, the size of the thumb does not represent the actual
916 amount of text shown any more (only a crude approximation of it).
917
918 ---
919 ** The pop up menus for Lucid now stay up if you do a fast click and can
920 be navigated with the arrow keys (like Gtk+ and W32).
921
922 ---
923 ** Dialogs for Lucid/Athena and Lesstif/Motif pops down when pressing ESC.
924
925 +++
926 ** The file selection dialog for Gtk+, W32 and Motif/Lesstif can be
927 disabled by customizing the variable `use-file-dialog'.
928
929 +++
930 ** Emacs can produce an underscore-like (horizontal bar) cursor.
931 The underscore cursor is set by putting `(cursor-type . hbar)' in
932 default-frame-alist. It supports variable heights, like the `bar'
933 cursor does.
934
935 +++
936 ** On X, MS Windows, and Mac OS, the blinking cursor's "off" state is
937 now controlled by the variable `blink-cursor-alist'.
938
939 ** Filesets are collections of files. You can define a fileset in
940 various ways, such as based on a directory tree or based on
941 program files that include other program files.
942
943 Once you have defined a fileset, you can perform various operations on
944 all the files in it, such as visiting them or searching and replacing
945 in them.
946
947 ---
948 ** PO translation files are decoded according to their MIME headers
949 when Emacs visits them.
950
951 ---
952 ** The game `mpuz' is enhanced.
953
954 `mpuz' now allows the 2nd factor not to have two identical digits. By
955 default, all trivial operations involving whole lines are performed
956 automatically. The game uses faces for better visual feedback.
957
958 ** The new variable `x-select-request-type' controls how Emacs
959 requests X selection. The default value is nil, which means that
960 Emacs requests X selection with types COMPOUND_TEXT and UTF8_STRING,
961 and use the more appropriately result.
962
963 +++
964 ** The parameters of automatic hscrolling can now be customized.
965 The variable `hscroll-margin' determines how many columns away from
966 the window edge point is allowed to get before automatic hscrolling
967 will horizontally scroll the window. The default value is 5.
968
969 The variable `hscroll-step' determines how many columns automatic
970 hscrolling scrolls the window when point gets too close to the
971 window edge. If its value is zero, the default, Emacs scrolls the
972 window so as to center point. If its value is an integer, it says how
973 many columns to scroll. If the value is a floating-point number, it
974 gives the fraction of the window's width to scroll the window.
975
976 The variable `automatic-hscrolling' was renamed to
977 `auto-hscroll-mode'. The old name is still available as an alias.
978
979 ** TeX modes:
980 *** C-c C-c prompts for a command to run, and tries to offer a good default.
981 +++
982 *** The user option `tex-start-options-string' has been replaced
983 by two new user options: `tex-start-options', which should hold
984 command-line options to feed to TeX, and `tex-start-commands' which should hold
985 TeX commands to use at startup.
986 *** verbatim environments are now highlighted in courier by font-lock
987 and super/sub-scripts are made into super/sub-scripts.
988
989 *** New major mode doctex-mode for *.dtx files.
990
991 +++
992 ** New display feature: focus follows the mouse from one Emacs window
993 to another, even within a frame. If you set the variable
994 mouse-autoselect-window to non-nil value, moving the mouse to a
995 different Emacs window will select that window (minibuffer window can
996 be selected only when it is active). The default is nil, so that this
997 feature is not enabled.
998
999 ** On X, when the window manager requires that you click on a frame to
1000 select it (give it focus), the selected window and cursor position
1001 normally changes according to the mouse click position. If you set
1002 the variable x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position to t, the selected
1003 window and cursor position do not change when you click on a frame
1004 to give it focus.
1005
1006 +++
1007 ** The new command `describe-char' (C-u C-x =) pops up a buffer with
1008 description various information about a character, including its
1009 encodings and syntax, its text properties, how to input, overlays, and
1010 widgets at point. You can get more information about some of them, by
1011 clicking on mouse-sensitive areas or moving there and pressing RET.
1012
1013 +++
1014 ** The new command `multi-occur' is just like `occur', except it can
1015 search multiple buffers. There is also a new command
1016 `multi-occur-by-filename-regexp' which allows you to specify the
1017 buffers to search by their filename. Internally, Occur mode has been
1018 rewritten, and now uses font-lock, among other changes.
1019
1020 ** The default values of paragraph-start and indent-line-function have
1021 been changed to reflect those used in Text mode rather than those used
1022 in Indented-Text mode.
1023
1024 ** New user option `query-replace-skip-read-only': when non-nil,
1025 `query-replace' and related functions simply ignore
1026 a match if part of it has a read-only property.
1027
1028 ** When used interactively, the commands `query-replace-regexp' and
1029 `replace-regexp' allow \,expr to be used in a replacement string,
1030 where expr is an arbitrary Lisp expression evaluated at replacement
1031 time. In many cases, this will be more convenient than using
1032 `query-replace-regexp-eval'. `\#' in a replacement string now refers
1033 to the count of replacements already made by the replacement command.
1034 All regular expression replacement commands now allow `\?' in the
1035 replacement string to specify a position where the replacement string
1036 can be edited for each replacement.
1037
1038 +++
1039 ** Emacs normally highlights mouse sensitive text whenever the mouse
1040 is over the text. By setting the new variable `mouse-highlight', you
1041 can optionally enable mouse highlighting only after you move the
1042 mouse, so that highlighting disappears when you press a key. You can
1043 also disable mouse highlighting.
1044
1045 ** You can now customize if selecting a region by dragging the mouse
1046 shall not copy the selected text to the kill-ring by setting the new
1047 variable mouse-drag-copy-region to nil.
1048
1049 +++
1050 ** font-lock: in modes like C and Lisp where the fontification assumes that
1051 an open-paren in column 0 is always outside of any string or comment,
1052 font-lock now highlights any such open-paren-in-column-zero in bold-red
1053 if it is inside a string or a comment, to indicate that it can cause
1054 trouble with fontification and/or indentation.
1055
1056 +++
1057 ** There's a new face `minibuffer-prompt'.
1058 Emacs adds this face to the list of text properties stored in the
1059 variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', which is used to display the
1060 prompt string.
1061
1062 +++
1063 ** The new face `mode-line-inactive' is used to display the mode line
1064 of non-selected windows. The `mode-line' face is now used to display
1065 the mode line of the currently selected window.
1066
1067 The new variable `mode-line-in-non-selected-windows' controls whether
1068 the `mode-line-inactive' face is used.
1069
1070 ---
1071 ** A menu item "Show/Hide" was added to the top-level menu "Options".
1072 This menu allows you to turn various display features on and off (such
1073 as the fringes, the tool bar, the speedbar, and the menu bar itself).
1074 You can also move the vertical scroll bar to either side here or turn
1075 it off completely. There is also a menu-item to toggle displaying of
1076 current date and time, current line and column number in the
1077 mode-line.
1078
1079 ---
1080 ** Speedbar has moved from the "Tools" top level menu to "Show/Hide".
1081
1082 +++
1083 ** Emacs can now indicate in the mode-line the presence of new e-mail
1084 in a directory or in a file. See the documentation of the user option
1085 `display-time-mail-directory'.
1086
1087 ---
1088 ** LDAP support now defaults to ldapsearch from OpenLDAP version 2.
1089
1090 +++
1091 ** You can now disable pc-selection-mode after enabling it.
1092 M-x pc-selection-mode behaves like a proper minor mode, and with no
1093 argument it toggles the mode.
1094
1095 Turning off PC-Selection mode restores the global key bindings
1096 that were replaced by turning on the mode.
1097
1098 +++
1099 ** Emacs now displays a splash screen by default even if command-line
1100 arguments were given. The new command-line option --no-splash
1101 disables the splash screen; see also the variable
1102 `inhibit-startup-message' (which is also aliased as
1103 `inhibit-splash-screen').
1104
1105 ** Changes in support of colors on character terminals
1106
1107 +++
1108 *** The new command-line option --color=MODE lets you specify a standard
1109 mode for a tty color support. It is meant to be used on character
1110 terminals whose capabilities are not set correctly in the terminal
1111 database, or with terminal emulators which support colors, but don't
1112 set the TERM environment variable to a name of a color-capable
1113 terminal. "emacs --color" uses the same color commands as GNU `ls'
1114 when invoked with "ls --color", so if your terminal can support colors
1115 in "ls --color", it will support "emacs --color" as well. See the
1116 user manual for the possible values of the MODE parameter.
1117
1118 ---
1119 *** Emacs now supports several character terminals which provide more
1120 than 8 colors. For example, for `xterm', 16-color, 88-color, and
1121 256-color modes are supported. Emacs automatically notes at startup
1122 the extended number of colors, and defines the appropriate entries for
1123 all of these colors.
1124
1125 +++
1126 *** Emacs now uses the full range of available colors for the default
1127 faces when running on a color terminal, including 16-, 88-, and
1128 256-color xterms. This means that when you run "emacs -nw" on an
1129 88-color or 256-color xterm, you will see essentially the same face
1130 colors as on X.
1131
1132 ---
1133 *** There's a new support for colors on `rxvt' terminal emulator.
1134
1135 +++
1136 ** Emacs can now be invoked in full-screen mode on a windowed display.
1137
1138 When Emacs is invoked on a window system, the new command-line options
1139 `--fullwidth', `--fullheight', and `--fullscreen' produce a frame
1140 whose width, height, or both width and height take up the entire
1141 screen size. (For now, this does not work with some window managers.)
1142
1143 ---
1144 ** Emacs now tries to set up buffer coding systems for HTML/XML files
1145 automatically.
1146
1147 +++
1148 ** The new command `comint-insert-previous-argument' in comint-derived
1149 modes (shell-mode etc) inserts arguments from previous command lines,
1150 like bash's `ESC .' binding. It is bound by default to `C-c .', but
1151 otherwise behaves quite similarly to the bash version.
1152
1153 +++
1154 ** Changes in C-h bindings:
1155
1156 C-h e displays the *Messages* buffer.
1157
1158 C-h followed by a control character is used for displaying files
1159 that do not change:
1160
1161 C-h C-f displays the FAQ.
1162 C-h C-e displays the PROBLEMS file.
1163
1164 The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
1165 have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
1166
1167 C-h c, C-h k, C-h w, and C-h f now handle remapped interactive commands.
1168
1169 - C-h c and C-h k report the actual command (after possible remapping)
1170 run by the key sequence.
1171
1172 - C-h w and C-h f on a command which has been remapped now report the
1173 command it is remapped to, and the keys which can be used to run
1174 that command.
1175
1176 For example, if C-k is bound to kill-line, and kill-line is remapped
1177 to new-kill-line, these commands now report:
1178
1179 - C-h c and C-h k C-k reports:
1180 C-k runs the command new-kill-line
1181
1182 - C-h w and C-h f kill-line reports:
1183 kill-line is remapped to new-kill-line which is on C-k, <deleteline>
1184
1185 - C-h w and C-h f new-kill-line reports:
1186 new-kill-line is on C-k
1187
1188 +++
1189 ** Vertical scrolling is now possible within incremental search.
1190 To enable this feature, customize the new user option
1191 `isearch-allow-scroll'. User written commands which satisfy stringent
1192 constraints can be marked as "scrolling commands". See the Emacs manual
1193 for details.
1194
1195 +++
1196 ** C-w in incremental search now grabs either a character or a word,
1197 making the decision in a heuristic way. This new job is done by the
1198 command `isearch-yank-word-or-char'. To restore the old behavior,
1199 bind C-w to `isearch-yank-word' in `isearch-mode-map'.
1200
1201 +++
1202 ** C-y in incremental search now grabs the next line if point is already
1203 at the end of a line.
1204
1205 +++
1206 ** C-M-w deletes and C-M-y grabs a character in isearch mode.
1207 Another method to grab a character is to enter the minibuffer by `M-e'
1208 and to type `C-f' at the end of the search string in the minibuffer.
1209
1210 +++
1211 ** M-% typed in isearch mode invokes `query-replace' or
1212 `query-replace-regexp' (depending on search mode) with the current
1213 search string used as the string to replace.
1214
1215 +++
1216 ** Isearch no longer adds `isearch-resume' commands to the command
1217 history by default. To enable this feature, customize the new
1218 user option `isearch-resume-in-command-history'.
1219
1220 +++
1221 ** New user option `history-delete-duplicates'.
1222 If set to t when adding a new history element, all previous identical
1223 elements are deleted.
1224
1225 +++
1226 ** Yanking text now discards certain text properties that can
1227 be inconvenient when you did not expect them. The variable
1228 `yank-excluded-properties' specifies which ones. Insertion
1229 of register contents and rectangles also discards these properties.
1230
1231 +++
1232 ** Occur, Info, and comint-derived modes now support using
1233 M-x font-lock-mode to toggle fontification. The variable
1234 `Info-fontify' is no longer applicable; to disable fontification,
1235 remove `turn-on-font-lock' from `Info-mode-hook'.
1236
1237 +++
1238 ** M-x grep now tries to avoid appending `/dev/null' to the command line
1239 by using GNU grep `-H' option instead. M-x grep automatically
1240 detects whether this is possible or not the first time it is invoked.
1241 When `-H' is used, the grep command line supplied by the user is passed
1242 unchanged to the system to execute, which allows more complicated
1243 command lines to be used than was possible before.
1244
1245 ---
1246 ** The face-customization widget has been reworked to be less confusing.
1247 In particular, when you enable a face attribute using the corresponding
1248 check-box, there's no longer a redundant `*' option in value selection
1249 for that attribute; the values you can choose are only those which make
1250 sense for the attribute. When an attribute is de-selected by unchecking
1251 its check-box, then the (now ignored, but still present temporarily in
1252 case you re-select the attribute) value is hidden.
1253
1254 +++
1255 ** When you set or reset a variable's value in a Customize buffer,
1256 the previous value becomes the "backup value" of the variable.
1257 You can go back to that backup value by selecting "Use Backup Value"
1258 under the "[State]" button.
1259
1260 ** The new customization type `float' specifies numbers with floating
1261 point (no integers are allowed).
1262
1263 +++
1264 ** In GUD mode, when talking to GDB, C-x C-a C-j "jumps" the program
1265 counter to the specified source line (the one where point is).
1266
1267 ---
1268 ** GUD mode improvements for jdb:
1269
1270 *** Search for source files using jdb classpath and class
1271 information. Fast startup since there is no need to scan all
1272 source files up front. There is also no need to create and maintain
1273 lists of source directories to scan. Look at `gud-jdb-use-classpath'
1274 and `gud-jdb-classpath' customization variables documentation.
1275
1276 *** Supports the standard breakpoint (gud-break, gud-clear)
1277 set/clear operations from java source files under the classpath, stack
1278 traversal (gud-up, gud-down), and run until current stack finish
1279 (gud-finish).
1280
1281 *** Supports new jdb (Java 1.2 and later) in addition to oldjdb
1282 (Java 1.1 jdb).
1283
1284 *** The previous method of searching for source files has been
1285 preserved in case someone still wants/needs to use it.
1286 Set gud-jdb-use-classpath to nil.
1287
1288 Added Customization Variables
1289
1290 *** gud-jdb-command-name. What command line to use to invoke jdb.
1291
1292 *** gud-jdb-use-classpath. Allows selection of java source file searching
1293 method: set to t for new method, nil to scan gud-jdb-directories for
1294 java sources (previous method).
1295
1296 *** gud-jdb-directories. List of directories to scan and search for java
1297 classes using the original gud-jdb method (if gud-jdb-use-classpath
1298 is nil).
1299
1300 Minor Improvements
1301
1302 *** The STARTTLS elisp wrapper (starttls.el) can now use GNUTLS
1303 instead of the OpenSSL based "starttls" tool. For backwards
1304 compatibility, it prefers "starttls", but you can toggle
1305 `starttls-use-gnutls' to switch to GNUTLS (or simply remove the
1306 "starttls" tool).
1307
1308 *** Do not allow debugger output history variable to grow without bounds.
1309
1310 +++
1311 ** hide-ifdef-mode now uses overlays rather than selective-display
1312 to hide its text. This should be mostly transparent but slightly
1313 changes the behavior of motion commands like C-e and C-p.
1314
1315 +++
1316 ** Unquoted `$' in file names do not signal an error any more when
1317 the corresponding environment variable does not exist.
1318 Instead, the `$ENVVAR' text is left as is, so that `$$' quoting
1319 is only rarely needed.
1320
1321 ---
1322 ** JIT-lock changes
1323 *** jit-lock can now be delayed with `jit-lock-defer-time'.
1324
1325 If this variable is non-nil, its value should be the amount of Emacs
1326 idle time in seconds to wait before starting fontification. For
1327 example, if you set `jit-lock-defer-time' to 0.25, fontification will
1328 only happen after 0.25s of idle time.
1329
1330 *** contextual refontification is now separate from stealth fontification.
1331
1332 jit-lock-defer-contextually is renamed jit-lock-contextually and
1333 jit-lock-context-time determines the delay after which contextual
1334 refontification takes place.
1335
1336 +++
1337 ** Marking commands extend the region when invoked multiple times. If
1338 you hit M-C-SPC (mark-sexp), M-@ (mark-word), M-h (mark-paragraph), or
1339 C-M-h (mark-defun) repeatedly, the marked region extends each time, so
1340 you can mark the next two sexps with M-C-SPC M-C-SPC, for example.
1341 This feature also works for mark-end-of-sentence, if you bind that to
1342 a key.
1343
1344 +++
1345 ** Some commands do something special in Transient Mark mode when the
1346 mark is active--for instance, they limit their operation to the
1347 region. Even if you don't normally use Transient Mark mode, you might
1348 want to get this behavior from a particular command. There are two
1349 ways you can enable Transient Mark mode and activate the mark, for one
1350 command only.
1351
1352 One method is to type C-SPC C-SPC; this enables Transient Mark mode
1353 and sets the mark at point. The other method is to type C-u C-x C-x.
1354 This enables Transient Mark mode temporarily but does not alter the
1355 mark or the region.
1356
1357 After these commands, Transient Mark mode remains enabled until you
1358 deactivate the mark. That typically happens when you type a command
1359 that alters the buffer, but you can also deactivate the mark by typing
1360 C-g.
1361
1362 +++
1363 ** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
1364 previous mark, i.e. C-u C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the
1365 mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC to set the mark immediately after a jump.
1366
1367 +++
1368 ** In the *Occur* buffer, `o' switches to it in another window, and
1369 C-o displays the current line's occurrence in another window without
1370 switching to it.
1371
1372 +++
1373 ** When you specify a frame size with --geometry, the size applies to
1374 all frames you create. A position specified with --geometry only
1375 affects the initial frame.
1376
1377 +++
1378 ** M-h (mark-paragraph) now accepts a prefix arg.
1379 With positive arg, M-h marks the current and the following paragraphs;
1380 if the arg is negative, it marks the current and the preceding
1381 paragraphs.
1382
1383 +++
1384 ** The variables dired-free-space-program and dired-free-space-args
1385 have been renamed to directory-free-space-program and
1386 directory-free-space-args, and they now apply whenever Emacs puts a
1387 directory listing into a buffer.
1388
1389 ---
1390 ** mouse-wheels can now scroll a specific fraction of the window
1391 (rather than a fixed number of lines) and the scrolling is `progressive'.
1392
1393 ** Unexpected yanking of text due to accidental clicking on the mouse
1394 wheel button (typically mouse-2) during wheel scrolling is now avoided.
1395 This behaviour can be customized via the mouse-wheel-click-event and
1396 mouse-wheel-inhibit-click-time variables.
1397
1398 +++
1399 ** The keyboard-coding-system is now automatically set based on your
1400 current locale settings if you are not using a window system. This
1401 may mean that the META key doesn't work but generates non-ASCII
1402 characters instead, depending on how the terminal (or terminal
1403 emulator) works. Use `set-keyboard-coding-system' (or customize
1404 keyboard-coding-system) if you prefer META to work (the old default)
1405 or if the locale doesn't describe the character set actually generated
1406 by the keyboard. See Info node `Single-Byte Character Support'.
1407
1408 +++
1409 ** Emacs now reads the standard abbrevs file ~/.abbrev_defs
1410 automatically at startup, if it exists. When Emacs offers to save
1411 modified buffers, it saves the abbrevs too if they have changed. It
1412 can do this either silently or asking for confirmation first,
1413 according to the value of `save-abbrevs'.
1414
1415 +++
1416 ** Display of hollow cursors now obeys the buffer-local value (if any)
1417 of `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' in the buffer that the cursor
1418 appears in.
1419
1420 ** The variable `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' can now be set to any
1421 of the recognized cursor types.
1422
1423 ---
1424 ** The variable `auto-save-file-name-transforms' now has a third element that
1425 controls whether or not the function `make-auto-save-file-name' will
1426 attempt to construct a unique auto-save name (e.g. for remote files).
1427
1428 +++
1429 ** There is a new calendar package, icalendar.el, that can be used to
1430 convert Emacs diary entries to/from the iCalendar format.
1431
1432 +++
1433 ** Diary sexp entries can have custom marking in the calendar.
1434 Diary sexp functions which only apply to certain days (such as
1435 `diary-block' or `diary-cyclic') now take an optional parameter MARK,
1436 which is the name of a face or a single-character string indicating
1437 how to highlight the day in the calendar display. Specifying a
1438 single-character string as @var{mark} places the character next to the
1439 day in the calendar. Specifying a face highlights the day with that
1440 face. This lets you have different colors or markings for vacations,
1441 appointments, paydays or anything else using a sexp.
1442
1443 +++
1444 ** The new function `calendar-goto-day-of-year' (g D) prompts for a
1445 year and day number, and moves to that date. Negative day numbers
1446 count backward from the end of the year.
1447
1448 +++
1449 ** The new Calendar function `calendar-goto-iso-week' (g w)
1450 prompts for a year and a week number, and moves to the first
1451 day of that ISO week.
1452
1453 ---
1454 ** The functions `holiday-easter-etc' and `holiday-advent' now take
1455 arguments, and only report on the specified holiday rather than all.
1456 This makes customization of the variable `christian-holidays' simpler,
1457 but existing customizations may need to be updated.
1458
1459 ** The function `simple-diary-display' now by default sets a header line.
1460 This can be controlled through the variables `diary-header-line-flag'
1461 and `diary-header-line-format'.
1462
1463 +++
1464 ** The procedure for activating appointment reminders has changed: use
1465 the new function `appt-activate'. The new variable
1466 `appt-display-format' controls how reminders are displayed, replacing
1467 appt-issue-message, appt-visible, and appt-msg-window.
1468
1469 ** The new functions `diary-from-outlook', `diary-from-outlook-gnus',
1470 and `diary-from-outlook-rmail' can be used to import diary entries
1471 from Outlook-format appointments in mail messages. The variable
1472 `diary-outlook-formats' can be customized to recognize additional
1473 formats.
1474
1475
1476 ** VC Changes
1477
1478 *** The key C-x C-q no longer checks files in or out, it only changes
1479 the read-only state of the buffer (toggle-read-only). We made this
1480 change because we held a poll and found that many users were unhappy
1481 with the previous behavior. If you do prefer this behavior, you
1482 can bind `vc-toggle-read-only' to C-x C-q in your .emacs:
1483
1484 (global-set-key "\C-x\C-q" 'vc-toggle-read-only)
1485
1486 The function `vc-toggle-read-only' will continue to exist.
1487
1488 +++
1489 *** There is a new user option `vc-cvs-global-switches' that allows
1490 you to specify switches that are passed to any CVS command invoked
1491 by VC. These switches are used as "global options" for CVS, which
1492 means they are inserted before the command name. For example, this
1493 allows you to specify a compression level using the "-z#" option for
1494 CVS.
1495
1496 *** New backends for Subversion and Meta-CVS.
1497
1498 ** EDiff changes.
1499
1500 +++
1501 *** When comparing directories.
1502 Typing D brings up a buffer that lists the differences between the contents of
1503 directories. Now it is possible to use this buffer to copy the missing files
1504 from one directory to another.
1505
1506 +++
1507 *** When comparing files or buffers.
1508 Typing the = key now offers to perform the word-by-word comparison of the
1509 currently highlighted regions in an inferior Ediff session. If you answer 'n'
1510 then it reverts to the old behavior and asks the user to select regions for
1511 comparison.
1512
1513 *** The new command `ediff-backup' compares a file with its most recent
1514 backup using `ediff'. If you specify the name of a backup file,
1515 `ediff-backup' compares it with the file of which it is a backup.
1516
1517 +++
1518 ** Etags changes.
1519
1520 *** New regular expressions features
1521
1522 **** New syntax for regular expressions, multi-line regular expressions.
1523 The syntax --ignore-case-regexp=/regex/ is now undocumented and retained
1524 only for backward compatibility. The new equivalent syntax is
1525 --regex=/regex/i. More generally, it is --regex=/TAGREGEX/TAGNAME/MODS,
1526 where `/TAGNAME' is optional, as usual, and MODS is a string of 0 or
1527 more characters among `i' (ignore case), `m' (multi-line) and `s'
1528 (single-line). The `m' and `s' modifiers behave as in Perl regular
1529 expressions: `m' allows regexps to match more than one line, while `s'
1530 (which implies `m') means that `.' matches newlines. The ability to
1531 span newlines allows writing of much more powerful regular expressions
1532 and rapid prototyping for tagging new languages.
1533
1534 **** Regular expressions can use char escape sequences as in Gcc.
1535 The escaped character sequence \a, \b, \d, \e, \f, \n, \r, \t, \v,
1536 respectively, stand for the ASCII characters BEL, BS, DEL, ESC, FF, NL,
1537 CR, TAB, VT,
1538
1539 **** Regular expressions can be bound to a given language.
1540 The syntax --regex={LANGUAGE}REGEX means that REGEX is used to make tags
1541 only for files of language LANGUAGE, and ignored otherwise. This is
1542 particularly useful when storing regexps in a file.
1543
1544 **** Regular expressions can be read from a file.
1545 The --regex=@regexfile option means read the regexps from a file, one
1546 per line. Lines beginning with space or tab are ignored.
1547
1548 *** New language parsing features
1549
1550 **** The `::' qualifier triggers C++ parsing in C file.
1551 Previously, only the `template' and `class' keywords had this effect.
1552
1553 **** The gnucc __attribute__ keyword is now recognised and ignored.
1554
1555 **** New language HTML.
1556 Title and h1, h2, h3 are tagged. Also, tags are generated when name= is
1557 used inside an anchor and whenever id= is used.
1558
1559 **** In Makefiles, constants are tagged.
1560 If you want the old behavior instead, thus avoiding to increase the
1561 size of the tags file, use the --no-globals option.
1562
1563 **** New language Lua.
1564 All functions are tagged.
1565
1566 **** In Perl, packages are tags.
1567 Subroutine tags are named from their package. You can jump to sub tags
1568 as you did before, by the sub name, or additionally by looking for
1569 package::sub.
1570
1571 **** In Prolog, etags creates tags for rules in addition to predicates.
1572
1573 **** New language PHP.
1574 Tags are functions, classes and defines.
1575 If the --members option is specified to etags, tags are variables also.
1576
1577 **** New default keywords for TeX.
1578 The new keywords are def, newcommand, renewcommand, newenvironment and
1579 renewenvironment.
1580
1581 *** Honour #line directives.
1582 When Etags parses an input file that contains C preprocessor's #line
1583 directives, it creates tags using the file name and line number
1584 specified in those directives. This is useful when dealing with code
1585 created from Cweb source files. When Etags tags the generated file, it
1586 writes tags pointing to the source file.
1587
1588 *** New option --parse-stdin=FILE.
1589 This option is mostly useful when calling etags from programs. It can
1590 be used (only once) in place of a file name on the command line. Etags
1591 reads from standard input and marks the produced tags as belonging to
1592 the file FILE.
1593
1594 +++
1595 ** CC Mode changes.
1596
1597 *** Font lock support.
1598 CC Mode now provides font lock support for all its languages. This
1599 supersedes the font lock patterns that have been in the core font lock
1600 package for C, C++, Java and Objective-C. Like indentation, font
1601 locking is done in a uniform way across all languages (except the new
1602 AWK mode - see below). That means that the new font locking will be
1603 different from the old patterns in various details for most languages.
1604
1605 The main goal of the font locking in CC Mode is accuracy, to provide a
1606 dependable aid in recognizing the various constructs. Some, like
1607 strings and comments, are easy to recognize while others like
1608 declarations and types can be very tricky. CC Mode can go to great
1609 lengths to recognize declarations and casts correctly, especially when
1610 the types aren't recognized by standard patterns. This is a fairly
1611 demanding analysis which can be slow on older hardware, and it can
1612 therefore be disabled by choosing a lower decoration level with the
1613 variable font-lock-maximum-decoration.
1614
1615 Note that the most demanding font lock level has been tuned with lazy
1616 fontification in mind, i.e. there should be a support mode that waits
1617 with the fontification until the text is actually shown
1618 (e.g. Just-in-time Lock mode, which is the default, or Lazy Lock
1619 mode). Fontifying a file with several thousand lines in one go can
1620 take the better part of a minute.
1621
1622 **** The (c|c++|objc|java|idl|pike)-font-lock-extra-types variables
1623 are now used by CC Mode to recognize identifiers that are certain to
1624 be types. (They are also used in cases that aren't related to font
1625 locking.) At the maximum decoration level, types are often recognized
1626 properly anyway, so these variables should be fairly restrictive and
1627 not contain patterns for uncertain types.
1628
1629 **** Support for documentation comments.
1630 There is a "plugin" system to fontify documentation comments like
1631 Javadoc and the markup within them. It's independent of the host
1632 language, so it's possible to e.g. turn on Javadoc font locking in C
1633 buffers. See the variable c-doc-comment-style for details.
1634
1635 Currently two kinds of doc comment styles are recognized: Suns Javadoc
1636 and Autodoc which is used in Pike. This is by no means a complete
1637 list of the most common tools; if your doc comment extractor of choice
1638 is missing then please drop a note to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
1639
1640 **** Better handling of C++ templates.
1641 As a side effect of the more accurate font locking, C++ templates are
1642 now handled much better. The angle brackets that delimit them are
1643 given parenthesis syntax so that they can be navigated like other
1644 parens.
1645
1646 This also improves indentation of templates, although there still is
1647 work to be done in that area. E.g. it's required that multiline
1648 template clauses are written in full and then refontified to be
1649 recognized, and the indentation of nested templates is a bit odd and
1650 not as configurable as it ought to be.
1651
1652 **** Improved handling of Objective-C and CORBA IDL.
1653 Especially the support for Objective-C and IDL has gotten an overhaul.
1654 The special "@" declarations in Objective-C are handled correctly.
1655 All the keywords used in CORBA IDL, PSDL, and CIDL are recognized and
1656 handled correctly, also wrt indentation.
1657
1658 *** Support for the AWK language.
1659 Support for the AWK language has been introduced. The implementation is
1660 based around GNU AWK version 3.1, but it should work pretty well with
1661 any AWK. As yet, not all features of CC Mode have been adapted for AWK.
1662 Here is a summary:
1663
1664 **** Indentation Engine
1665 The CC Mode indentation engine fully supports AWK mode.
1666
1667 AWK mode handles code formatted in the conventional AWK fashion: `{'s
1668 which start actions, user-defined functions, or compound statements are
1669 placed on the same line as the associated construct; the matching `}'s
1670 are normally placed under the start of the respective pattern, function
1671 definition, or structured statement.
1672
1673 The predefined indentation functions haven't yet been adapted for AWK
1674 mode, though some of them may work serendipitously. There shouldn't be
1675 any problems writing custom indentation functions for AWK mode.
1676
1677 The command C-c C-q (c-indent-defun) hasn't yet been adapted for AWK,
1678 though in practice it works properly nearly all the time. Should it
1679 fail, explicitly set the region around the function (using C-u C-SPC:
1680 C-M-h probably won't work either) then do C-M-\ (indent-region).
1681
1682 **** Font Locking
1683 There is a single level of font locking in AWK mode, rather than the
1684 three distinct levels the other modes have. There are several
1685 idiosyncrasies in AWK mode's font-locking due to the peculiarities of
1686 the AWK language itself.
1687
1688 **** Comment Commands
1689 M-; (indent-for-comment) works fine. None of the other CC Mode
1690 comment formatting commands have yet been adapted for AWK mode.
1691
1692 **** Movement Commands
1693 Most of the movement commands work in AWK mode. The most important
1694 exceptions are M-a (c-beginning-of-statement) and M-e
1695 (c-end-of-statement) which haven't yet been adapted.
1696
1697 The notion of "defun" has been augmented to include AWK pattern-action
1698 pairs. C-M-a (c-awk-beginning-of-defun) and C-M-e (c-awk-end-of-defun)
1699 recognise these pattern-action pairs, as well as user defined
1700 functions.
1701
1702 **** Auto-newline Insertion and Clean-ups
1703 Auto-newline insertion hasn't yet been adapted for AWK. Some of
1704 the clean-ups can actually convert good AWK code into syntactically
1705 invalid code. These features are best disabled in AWK buffers.
1706
1707 *** New syntactic symbols in IDL mode.
1708 The top level constructs "module" and "composition" (from CIDL) are
1709 now handled like "namespace" in C++: They are given syntactic symbols
1710 module-open, module-close, inmodule, composition-open,
1711 composition-close, and incomposition.
1712
1713 *** New functions to do hungry delete without enabling hungry delete mode.
1714 The functions c-hungry-backspace and c-hungry-delete-forward can be
1715 bound to keys to get this feature without toggling a mode.
1716 Contributed by Kevin Ryde.
1717
1718 *** Better control over require-final-newline.
1719 The variable that controls how to handle a final newline when the
1720 buffer is saved, require-final-newline, is now customizable on a
1721 per-mode basis through c-require-final-newline. The default is to set
1722 it to t only in languages that mandate a final newline in source files
1723 (C, C++ and Objective-C).
1724
1725 *** Format change for syntactic context elements.
1726 The elements in the syntactic context returned by c-guess-basic-syntax
1727 and stored in c-syntactic-context has been changed somewhat to allow
1728 attaching more information. They are now lists instead of single cons
1729 cells. E.g. a line that previously had the syntactic analysis
1730
1731 ((inclass . 11) (topmost-intro . 13))
1732
1733 is now analysed as
1734
1735 ((inclass 11) (topmost-intro 13))
1736
1737 In some cases there are more than one position given for a syntactic
1738 symbol.
1739
1740 This change might affect code that call c-guess-basic-syntax directly,
1741 and custom lineup functions if they use c-syntactic-context. However,
1742 the argument given to lineup functions is still a single cons cell
1743 with nil or an integer in the cdr.
1744
1745 *** API changes for derived modes.
1746 There have been extensive changes "under the hood" which can affect
1747 derived mode writers. Some of these changes are likely to cause
1748 incompatibilities with existing derived modes, but on the other hand
1749 care has now been taken to make it possible to extend and modify CC
1750 Mode with less risk of such problems in the future.
1751
1752 **** New language variable system.
1753 See the comment blurb near the top of cc-langs.el.
1754
1755 **** New initialization functions.
1756 The initialization procedure has been split up into more functions to
1757 give better control: c-basic-common-init, c-font-lock-init, and
1758 c-init-language-vars.
1759
1760 *** Changes in analysis of nested syntactic constructs.
1761 The syntactic analysis engine has better handling of cases where
1762 several syntactic constructs appear nested on the same line. They are
1763 now handled as if each construct started on a line of its own.
1764
1765 This means that CC Mode now indents some cases differently, and
1766 although it's more consistent there might be cases where the old way
1767 gave results that's more to one's liking. So if you find a situation
1768 where you think that the indentation has become worse, please report
1769 it to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
1770
1771 **** New syntactic symbol substatement-label.
1772 This symbol is used when a label is inserted between a statement and
1773 its substatement. E.g:
1774
1775 if (x)
1776 x_is_true:
1777 do_stuff();
1778
1779 *** Better handling of multiline macros.
1780
1781 **** Syntactic indentation inside macros.
1782 The contents of multiline #define's are now analyzed and indented
1783 syntactically just like other code. This can be disabled by the new
1784 variable c-syntactic-indentation-in-macros. A new syntactic symbol
1785 cpp-define-intro has been added to control the initial indentation
1786 inside #define's.
1787
1788 **** New lineup function c-lineup-cpp-define.
1789 Now used by default to line up macro continuation lines. The behavior
1790 of this function closely mimics the indentation one gets if the macro
1791 is indented while the line continuation backslashes are temporarily
1792 removed. If syntactic indentation in macros is turned off, it works
1793 much line c-lineup-dont-change, which was used earlier, but handles
1794 empty lines within the macro better.
1795
1796 **** Automatically inserted newlines continues the macro if used within one.
1797 This applies to the newlines inserted by the auto-newline mode, and to
1798 c-context-line-break and c-context-open-line.
1799
1800 **** Better alignment of line continuation backslashes.
1801 c-backslash-region tries to adapt to surrounding backslashes. New
1802 variable c-backslash-max-column which put a limit on how far out
1803 backslashes can be moved.
1804
1805 **** Automatic alignment of line continuation backslashes.
1806 This is controlled by the new variable c-auto-align-backslashes. It
1807 affects c-context-line-break, c-context-open-line and newlines
1808 inserted in auto-newline mode.
1809
1810 **** Line indentation works better inside macros.
1811 Regardless whether syntactic indentation and syntactic indentation
1812 inside macros are enabled or not, line indentation now ignores the
1813 line continuation backslashes. This is most noticeable when syntactic
1814 indentation is turned off and there are empty lines (save for the
1815 backslash) in the macro.
1816
1817 *** indent-for-comment is more customizable.
1818 The behavior of M-; (indent-for-comment) is now configurable through
1819 the variable c-indent-comment-alist. The indentation behavior based
1820 on the preceding code on the line, e.g. to get two spaces after #else
1821 and #endif but indentation to comment-column in most other cases
1822 (something which was hardcoded earlier).
1823
1824 *** New function c-context-open-line.
1825 It's the open-line equivalent of c-context-line-break.
1826
1827 *** New lineup functions
1828
1829 **** c-lineup-string-cont
1830 This lineup function lines up a continued string under the one it
1831 continues. E.g:
1832
1833 result = prefix + "A message "
1834 "string."; <- c-lineup-string-cont
1835
1836 **** c-lineup-cascaded-calls
1837 Lines up series of calls separated by "->" or ".".
1838
1839 **** c-lineup-knr-region-comment
1840 Gives (what most people think is) better indentation of comments in
1841 the "K&R region" between the function header and its body.
1842
1843 **** c-lineup-gcc-asm-reg
1844 Provides better indentation inside asm blocks. Contributed by Kevin
1845 Ryde.
1846
1847 **** c-lineup-argcont
1848 Lines up continued function arguments after the preceding comma.
1849 Contributed by Kevin Ryde.
1850
1851 *** Better caching of the syntactic context.
1852 CC Mode caches the positions of the opening parentheses (of any kind)
1853 of the lists surrounding the point. Those positions are used in many
1854 places as anchor points for various searches. The cache is now
1855 improved so that it can be reused to a large extent when the point is
1856 moved. The less it moves, the less needs to be recalculated.
1857
1858 The effect is that CC Mode should be fast most of the time even when
1859 opening parens are hung (i.e. aren't in column zero). It's typically
1860 only the first time after the point is moved far down in a complex
1861 file that it'll take noticeable time to find out the syntactic
1862 context.
1863
1864 *** Statements are recognized in a more robust way.
1865 Statements are recognized most of the time even when they occur in an
1866 "invalid" context, e.g. in a function argument. In practice that can
1867 happen when macros are involved.
1868
1869 *** Improved the way c-indent-exp chooses the block to indent.
1870 It now indents the block for the closest sexp following the point
1871 whose closing paren ends on a different line. This means that the
1872 point doesn't have to be immediately before the block to indent.
1873 Also, only the block and the closing line is indented; the current
1874 line is left untouched.
1875
1876 *** Added toggle for syntactic indentation.
1877 The function c-toggle-syntactic-indentation can be used to toggle
1878 syntactic indentation.
1879
1880 ** The command line option --no-windows has been changed to
1881 --no-window-system. The old one still works, but is deprecated.
1882
1883 +++
1884 ** The command `list-text-properties-at' has been deleted because
1885 C-u C-x = gives the same information and more.
1886
1887 +++
1888 ** `buffer-menu' and `list-buffers' now list buffers whose names begin
1889 with a space, when those buffers are visiting files. Normally buffers
1890 whose names begin with space are omitted.
1891
1892 +++
1893 ** You can now customize fill-nobreak-predicate to control where
1894 filling can break lines. We provide two sample predicates,
1895 fill-single-word-nobreak-p and fill-french-nobreak-p.
1896
1897 +++
1898 ** New user option `add-log-always-start-new-record'.
1899 When this option is enabled, M-x add-change-log-entry always
1900 starts a new record regardless of when the last record is.
1901
1902 +++
1903 ** SGML mode has indentation and supports XML syntax.
1904 The new variable `sgml-xml-mode' tells SGML mode to use XML syntax.
1905 When this option is enabled, SGML tags are inserted in XML style,
1906 i.e., there is always a closing tag.
1907 By default, its setting is inferred on a buffer-by-buffer basis
1908 from the file name or buffer contents.
1909
1910 +++
1911 ** `xml-mode' is now an alias for `sgml-mode', which has XML support.
1912
1913 ---
1914 ** Lisp mode now uses font-lock-doc-face for the docstrings.
1915
1916 ---
1917 ** Perl mode has a new variable `perl-indent-continued-arguments'.
1918
1919 +++
1920 ** Fortran mode has a new variable `fortran-directive-re'.
1921 Adapt this to match the format of any compiler directives you use.
1922 Lines that match are never indented, and are given distinctive font-locking.
1923
1924 ---
1925 ** F90 mode has new navigation commands `f90-end-of-block',
1926 `f90-beginning-of-block', `f90-next-block', `f90-previous-block'.
1927
1928 ** F90 mode now has support for hs-minor-mode (hideshow).
1929 It cannot deal with every code format, but ought to handle a sizeable
1930 majority.
1931
1932 ---
1933 ** Prolog mode has a new variable `prolog-font-lock-keywords'
1934 to support use of font-lock.
1935
1936 +++
1937 ** `special-display-buffer-names' and `special-display-regexps' now
1938 understand two new boolean pseudo-frame-parameters `same-frame' and
1939 `same-window'.
1940
1941 +++
1942 ** M-x setenv now expands environment variables of the form `$foo' and
1943 `${foo}' in the specified new value of the environment variable. To
1944 include a `$' in the value, use `$$'.
1945
1946 +++
1947 ** File-name completion can now ignore directories.
1948 If an element of the list in `completion-ignored-extensions' ends in a
1949 slash `/', it indicates a subdirectory that should be ignored when
1950 completing file names. Elements of `completion-ignored-extensions'
1951 which do not end in a slash are never considered when a completion
1952 candidate is a directory.
1953
1954 +++
1955 ** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
1956 to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
1957 it remains unchanged.
1958
1959 ** Enhanced visual feedback in *Completions* buffer.
1960
1961 Completions lists use faces to highlight what all completions
1962 have in common and where they begin to differ.
1963
1964 The common prefix shared by all possible completions uses the face
1965 `completions-common-part', while the first character that isn't the
1966 same uses the face `completions-first-difference'. By default,
1967 `completions-common-part' inherits from `default', and
1968 `completions-first-difference' inherits from `bold'. The idea of
1969 `completions-common-part' is that you can use it to make the common
1970 parts less visible than normal, so that the rest of the differing
1971 parts is, by contrast, slightly highlighted.
1972
1973 +++
1974 ** New user option `inhibit-startup-buffer-menu'.
1975 When loading many files, for instance with `emacs *', Emacs normally
1976 displays a buffer menu. This option turns the buffer menu off.
1977
1978 ---
1979 ** Rmail now displays 5-digit message ids in its summary buffer.
1980
1981 ---
1982 ** On MS Windows, the "system caret" now follows the cursor.
1983 This enables Emacs to work better with programs that need to track
1984 the cursor, for example screen magnifiers and text to speech programs.
1985
1986 ---
1987 ** Tooltips now work on MS Windows.
1988 See the Emacs 21.1 NEWS entry for tooltips for details.
1989
1990 ---
1991 ** Images are now supported on MS Windows.
1992 PBM and XBM images are supported out of the box. Other image formats
1993 depend on external libraries. All of these libraries have been ported
1994 to Windows, and can be found in both source and binary form at
1995 http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net/. Note that libpng also depends on
1996 zlib, and tiff depends on the version of jpeg that it was compiled
1997 against. For additional information, see nt/INSTALL.
1998
1999 ---
2000 ** Sound is now supported on MS Windows.
2001 WAV format is supported on all versions of Windows, other formats such
2002 as AU, AIFF and MP3 may be supported in the more recent versions of
2003 Windows, or when other software provides hooks into the system level
2004 sound support for those formats.
2005
2006 ---
2007 ** Different shaped mouse pointers are supported on MS Windows.
2008 The mouse pointer changes shape depending on what is under the pointer.
2009
2010 ---
2011 ** Pointing devices with more than 3 buttons are now supported on MS Windows.
2012 The new variable `w32-pass-extra-mouse-buttons-to-system' controls
2013 whether Emacs should handle the extra buttons itself (the default), or
2014 pass them to Windows to be handled with system-wide functions.
2015
2016 ---
2017 ** Emacs takes note of colors defined in Control Panel on MS-Windows.
2018 The Control Panel defines some default colors for applications in much
2019 the same way as wildcard X Resources do on X. Emacs now adds these
2020 colors to the colormap prefixed by System (eg SystemMenu for the
2021 default Menu background, SystemMenuText for the foreground), and uses
2022 some of them to initialize some of the default faces.
2023 `list-colors-display' shows the list of System color names, in case
2024 you wish to use them in other faces.
2025
2026 +++
2027 ** Under X11, it is possible to swap Alt and Meta (and Super and Hyper).
2028 The new variables `x-alt-keysym', `x-hyper-keysym', `x-meta-keysym',
2029 and `x-super-keysym' can be used to choose which keysyms Emacs should
2030 use for the modifiers. For example, the following two lines swap
2031 Meta and Alt:
2032 (setq x-alt-keysym 'meta)
2033 (setq x-meta-keysym 'alt)
2034
2035 +++
2036 ** vc-annotate-mode enhancements
2037
2038 In vc-annotate mode, you can now use the following key bindings for
2039 enhanced functionality to browse the annotations of past revisions, or
2040 to view diffs or log entries directly from vc-annotate-mode:
2041
2042 P: annotates the previous revision
2043 N: annotates the next revision
2044 J: annotates the revision at line
2045 A: annotates the revision previous to line
2046 D: shows the diff of the revision at line with its previous revision
2047 L: shows the log of the revision at line
2048 W: annotates the workfile (most up to date) version
2049
2050 +++
2051 ** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d y' command to view the diffs
2052 between the local version of the file and yesterday's head revision
2053 in the repository.
2054
2055 +++
2056 ** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d r' command to view the changes
2057 anyone has committed to the repository since you last executed
2058 "checkout", "update" or "commit". That means using cvs diff options
2059 -rBASE -rHEAD.
2060
2061 \f
2062 * New modes and packages in Emacs 21.4
2063
2064 ** The new package password.el provide a password cache and expiring mechanism.
2065
2066 ** The new package dns-mode.el add syntax highlight of DNS master files.
2067 The key binding C-c C-s (`dns-mode-soa-increment-serial') can be used
2068 to increment the SOA serial.
2069
2070 ** The new package flymake.el does on-the-fly syntax checking of program
2071 source files. See the Flymake's Info manual for more details.
2072
2073 ** The library tree-widget.el provides a new widget to display a set
2074 of hierarchical data as an outline. For example, the tree-widget is
2075 well suited to display a hierarchy of directories and files.
2076
2077 ** The wdired.el package allows you to use normal editing commands on Dired
2078 buffers to change filenames, permissions, etc...
2079
2080 ** The thumbs.el package allows you to preview image files as thumbnails
2081 and can be invoked from a Dired buffer.
2082
2083 ** The new python.el package is used to edit Python and Jython programs.
2084
2085 ** The URL package (which had been part of W3) is now part of Emacs.
2086
2087 +++
2088 ** The new global minor mode `size-indication-mode' (off by default)
2089 shows the size of accessible part of the buffer on the mode line.
2090
2091 ** GDB-Script-mode is used for files like .gdbinit.
2092
2093 ---
2094 ** Ido mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
2095
2096 The ido (interactively do) package is an extension of the iswitchb
2097 package to do interactive opening of files and directories in addition
2098 to interactive buffer switching. Ido is a superset of iswitchb (with
2099 a few exceptions), so don't enable both packages.
2100
2101 ---
2102 ** CUA mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
2103
2104 The new cua package provides CUA-like keybindings using C-x for
2105 cut (kill), C-c for copy, C-v for paste (yank), and C-z for undo.
2106 With cua, the region can be set and extended using shifted movement
2107 keys (like pc-selection-mode) and typed text replaces the active
2108 region (like delete-selection-mode). Do not enable these modes with
2109 cua-mode. Customize the variable `cua-mode' to enable cua.
2110
2111 In addition, cua provides unified rectangle support with visible
2112 rectangle highlighting: Use S-return to start a rectangle, extend it
2113 using the movement commands (or mouse-3), and cut or copy it using C-x
2114 or C-c (using C-w and M-w also works).
2115
2116 Use M-o and M-c to `open' or `close' the rectangle, use M-b or M-f, to
2117 fill it with blanks or another character, use M-u or M-l to upcase or
2118 downcase the rectangle, use M-i to increment the numbers in the
2119 rectangle, use M-n to fill the rectangle with a numeric sequence (such
2120 as 10 20 30...), use M-r to replace a regexp in the rectangle, and use
2121 M-' or M-/ to restrict command on the rectangle to a subset of the
2122 rows. See the commentary in cua-base.el for more rectangle commands.
2123
2124 Cua also provides unified support for registers: Use a numeric
2125 prefix argument between 0 and 9, i.e. M-0 .. M-9, for C-x, C-c, and
2126 C-v to cut or copy into register 0-9, or paste from register 0-9.
2127
2128 The last text deleted (not killed) is automatically stored in
2129 register 0. This includes text deleted by typing text.
2130
2131 Finally, cua provides a global mark which is set using S-C-space.
2132 When the global mark is active, any text which is cut or copied is
2133 automatically inserted at the global mark position. See the
2134 commentary in cua-base.el for more global mark related commands.
2135
2136 The features of cua also works with the standard emacs bindings for
2137 kill, copy, yank, and undo. If you want to use cua mode, but don't
2138 want the C-x, C-c, C-v, and C-z bindings, you may customize the
2139 `cua-enable-cua-keys' variable.
2140
2141 Note: This version of cua mode is not backwards compatible with older
2142 versions of cua.el and cua-mode.el. To ensure proper operation, you
2143 must remove older versions of cua.el or cua-mode.el as well as the
2144 loading and customization of those packages from the .emacs file.
2145
2146 ** The new keypad setup package provides several common bindings for
2147 the numeric keypad which is available on most keyboards. The numeric
2148 keypad typically has the digits 0 to 9, a decimal point, keys marked
2149 +, -, /, and *, an Enter key, and a NumLock toggle key. The keypad
2150 package only controls the use of the digit and decimal keys.
2151
2152 By customizing the variables `keypad-setup', `keypad-shifted-setup',
2153 `keypad-numlock-setup', and `keypad-numlock-shifted-setup', or by
2154 using the function `keypad-setup', you can rebind all digit keys and
2155 the decimal key of the keypad in one step for each of the four
2156 possible combinations of the Shift key state (not pressed/pressed) and
2157 the NumLock toggle state (off/on).
2158
2159 The choices for the keypad keys in each of the above states are:
2160 `Plain numeric keypad' where the keys generates plain digits,
2161 `Numeric keypad with decimal key' where the character produced by the
2162 decimal key can be customized individually (for internationalization),
2163 `Numeric Prefix Arg' where the keypad keys produce numeric prefix args
2164 for emacs editing commands, `Cursor keys' and `Shifted Cursor keys'
2165 where the keys work like (shifted) arrow keys, home/end, etc., and
2166 `Unspecified/User-defined' where the keypad keys (kp-0, kp-1, etc.)
2167 are left unspecified and can be bound individually through the global
2168 or local keymaps.
2169
2170 +++
2171 ** The new kmacro package provides a simpler user interface to
2172 emacs' keyboard macro facilities.
2173
2174 Basically, it uses two function keys (default F3 and F4) like this:
2175 F3 starts a macro, F4 ends the macro, and pressing F4 again executes
2176 the last macro. While defining the macro, F3 inserts a counter value
2177 which automatically increments every time the macro is executed.
2178
2179 There is now a keyboard macro ring which stores the most recently
2180 defined macros.
2181
2182 The C-x C-k sequence is now a prefix for the kmacro keymap which
2183 defines bindings for moving through the keyboard macro ring,
2184 C-x C-k C-p and C-x C-k C-n, editing the last macro C-x C-k C-e,
2185 manipulating the macro counter and format via C-x C-k C-c,
2186 C-x C-k C-a, and C-x C-k C-f. See the commentary in kmacro.el
2187 for more commands.
2188
2189 The normal macro bindings C-x (, C-x ), and C-x e now interfaces to
2190 the keyboard macro ring.
2191
2192 The C-x e command now automatically terminates the current macro
2193 before calling it, if used while defining a macro.
2194
2195 In addition, when ending or calling a macro with C-x e, the macro can
2196 be repeated immediately by typing just the `e'. You can customize
2197 this behaviour via the variable kmacro-call-repeat-key and
2198 kmacro-call-repeat-with-arg.
2199
2200 Keyboard macros can now be debugged and edited interactively.
2201 C-x C-k SPC steps through the last keyboard macro one key sequence
2202 at a time, prompting for the actions to take.
2203
2204 ---
2205 ** The old Octave mode bindings C-c f and C-c i have been changed
2206 to C-c C-f and C-c C-i. The C-c C-i subcommands now have duplicate
2207 bindings on control characters--thus, C-c C-i C-b is the same as
2208 C-c C-i b, and so on.
2209
2210 ** The printing package is now part of the Emacs distribution.
2211
2212 If you enable the printing package by including (require 'printing) in
2213 the .emacs file, the normal Print item on the File menu is replaced
2214 with a Print sub-menu which allows you to preview output through
2215 ghostview, use ghostscript to print (if you don't have a PostScript
2216 printer) or send directly to printer a PostScript code generated by
2217 `ps-print' package. Use M-x pr-help for more information.
2218
2219 +++
2220 ** Calc is now part of the Emacs distribution.
2221
2222 Calc is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool written in
2223 Emacs Lisp. Its documentation is in a separate manual; within Emacs,
2224 type "C-h i m calc RET" to read that manual. A reference card is
2225 available in `etc/calccard.tex' and `etc/calccard.ps'.
2226
2227 +++
2228 ** Tramp is now part of the distribution.
2229
2230 This package is similar to Ange-FTP: it allows you to edit remote
2231 files. But whereas Ange-FTP uses FTP to access the remote host,
2232 Tramp uses a shell connection. The shell connection is always used
2233 for filename completion and directory listings and suchlike, but for
2234 the actual file transfer, you can choose between the so-called
2235 `inline' methods (which transfer the files through the shell
2236 connection using base64 or uu encoding) and the `out-of-band' methods
2237 (which invoke an external copying program such as `rcp' or `scp' or
2238 `rsync' to do the copying).
2239
2240 Shell connections can be acquired via `rsh', `ssh', `telnet' and also
2241 `su' and `sudo'.
2242
2243 ---
2244 ** The new global minor mode `file-name-shadow-mode' modifies the way
2245 filenames being entered by the user in the minibuffer are displayed, so
2246 that it's clear when part of the entered filename will be ignored due to
2247 emacs' filename parsing rules. The ignored portion can be made dim,
2248 invisible, or otherwise less visually noticable. The display method may
2249 be displayed by customizing the variable `file-name-shadow-properties'.
2250
2251 ---
2252 ** The ruler-mode.el library provides a minor mode for displaying an
2253 "active" ruler in the header line. You can use the mouse to visually
2254 change the `fill-column', `window-margins' and `tab-stop-list'
2255 settings.
2256
2257 ---
2258 ** The minor mode Reveal mode makes text visible on the fly as you
2259 move your cursor into hidden regions of the buffer.
2260 It should work with any package that uses overlays to hide parts
2261 of a buffer, such as outline-minor-mode, hs-minor-mode, hide-ifdef-mode, ...
2262
2263 There is also Global Reveal mode which affects all buffers.
2264
2265 ---
2266 ** The new package ibuffer provides a powerful, completely
2267 customizable replacement for buff-menu.el.
2268
2269 ** The new package table.el implements editable, WYSIWYG, embedded
2270 `text tables' in Emacs buffers. It simulates the effect of putting
2271 these tables in a special major mode. The package emulates WYSIWYG
2272 table editing available in modern word processors. The package also
2273 can generate a table source in typesetting and markup languages such
2274 as latex and html from the visually laid out text table.
2275
2276 +++
2277 ** SES mode (ses-mode) is a new major mode for creating and editing
2278 spreadsheet files. Besides the usual Emacs features (intuitive command
2279 letters, undo, cell formulas in Lisp, plaintext files, etc.) it also offers
2280 viral immunity and import/export of tab-separated values.
2281
2282 ---
2283 ** Support for `magic cookie' standout modes has been removed.
2284 Emacs will still work on terminals that require magic cookies in order
2285 to use standout mode, however they will not be able to display
2286 mode-lines in inverse-video.
2287
2288 ---
2289 ** cplus-md.el has been removed to avoid problems with Custom.
2290
2291 ** New package benchmark.el contains simple support for convenient
2292 timing measurements of code (including the garbage collection component).
2293
2294 ** The new Lisp library fringe.el controls the appearance of fringes.
2295
2296 ** `cfengine-mode' is a major mode for editing GNU Cfengine
2297 configuration files.
2298 \f
2299 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 21.4
2300
2301 +++
2302 ** An interactive specification may now use the code letter 'U' to get
2303 the up-event that was discarded in case the last key sequence read for a
2304 previous 'k' or 'K' argument was a down-event; otherwise nil is used.
2305
2306 ** Function `translate-region' accepts also a char-table as TABLE
2307 argument.
2308
2309 +++
2310 ** Major mode functions now run the new normal hook
2311 `after-change-major-mode-hook', at their very end, after the mode hooks.
2312
2313 +++
2314 ** `auto-save-file-format' has been renamed to
2315 `buffer-auto-save-file-format' and made into a permanent local.
2316
2317 +++
2318 ** Both the variable and the function `disabled-command-hook' have
2319 been renamed to `disabled-command-function'. The variable
2320 `disabled-command-hook' has been kept as an obsolete alias.
2321
2322 ** Function `compute-motion' now calculates the usable window
2323 width if the WIDTH argument is nil. If the TOPOS argument is nil,
2324 the usable window height and width is used.
2325
2326 +++
2327 ** `visited-file-modtime' and `calendar-time-from-absolute' now return
2328 a list of two integers, instead of a cons.
2329
2330 ** If a command sets transient-mark-mode to `only', that
2331 enables Transient Mark mode for the following command only.
2332 During that following command, the value of transient-mark-mode
2333 is `identity'. If it is still `identity' at the end of the command,
2334 it changes to nil.
2335
2336 +++
2337 ** Cleaner way to enter key sequences.
2338
2339 You can enter a constant key sequence in a more natural format, the
2340 same one used for saving keyboard macros, using the macro `kbd'. For
2341 example,
2342
2343 (kbd "C-x C-f") => "\^x\^f"
2344
2345 ** The sentinel is now called when a network process is deleted with
2346 delete-process. The status message passed to the sentinel for a
2347 deleted network process is "deleted". The message passed to the
2348 sentinel when the connection is closed by the remote peer has been
2349 changed to "connection broken by remote peer".
2350
2351 ** If the buffer's undo list for the current command gets longer than
2352 undo-outer-limit, garbage collection empties it. This is to prevent
2353 it from using up the available memory and choking Emacs.
2354
2355 ---
2356 ** New function quail-find-key returns a list of keys to type in the
2357 current input method to input a character.
2358
2359 +++
2360 ** New functions posn-at-point and posn-at-x-y return
2361 click-event-style position information for a given visible buffer
2362 position or for a given window pixel coordinate.
2363
2364 ** skip-chars-forward and skip-chars-backward now handle
2365 character classes such as [:alpha:], along with individual characters
2366 and ranges.
2367
2368 ** Function pos-visible-in-window-p now returns the pixel coordinates
2369 and partial visiblity state of the corresponding row, if the PARTIALLY
2370 arg is non-nil.
2371
2372 ** The function `eql' is now available without requiring the CL package.
2373
2374 +++
2375 ** The new primitive `set-file-times' sets a file's access and
2376 modification times. Magic file name handlers can handle this
2377 operation.
2378
2379 ** file-remote-p now returns an identifier for the remote system,
2380 if the file is indeed remote. (Before, the return value was t in
2381 this case.)
2382
2383 +++
2384 ** The display space :width and :align-to text properties are now
2385 supported on text terminals.
2386
2387 +++
2388 ** Support for displaying image slices
2389
2390 *** New display property (slice X Y WIDTH HEIGHT) may be used with
2391 an image property to display only a specific slice of the image.
2392
2393 *** Function insert-image has new optional fourth arg to
2394 specify image slice (X Y WIDTH HEIGHT).
2395
2396 *** New function insert-sliced-image inserts a given image as a
2397 specified number of evenly sized slices (rows x columns).
2398
2399 +++
2400 ** New line-height and line-spacing properties for newline characters
2401
2402 A newline may now have line-height and line-spacing text or overlay
2403 properties that control the height of the corresponding display row.
2404
2405 If the line-height property value is 0, the newline does not
2406 contribute to the height of the display row; instead the height of the
2407 newline glyph is reduced. Also, a line-spacing property on this
2408 newline is ignored. This can be used to tile small images or image
2409 slices without adding blank areas between the images.
2410
2411 If the line-height property value is a positive integer, the value
2412 specifies the minimum line height in pixels. If necessary, the line
2413 height it increased by increasing the line's ascent.
2414
2415 If the line-height property value is a float, the minimum line height
2416 is calculated by multiplying the default frame line height by the
2417 given value.
2418
2419 If the line-height property value is a cons (RATIO . FACE), the
2420 minimum line height is calculated as RATIO * height of named FACE.
2421 RATIO is int or float. If FACE is t, it specifies the current face.
2422
2423 If the line-spacing property value is an positive integer, the value
2424 is used as additional pixels to insert after the display line; this
2425 overrides the default frame line-spacing and any buffer local value of
2426 the line-spacing variable.
2427
2428 If the line-spacing property may be a float or cons, the line spacing
2429 is calculated as specified above for the line-height property.
2430
2431 If the line-spacing value is a cons (total . SPACING) where SPACING is
2432 any of the forms described above, the value of SPACING is used as the
2433 total height of the line, i.e. a varying number of pixels are inserted
2434 after each line to make each line exactly that many pixels high.
2435
2436 ** The buffer local line-spacing variable may now have a float value,
2437 which is used as a height relative to the default frame line height.
2438
2439 +++
2440 ** Enhancements to stretch display properties
2441
2442 The display property stretch specification form `(space PROPS)', where
2443 PROPS is a property list now allows pixel based width and height
2444 specifications, as well as enhanced horizontal text alignment.
2445
2446 The value of these properties can now be a (primitive) expression
2447 which is evaluated during redisplay. The following expressions
2448 are supported:
2449
2450 EXPR ::= NUM | (NUM) | UNIT | ELEM | POS | IMAGE | FORM
2451 NUM ::= INTEGER | FLOAT | SYMBOL
2452 UNIT ::= in | mm | cm | width | height
2453 ELEM ::= left-fringe | right-fringe | left-margin | right-margin
2454 | scroll-bar | text
2455 POS ::= left | center | right
2456 FORM ::= (NUM . EXPR) | (OP EXPR ...)
2457 OP ::= + | -
2458
2459 The form `NUM' specifies a fractional width or height of the default
2460 frame font size. The form `(NUM)' specifies an absolute number of
2461 pixels. If a symbol is specified, its buffer-local variable binding
2462 is used. The `in', `mm', and `cm' units specifies the number of
2463 pixels per inch, milli-meter, and centi-meter, resp. The `width' and
2464 `height' units correspond to the width and height of the current face
2465 font. An image specification corresponds to the width or height of
2466 the image.
2467
2468 The `left-fringe', `right-fringe', `left-margin', `right-margin',
2469 `scroll-bar', and `text' elements specify to the width of the
2470 corresponding area of the window.
2471
2472 The `left', `center', and `right' positions can be used with :align-to
2473 to specify a position relative to the left edge, center, or right edge
2474 of the text area. One of the above window elements (except `text')
2475 can also be used with :align-to to specify that the position is
2476 relative to the left edge of the given area. Once the base offset for
2477 a relative position has been set (by the first occurrence of one of
2478 these symbols), further occurences of these symbols are interpreted as
2479 the width of the area.
2480
2481 For example, to align to the center of the left-margin, use
2482 :align-to (+ left-margin (0.5 . left-margin))
2483
2484 If no specific base offset is set for alignment, it is always relative
2485 to the left edge of the text area. For example, :align-to 0 in a
2486 header-line aligns with the first text column in the text area.
2487
2488 The value of the form `(NUM . EXPR)' is the value of NUM multiplied by
2489 the value of the expression EXPR. For example, (2 . in) specifies a
2490 width of 2 inches, while (0.5 . IMAGE) specifies half the width (or
2491 height) of the specified image.
2492
2493 The form `(+ EXPR ...)' adds up the value of the expressions.
2494 The form `(- EXPR ...)' negates or subtracts the value of the expressions.
2495
2496 +++
2497 ** Normally, the cursor is displayed at the end of any overlay and
2498 text property string that may be present at the current window
2499 position. The cursor may now be placed on any character of such
2500 strings by giving that character a non-nil `cursor' text property.
2501
2502 ** New macro with-local-quit temporarily sets inhibit-quit to nil for use
2503 around potentially blocking or long-running code in timers
2504 and post-command-hooks.
2505
2506 +++
2507 ** New face attribute `min-colors' can be used to tailor the face color
2508 to the number of colors supported by a display, and define the
2509 foreground and background colors accordingly so that they look best on
2510 a terminal that supports at least this many colors. This is now the
2511 preferred method for defining default faces in a way that makes a good
2512 use of the capabilities of the display.
2513
2514 +++
2515 ** Customizable fringe bitmaps
2516
2517 *** New function 'define-fringe-bitmap' can now be used to create new
2518 fringe bitmaps, as well as change the built-in fringe bitmaps.
2519
2520 To change a built-in bitmap, do (require 'fringe) and use the symbol
2521 identifing the bitmap such as `left-truncation or `continued-line'.
2522
2523 *** New function 'destroy-fringe-bitmap' may be used to destroy a
2524 previously created bitmap, or restore a built-in bitmap.
2525
2526 *** New function 'set-fringe-bitmap-face' can now be used to set a
2527 specific face to be used for a specific fringe bitmap. Normally,
2528 this should be a face derived from the `fringe' face, specifying
2529 the foreground color as the desired color of the bitmap.
2530
2531 *** There are new display properties, left-fringe and right-fringe,
2532 that can be used to show a specific bitmap in the left or right fringe
2533 bitmap of the display line.
2534
2535 Format is 'display '(left-fringe BITMAP [FACE]), where BITMAP is a
2536 symbol identifying a fringe bitmap, either built-in or defined with
2537 `define-fringe-bitmap', and FACE is an optional face name to be used
2538 for displaying the bitmap.
2539
2540 *** New function `fringe-bitmaps-at-pos' returns the current fringe
2541 bitmaps in the display line at a given buffer position.
2542
2543 ** Multiple overlay arrows can now be defined and managed via the new
2544 variable `overlay-arrow-variable-list'. It contains a list of
2545 varibles which contain overlay arrow position markers, including
2546 the original `overlay-arrow-position' variable.
2547
2548 Each variable on this list may have individual `overlay-arrow-string'
2549 and `overlay-arrow-bitmap' properties that specify an overlay arrow
2550 string (for non-window terminals) or fringe bitmap (for window
2551 systems) to display at the corresponding overlay arrow position.
2552 If either property is not set, the default `overlay-arrow-string' or
2553 'overlay-arrow-fringe-bitmap' will be used.
2554
2555 +++
2556 ** New function `line-number-at-pos' returns line number of current
2557 line in current buffer, or if optional buffer position is given, line
2558 number of corresponding line in current buffer.
2559
2560 +++
2561 ** The default value of `sentence-end' is now defined using the new
2562 variable `sentence-end-without-space' which contains such characters
2563 that end a sentence without following spaces.
2564
2565 +++
2566 ** The function `sentence-end' should be used to obtain the value of
2567 the variable `sentence-end'. If the variable `sentence-end' is nil,
2568 then this function returns the regexp constructed from the variables
2569 `sentence-end-without-period', `sentence-end-double-space' and
2570 `sentence-end-without-space'.
2571
2572 +++
2573 ** The flags, width, and precision options for %-specifications in function
2574 `format' are now documented. Some flags that were accepted but not
2575 implemented (such as "*") are no longer accepted.
2576
2577 ** New function `macroexpand-all' expands all macros in a form.
2578 It is similar to the Common-Lisp function of the same name.
2579 One difference is that it guarantees to return the original argument
2580 if no expansion is done, which may be tested using `eq'.
2581
2582 +++
2583 ** New function `delete-dups' destructively removes `equal' duplicates
2584 from a list. Of several `equal' occurrences of an element in the list,
2585 the first one is kept.
2586
2587 +++
2588 ** `declare' is now a macro. This change was made mostly for
2589 documentation purposes and should have no real effect on Lisp code.
2590
2591 ** The new hook `before-save-hook' is invoked by `basic-save-buffer'
2592 before saving buffers. This allows packages to perform various final
2593 tasks, for example; it can be used by the copyright package to make
2594 sure saved files have the current year in any copyright headers.
2595
2596 +++
2597 ** The function `insert-for-yank' now supports strings where the
2598 `yank-handler' property does not span the first character of the
2599 string. The old behavior is available if you call
2600 `insert-for-yank-1' instead.
2601
2602 ** New function `get-char-property-and-overlay' accepts the same
2603 arguments as `get-char-property' and returns a cons whose car is the
2604 return value of `get-char-property' called with those arguments and
2605 whose cdr is the overlay in which the property was found, or nil if
2606 it was found as a text property or not found at all.
2607
2608 +++ (lispref)
2609 ??? (man)
2610 ** The mouse pointer shape in void text areas (i.e. after the end of a
2611 line or below the last line in the buffer) of the text window is now
2612 controlled by the new variable `void-text-area-pointer'. The default
2613 is to use the `arrow' (non-text) pointer. Other choices are `text'
2614 (or nil), `hand', `vdrag', `hdrag', `modeline', and `hourglass'.
2615
2616 +++
2617 ** The mouse pointer shape over an image can now be controlled by the
2618 :pointer image property.
2619
2620 +++
2621 ** The mouse pointer shape over ordinary text or images may now be
2622 controlled/overriden via the `pointer' text property.
2623
2624 +++
2625 ** Images may now have an associated image map via the :map property.
2626
2627 An image map is an alist where each element has the format (AREA ID PLIST).
2628 An AREA is specified as either a rectangle, a circle, or a polygon:
2629 A rectangle is a cons (rect . ((x0 . y0) . (x1 . y1))) specifying the
2630 pixel coordinates of the upper left and bottom right corners.
2631 A circle is a cons (circle . ((x0 . y0) . r)) specifying the center
2632 and the radius of the circle; r may be a float or integer.
2633 A polygon is a cons (poly . [x0 y0 x1 y1 ...]) where each pair in the
2634 vector describes one corner in the polygon.
2635
2636 When the mouse pointer is above a hot-spot area of an image, the
2637 PLIST of that hot-spot is consulted; if it contains a `help-echo'
2638 property it defines a tool-tip for the hot-spot, and if it contains
2639 a `pointer' property, it defines the shape of the mouse cursor when
2640 it is over the hot-spot. See the variable 'void-area-text-pointer'
2641 for possible pointer shapes.
2642
2643 When you click the mouse when the mouse pointer is over a hot-spot,
2644 an event is composed by combining the ID of the hot-spot with the
2645 mouse event, e.g. [area4 mouse-1] if the hot-spot's ID is `area4'.
2646
2647 ** Mouse event enhancements:
2648
2649 *** Mouse clicks on fringes now generates left-fringe or right-fringes
2650 events, rather than a text area click event.
2651
2652 *** Mouse clicks in the left and right marginal areas now includes a
2653 sensible buffer position corresponding to the first character in the
2654 corresponding text row.
2655
2656 *** Function `mouse-set-point' now works for events outside text area.
2657
2658 +++
2659 *** Mouse events now includes buffer position for all event types.
2660
2661 +++
2662 *** `posn-point' now returns buffer position for non-text area events.
2663
2664 +++
2665 *** New function `posn-area' returns window area clicked on (nil means
2666 text area).
2667
2668 +++
2669 *** Mouse events include actual glyph column and row for all event types.
2670
2671 +++
2672 *** New function `posn-actual-col-row' returns actual glyph coordinates.
2673
2674 +++
2675 *** Mouse events may now include image object in addition to string object.
2676
2677 +++
2678 *** Mouse events include relative x and y pixel coordinates relative to
2679 the top left corner of the object (image or character) clicked on.
2680
2681 +++
2682 *** Mouse events include the pixel width and height of the object
2683 (image or character) clicked on.
2684
2685 +++
2686 *** New functions 'posn-object', 'posn-object-x-y', and
2687 'posn-object-width-height' return the image or string object of a mouse
2688 click, the x and y pixel coordinates relative to the top left corner
2689 of that object, and the total width and height of that object.
2690
2691 ** New function `force-window-update' can initiate a full redisplay of
2692 one or all windows. Normally, this is not needed as changes in window
2693 contents are detected automatically. However, certain implicit
2694 changes to mode lines, header lines, or display properties may require
2695 forcing an explicit window update.
2696
2697 ** New function `redirect-debugging-output' can be used to redirect
2698 debugging output on the stderr file handle to a file.
2699
2700 +++
2701 ** `split-string' now includes null substrings in the returned list if
2702 the optional argument SEPARATORS is non-nil and there are matches for
2703 SEPARATORS at the beginning or end of the string. If SEPARATORS is
2704 nil, or if the new optional third argument OMIT-NULLS is non-nil, all
2705 empty matches are omitted from the returned list.
2706
2707 +++
2708 ** `makehash' is now obsolete. Use `make-hash-table' instead.
2709
2710 +++
2711 ** If optional third argument APPEND to `add-to-list' is non-nil, a
2712 new element gets added at the end of the list instead of at the
2713 beginning. This change actually occurred in Emacs-21.1, but was not
2714 documented.
2715
2716 ** Major modes can define `eldoc-print-current-symbol-info-function'
2717 locally to provide Eldoc functionality by some method appropriate to
2718 the language.
2719
2720 ---
2721 ** New coding system property `mime-text-unsuitable' indicates that
2722 the coding system's `mime-charset' is not suitable for MIME text
2723 parts, e.g. utf-16.
2724
2725 +++
2726 ** The argument to forward-word, backward-word, forward-to-indentation
2727 and backward-to-indentation is now optional, and defaults to 1.
2728
2729 +++
2730 ** (char-displayable-p CHAR) returns non-nil if Emacs ought to be able
2731 to display CHAR. More precisely, if the selected frame's fontset has
2732 a font to display the character set that CHAR belongs to.
2733
2734 Fontsets can specify a font on a per-character basis; when the fontset
2735 does that, this value may not be accurate.
2736
2737 +++
2738 ** The new function `window-inside-edges' returns the edges of the
2739 actual text portion of the window, not including the scroll bar or
2740 divider line, the fringes, the display margins, the header line and
2741 the mode line.
2742
2743 +++
2744 ** The new functions `window-pixel-edges' and `window-inside-pixel-edges'
2745 return window edges in units of pixels, rather than columns and lines.
2746
2747 +++
2748 ** The kill-buffer-hook is now permanent-local.
2749
2750 +++
2751 ** `select-window' takes an optional second argument `norecord', like
2752 `switch-to-buffer'.
2753
2754 +++
2755 ** The new macro `with-selected-window' temporarily switches the
2756 selected window without impacting the order of buffer-list.
2757
2758 +++
2759 ** The `keymap' property now also works at the ends of overlays and
2760 text-properties, according to their stickiness. This also means that it
2761 works with empty overlays. The same hold for the `local-map' property.
2762
2763 +++
2764 ** (map-keymap FUNCTION KEYMAP) applies the function to each binding
2765 in the keymap.
2766
2767 ---
2768 ** VC changes for backends:
2769 *** (vc-switches BACKEND OPERATION) is a new function for use by backends.
2770 *** The new `find-version' backend function replaces the `destfile'
2771 parameter of the `checkout' backend function.
2772 Old code still works thanks to a default `find-version' behavior that
2773 uses the old `destfile' parameter.
2774
2775 +++
2776 ** The new macro dynamic-completion-table supports using functions
2777 as a dynamic completion table.
2778
2779 (dynamic-completion-table FUN)
2780
2781 FUN is called with one argument, the string for which completion is required,
2782 and it should return an alist containing all the intended possible
2783 completions. This alist may be a full list of possible completions so that FUN
2784 can ignore the value of its argument. If completion is performed in the
2785 minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer from which the minibuffer was
2786 entered. dynamic-completion-table then computes the completion.
2787
2788 +++
2789 ** The new macro lazy-completion-table initializes a variable
2790 as a lazy completion table.
2791
2792 (lazy-completion-table VAR FUN &rest ARGS)
2793
2794 If the completion table VAR is used for the first time (e.g., by passing VAR
2795 as an argument to `try-completion'), the function FUN is called with arguments
2796 ARGS. FUN must return the completion table that will be stored in VAR. If
2797 completion is requested in the minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer
2798 from which the minibuffer was entered. The return value of
2799 `lazy-completion-table' must be used to initialize the value of VAR.
2800
2801 +++
2802 ** `minor-mode-list' now holds a list of minor mode commands.
2803
2804 +++
2805 ** The new function `modify-all-frames-parameters' modifies parameters
2806 for all (existing and future) frames.
2807
2808 +++
2809 ** `sit-for' can now be called with args (SECONDS &optional NODISP).
2810
2811 +++
2812 ** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-preprocessor-face'.
2813
2814 +++
2815 ** The macro `with-syntax-table' does not copy the table any more.
2816
2817 +++
2818 ** The variable `face-font-rescale-alist' specifies how much larger
2819 (or smaller) font we should use. For instance, if the value is
2820 '((SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN . 1.3)) and a face requests a font of 10
2821 point, we actually use a font of 13 point if the font matches
2822 SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN.
2823
2824 +++
2825 ** The function `number-sequence' returns a list of equally-separated
2826 numbers. For instance, (number-sequence 4 9) returns (4 5 6 7 8 9).
2827 By default, the separation is 1, but you can specify a different separation
2828 as the third argument. (number-sequence 1.5 6 2) returns (1.5 3.5 5.5).
2829
2830 +++
2831 ** `file-chase-links' now takes an optional second argument LIMIT which
2832 specifies the maximum number of links to chase through. If after that
2833 many iterations the file name obtained is still a symbolic link,
2834 `file-chase-links' returns it anyway.
2835
2836 ---
2837 ** `set-fontset-font', `fontset-info', `fontset-font' now operate on
2838 the default fontset if the argument NAME is nil..
2839
2840 +++
2841 ** The escape sequence \s is now interpreted as a SPACE character,
2842 unless it is followed by a `-' in a character constant (e.g. ?\s-A),
2843 in which case it is still interpreted as the super modifier.
2844 In strings, \s is always interpreted as a space.
2845
2846 +++
2847 ** New function `set-process-filter-multibyte' sets the multibyteness
2848 of a string given to a process's filter.
2849
2850 +++
2851 ** New function `process-filter-multibyte-p' returns t if
2852 a string given to a process's filter is multibyte.
2853
2854 +++
2855 ** A filter function of a process is called with a multibyte string if
2856 the filter's multibyteness is t. That multibyteness is decided by the
2857 value of `default-enable-multibyte-characters' when the process is
2858 created and can be changed later by `set-process-filter-multibyte'.
2859
2860 +++
2861 ** If a process's coding system is raw-text or no-conversion and its
2862 buffer is multibyte, the output of the process is at first converted
2863 to multibyte by `string-to-multibyte' then inserted in the buffer.
2864 Previously, it was converted to multibyte by `string-as-multibyte',
2865 which was not compatible with the behaviour of file reading.
2866
2867 +++
2868 ** New function `string-to-multibyte' converts a unibyte string to a
2869 multibyte string with the same individual character codes.
2870
2871 +++
2872 ** New variables `gc-elapsed' and `gcs-done' provide extra information
2873 on garbage collection.
2874
2875 +++
2876 ** New function `decode-coding-inserted-region' decodes a region as if
2877 it is read from a file without decoding.
2878
2879 +++
2880 ** New function `locale-info' accesses locale information.
2881
2882 +++
2883 ** `save-selected-window' now saves and restores the selected window
2884 of every frame. This way, it restores everything that can be changed
2885 by calling `select-window'.
2886
2887 ---
2888 ** `easy-menu-define' now allows you to use nil for the symbol name
2889 if you don't need to give the menu a name. If you install the menu
2890 into other keymaps right away (MAPS is non-nil), it usually doesn't
2891 need to have a name.
2892
2893 ** Byte compiler changes:
2894
2895 ---
2896 *** `(featurep 'xemacs)' is treated by the compiler as nil. This
2897 helps to avoid noisy compiler warnings in code meant to run under both
2898 Emacs and XEmacs and may sometimes make the result significantly more
2899 efficient. Since byte code from recent versions of XEmacs won't
2900 generally run in Emacs and vice versa, this optimization doesn't lose
2901 you anything.
2902
2903 +++
2904 *** You can avoid warnings for possibly-undefined symbols with a
2905 simple convention that the compiler understands. (This is mostly
2906 useful in code meant to be portable to different Emacs versions.)
2907 Write forms like the following, or code that macroexpands into such
2908 forms:
2909
2910 (if (fboundp 'foo) <then> <else>)
2911 (if (boundp 'foo) <then> <else)
2912
2913 In the first case, using `foo' as a function inside the <then> form
2914 won't produce a warning if it's not defined as a function, and in the
2915 second case, using `foo' as a variable won't produce a warning if it's
2916 unbound. The test must be in exactly one of the above forms (after
2917 macro expansion), but such tests may be nested. Note that `when' and
2918 `unless' expand to `if', but `cond' doesn't.
2919
2920 +++
2921 *** The new macro `with-no-warnings' suppresses all compiler warnings
2922 inside its body. In terms of execution, it is equivalent to `progn'.
2923
2924 +++
2925 ** The new translation table `translation-table-for-input'
2926 is used for customizing self-insertion. The character to
2927 be inserted is translated through it.
2928
2929 +++
2930 ** `load-history' can now have elements of the form (t . FUNNAME),
2931 which means FUNNAME was previously defined as an autoload (before the
2932 current file redefined it).
2933
2934 +++
2935 ** New Lisp library testcover.el works with edebug to help you determine
2936 whether you've tested all your Lisp code. Function testcover-start
2937 instruments all functions in a given file. Then test your code. Function
2938 testcover-mark-all adds overlay "splotches" to the Lisp file's buffer to
2939 show where coverage is lacking. Command testcover-next-mark (bind it to
2940 a key!) will move point forward to the next spot that has a splotch.
2941
2942 *** Normally, a red splotch indicates the form was never completely evaluated;
2943 a brown splotch means it always evaluated to the same value. The red
2944 splotches are skipped for forms that can't possibly complete their evaluation,
2945 such as `error'. The brown splotches are skipped for forms that are expected
2946 to always evaluate to the same value, such as (setq x 14).
2947
2948 *** For difficult cases, you can add do-nothing macros to your code to help
2949 out the test coverage tool. The macro `noreturn' suppresses a red splotch.
2950 It is an error if the argument to `noreturn' does return. The macro 1value
2951 suppresses a brown splotch for its argument. This macro is a no-op except
2952 during test-coverage -- then it signals an error if the argument actually
2953 returns differing values.
2954
2955 +++
2956 ** New function unsafep returns nil if the given Lisp form can't possibly
2957 do anything dangerous; otherwise it returns a reason why the form might be
2958 unsafe (calls dangerous function, alters global variable, etc).
2959
2960 +++
2961 ** The new variable `print-continuous-numbering', when non-nil, says
2962 that successive calls to print functions should use the same
2963 numberings for circular structure references. This is only relevant
2964 when `print-circle' is non-nil.
2965
2966 When you bind `print-continuous-numbering' to t, you should
2967 also bind `print-number-table' to nil.
2968
2969 +++
2970 ** When using non-toolkit scroll bars with the default width,
2971 the scroll-bar-width frame parameter value is nil.
2972
2973 +++
2974 ** The new function copy-abbrev-table returns a new abbrev table that
2975 is a copy of a given abbrev table.
2976
2977 +++
2978 ** The option --script FILE runs Emacs in batch mode and loads FILE.
2979 It is useful for writing Emacs Lisp shell script files, because they
2980 can start with this line:
2981
2982 #!/usr/bin/emacs --script
2983
2984 ** The option --directory DIR now modifies `load-path' immediately.
2985 Directories are added to the front of `load-path' in the order they
2986 appear on the command line. For example, with this command line:
2987
2988 emacs -batch -L .. -L /tmp --eval "(require 'foo)"
2989
2990 Emacs looks for library `foo' in the parent directory, then in /tmp, then
2991 in the other directories in `load-path'. (-L is short for --directory.)
2992
2993 +++
2994 ** A function's docstring can now hold the function's usage info on
2995 its last line. It should match the regexp "\n\n(fn.*)\\'".
2996
2997 ---
2998 ** New CCL functions `lookup-character' and `lookup-integer' access
2999 hash tables defined by the Lisp function `define-translation-hash-table'.
3000
3001 +++
3002 ** The new function `minibufferp' returns non-nil if its optional buffer
3003 argument is a minibuffer. If the argument is omitted it defaults to
3004 the current buffer.
3005
3006 +++
3007 ** There is a new Warnings facility; see the functions `warn'
3008 and `display-warning'.
3009
3010 +++
3011 ** The functions all-completions and try-completion now accept lists
3012 of strings as well as hash-tables additionally to alists, obarrays
3013 and functions. Furthermore, the function `test-completion' is now
3014 exported to Lisp.
3015
3016 ---
3017 ** When pure storage overflows while dumping, Emacs now prints how
3018 much pure storage it will approximately need.
3019
3020 +++
3021 ** The new variable `auto-coding-functions' lets you specify functions
3022 to examine a file being visited and deduce the proper coding system
3023 for it. (If the coding system is detected incorrectly for a specific
3024 file, you can put a `coding:' tags to override it.)
3025
3026 ---
3027 ** The new function `merge-coding-systems' fills in unspecified aspects
3028 of one coding system from another coding system.
3029
3030 +++
3031 ** The variable `safe-local-eval-forms' specifies a list of forms that
3032 are ok to evaluate when they appear in an `eval' local variables
3033 specification. Normally Emacs asks for confirmation before evaluating
3034 such a form, but if the form appears in this list, no confirmation is
3035 needed.
3036
3037 ---
3038 ** If a function has a non-nil `safe-local-eval-function' property,
3039 that means it is ok to evaluate some calls to that function when it
3040 appears in an `eval' local variables specification. If the property
3041 is t, then any form calling that function with constant arguments is
3042 ok. If the property is a function or list of functions, they are called
3043 with the form as argument, and if any returns t, the form is ok to call.
3044
3045 If the form is not "ok to call", that means Emacs asks for
3046 confirmation as before.
3047
3048 +++
3049 ** Controlling the default left and right fringe widths.
3050
3051 The default left and right fringe widths for all windows of a frame
3052 can now be controlled by setting the `left-fringe' and `right-fringe'
3053 frame parameters to an integer value specifying the width in pixels.
3054 Setting the width to 0 effectively removes the corresponding fringe.
3055
3056 The actual default fringe widths for the frame may deviate from the
3057 specified widths, since the combined fringe widths must match an
3058 integral number of columns. The extra width is distributed evenly
3059 between the left and right fringe. For force a specific fringe width,
3060 specify the width as a negative integer (if both widths are negative,
3061 only the left fringe gets the specified width).
3062
3063 Setting the width to nil (the default), restores the default fringe
3064 width which is the minimum number of pixels necessary to display any
3065 of the currently defined fringe bitmaps. The width of the built-in
3066 fringe bitmaps is 8 pixels.
3067
3068 +++
3069 ** Per-window fringes settings
3070
3071 Windows can now have their own individual fringe widths and position
3072 settings.
3073
3074 To control the fringe widths of a window, either set the buffer-local
3075 variables `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', or call
3076 `set-window-fringes'.
3077
3078 To control the fringe position in a window, that is, whether fringes
3079 are positioned between the display margins and the window's text area,
3080 or at the edges of the window, either set the buffer-local variable
3081 `fringes-outside-margins' or call `set-window-fringes'.
3082
3083 The function `window-fringes' can be used to obtain the current
3084 settings. To make `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', and
3085 `fringes-outside-margins' take effect, you must set them before
3086 displaying the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force
3087 an update of the display margins.
3088
3089 +++
3090 ** Per-window vertical scroll-bar settings
3091
3092 Windows can now have their own individual scroll-bar settings
3093 controlling the width and position of scroll-bars.
3094
3095 To control the scroll-bar of a window, either set the buffer-local
3096 variables `scroll-bar-mode' and `scroll-bar-width', or call
3097 `set-window-scroll-bars'. The function `window-scroll-bars' can be
3098 used to obtain the current settings. To make `scroll-bar-mode' and
3099 `scroll-bar-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
3100 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
3101 of the display margins.
3102
3103 +++
3104 ** The function `set-window-buffer' now has an optional third argument
3105 KEEP-MARGINS which will preserve the window's current margin, fringe,
3106 and scroll-bar settings if non-nil.
3107
3108 +++
3109 ** Renamed file hooks to follow the convention:
3110 find-file-hooks to find-file-hook,
3111 find-file-not-found-hooks to find-file-not-found-functions,
3112 write-file-hooks to write-file-functions,
3113 write-contents-hooks to write-contents-functions.
3114 Marked local-write-file-hooks as obsolete (use the LOCAL arg of `add-hook').
3115
3116 +++
3117 ** The new variable `delete-frame-functions' replaces `delete-frame-hook'.
3118 It was renamed to follow the naming conventions for abnormal hooks. The old
3119 name remains available as an alias, but has been marked obsolete.
3120
3121 +++
3122 ** The `read-file-name' function now takes an additional argument which
3123 specifies a predicate which the file name read must satify. The
3124 new variable `read-file-name-predicate' contains the predicate argument
3125 while reading the file name from the minibuffer; the predicate in this
3126 variable is used by read-file-name-internal to filter the completion list.
3127
3128 ---
3129 ** The new variable `read-file-name-function' can be used by lisp code
3130 to override the internal read-file-name function.
3131
3132
3133 ** The new variable `read-file-name-completion-ignore-case' specifies
3134 whether completion ignores case when reading a file name with the
3135 `read-file-name' function.
3136
3137 +++
3138 ** The new function `read-directory-name' can be used instead of
3139 `read-file-name' to read a directory name; when used, completion
3140 will only show directories.
3141
3142 +++
3143 ** The new function `file-remote-p' tests a file name and returns
3144 non-nil if it specifies a remote file (one that Emacs accesses using
3145 its own special methods and not directly through the file system).
3146
3147 ---
3148 ** When a Lisp file uses CL functions at run-time, compiling the file
3149 now issues warnings about these calls, unless the file performs
3150 (require 'cl) when loaded.
3151
3152 +++
3153 ** The `defmacro' form may contain declarations specifying how to
3154 indent the macro in Lisp mode and how to debug it with Edebug. The
3155 syntax of defmacro has been extended to
3156
3157 (defmacro NAME LAMBDA-LIST [DOC-STRING] [DECLARATION ...] ...)
3158
3159 DECLARATION is a list `(declare DECLARATION-SPECIFIER ...)'. The
3160 declaration specifiers supported are:
3161
3162 (indent INDENT)
3163 Set NAME's `lisp-indent-function' property to INDENT.
3164
3165 (edebug DEBUG)
3166 Set NAME's `edebug-form-spec' property to DEBUG. (This is
3167 equivalent to writing a `def-edebug-spec' for the macro.
3168
3169 +++
3170 ** Interactive commands can be remapped through keymaps.
3171
3172 This is an alternative to using defadvice or substitute-key-definition
3173 to modify the behavior of a key binding using the normal keymap
3174 binding and lookup functionality.
3175
3176 When a key sequence is bound to a command, and that command is
3177 remapped to another command, that command is run instead of the
3178 original command.
3179
3180 Example:
3181 Suppose that minor mode my-mode has defined the commands
3182 my-kill-line and my-kill-word, and it wants C-k (and any other key
3183 bound to kill-line) to run the command my-kill-line instead of
3184 kill-line, and likewise it wants to run my-kill-word instead of
3185 kill-word.
3186
3187 Instead of rebinding C-k and the other keys in the minor mode map,
3188 command remapping allows you to directly map kill-line into
3189 my-kill-line and kill-word into my-kill-word through the minor mode
3190 map using define-key:
3191
3192 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-line] 'my-kill-line)
3193 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-word] 'my-kill-word)
3194
3195 Now, when my-mode is enabled, and the user enters C-k or M-d,
3196 the commands my-kill-line and my-kill-word are run.
3197
3198 Notice that only one level of remapping is supported. In the above
3199 example, this means that if my-kill-line is remapped to other-kill,
3200 then C-k still runs my-kill-line.
3201
3202 The following changes have been made to provide command remapping:
3203
3204 - Command remappings are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
3205 `remap', i.e. `(define-key MAP [remap CMD] DEF)' remaps command CMD
3206 to definition DEF in keymap MAP. The definition is not limited to
3207 another command; it can be anything accepted for a normal binding.
3208
3209 - The new function `command-remapping' returns the binding for a
3210 remapped command in the current keymaps, or nil if not remapped.
3211
3212 - key-binding now remaps interactive commands unless the optional
3213 third argument NO-REMAP is non-nil.
3214
3215 - where-is-internal now returns nil for a remapped command (e.g.
3216 kill-line if my-mode is enabled), and the actual key binding for
3217 the command it is remapped to (e.g. C-k for my-kill-line).
3218 It also has a new optional fifth argument, NO-REMAP, which inhibits
3219 remapping if non-nil (e.g. it returns C-k for kill-line and
3220 <kill-line> for my-kill-line).
3221
3222 - The new variable `this-original-command' contains the original
3223 command before remapping. It is equal to `this-command' when the
3224 command was not remapped.
3225
3226 +++
3227 ** New variable emulation-mode-map-alists.
3228
3229 Lisp packages using many minor mode keymaps can now maintain their own
3230 keymap alist separate from minor-mode-map-alist by adding their keymap
3231 alist to this list.
3232
3233 +++
3234 ** Atomic change groups.
3235
3236 To perform some changes in the current buffer "atomically" so that
3237 they either all succeed or are all undone, use `atomic-change-group'
3238 around the code that makes changes. For instance:
3239
3240 (atomic-change-group
3241 (insert foo)
3242 (delete-region x y))
3243
3244 If an error (or other nonlocal exit) occurs inside the body of
3245 `atomic-change-group', it unmakes all the changes in that buffer that
3246 were during the execution of the body. The change group has no effect
3247 on any other buffers--any such changes remain.
3248
3249 If you need something more sophisticated, you can directly call the
3250 lower-level functions that `atomic-change-group' uses. Here is how.
3251
3252 To set up a change group for one buffer, call `prepare-change-group'.
3253 Specify the buffer as argument; it defaults to the current buffer.
3254 This function returns a "handle" for the change group. You must save
3255 the handle to activate the change group and then finish it.
3256
3257 Before you change the buffer again, you must activate the change
3258 group. Pass the handle to `activate-change-group' afterward to
3259 do this.
3260
3261 After you make the changes, you must finish the change group. You can
3262 either accept the changes or cancel them all. Call
3263 `accept-change-group' to accept the changes in the group as final;
3264 call `cancel-change-group' to undo them all.
3265
3266 You should use `unwind-protect' to make sure the group is always
3267 finished. The call to `activate-change-group' should be inside the
3268 `unwind-protect', in case the user types C-g just after it runs.
3269 (This is one reason why `prepare-change-group' and
3270 `activate-change-group' are separate functions.) Once you finish the
3271 group, don't use the handle again--don't try to finish the same group
3272 twice.
3273
3274 To make a multibuffer change group, call `prepare-change-group' once
3275 for each buffer you want to cover, then use `nconc' to combine the
3276 returned values, like this:
3277
3278 (nconc (prepare-change-group buffer-1)
3279 (prepare-change-group buffer-2))
3280
3281 You can then activate the multibuffer change group with a single call
3282 to `activate-change-group', and finish it with a single call to
3283 `accept-change-group' or `cancel-change-group'.
3284
3285 Nested use of several change groups for the same buffer works as you
3286 would expect. Non-nested use of change groups for the same buffer
3287 will lead to undesirable results, so don't let it happen; the first
3288 change group you start for any given buffer should be the last one
3289 finished.
3290
3291 +++
3292 ** New variable char-property-alias-alist.
3293
3294 This variable allows you to create alternative names for text
3295 properties. It works at the same level as `default-text-properties',
3296 although it applies to overlays as well. This variable was introduced
3297 to implement the `font-lock-face' property.
3298
3299 +++
3300 ** New special text property `font-lock-face'.
3301
3302 This property acts like the `face' property, but it is controlled by
3303 M-x font-lock-mode. It is not, strictly speaking, a builtin text
3304 property. Instead, it is implemented inside font-core.el, using the
3305 new variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
3306
3307 +++
3308 ** New function remove-list-of-text-properties.
3309
3310 The new function `remove-list-of-text-properties' is almost the same
3311 as `remove-text-properties'. The only difference is that it takes
3312 a list of property names as argument rather than a property list.
3313
3314 +++
3315 ** New function insert-for-yank.
3316
3317 This function normally works like `insert' but removes the text
3318 properties in the `yank-excluded-properties' list. However, if the
3319 inserted text has a `yank-handler' text property on the first
3320 character of the string, the insertion of the text may be modified in
3321 a number of ways. See the description of `yank-handler' below.
3322
3323 +++
3324 ** New function insert-buffer-substring-as-yank.
3325
3326 This function works like `insert-buffer-substring', but removes the
3327 text properties in the `yank-excluded-properties' list.
3328
3329 +++
3330 ** New function insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
3331
3332 This function is like insert-buffer-substring, but removes all
3333 text properties from the inserted substring.
3334
3335 +++
3336 ** New `yank-handler' text property may be used to control how
3337 previously killed text on the kill-ring is reinserted.
3338
3339 The value of the yank-handler property must be a list with one to four
3340 elements with the following format:
3341 (FUNCTION PARAM NOEXCLUDE UNDO).
3342
3343 The `insert-for-yank' function looks for a yank-handler property on
3344 the first character on its string argument (typically the first
3345 element on the kill-ring). If a yank-handler property is found,
3346 the normal behaviour of `insert-for-yank' is modified in various ways:
3347
3348 When FUNCTION is present and non-nil, it is called instead of `insert'
3349 to insert the string. FUNCTION takes one argument--the object to insert.
3350 If PARAM is present and non-nil, it replaces STRING as the object
3351 passed to FUNCTION (or `insert'); for example, if FUNCTION is
3352 `yank-rectangle', PARAM should be a list of strings to insert as a
3353 rectangle.
3354 If NOEXCLUDE is present and non-nil, the normal removal of the
3355 yank-excluded-properties is not performed; instead FUNCTION is
3356 responsible for removing those properties. This may be necessary
3357 if FUNCTION adjusts point before or after inserting the object.
3358 If UNDO is present and non-nil, it is a function that will be called
3359 by `yank-pop' to undo the insertion of the current object. It is
3360 called with two arguments, the start and end of the current region.
3361 FUNCTION may set `yank-undo-function' to override the UNDO value.
3362
3363 *** The functions kill-new, kill-append, and kill-region now have an
3364 optional argument to specify the yank-handler text property to put on
3365 the killed text.
3366
3367 *** The function yank-pop will now use a non-nil value of the variable
3368 `yank-undo-function' (instead of delete-region) to undo the previous
3369 yank or yank-pop command (or a call to insert-for-yank). The function
3370 insert-for-yank automatically sets that variable according to the UNDO
3371 element of the string argument's yank-handler text property if present.
3372
3373 +++
3374 ** New function display-supports-face-attributes-p may be used to test
3375 whether a given set of face attributes is actually displayable.
3376
3377 A new predicate `supports' has also been added to the `defface' face
3378 specification language, which can be used to do this test for faces
3379 defined with defface.
3380
3381 ** The function face-differs-from-default-p now truly checks whether the
3382 given face displays differently from the default face or not (previously
3383 it did only a very cursory check).
3384
3385 +++
3386 ** face-attribute, face-foreground, face-background, and face-stipple now
3387 accept a new optional argument, INHERIT, which controls how face
3388 inheritance is used when determining the value of a face attribute.
3389
3390 +++
3391 ** New functions face-attribute-relative-p and merge-face-attribute
3392 help with handling relative face attributes.
3393
3394 ** The priority of faces in an :inherit attribute face-list is reversed.
3395 If a face contains an :inherit attribute with a list of faces, earlier
3396 faces in the list override later faces in the list; in previous releases
3397 of Emacs, the order was the opposite. This change was made so that
3398 :inherit face-lists operate identically to face-lists in text `face'
3399 properties.
3400
3401 +++
3402 ** Enhancements to process support
3403
3404 *** Function list-processes now has an optional argument; if non-nil,
3405 only the processes whose query-on-exit flag is set are listed.
3406
3407 *** New set-process-query-on-exit-flag and process-query-on-exit-flag
3408 functions. The existing process-kill-without-query function is still
3409 supported, but new code should use the new functions.
3410
3411 *** Function signal-process now accepts a process object or process
3412 name in addition to a process id to identify the signalled process.
3413
3414 *** Processes now have an associated property list where programs can
3415 maintain process state and other per-process related information.
3416
3417 The new functions process-get and process-put are used to access, add,
3418 and modify elements on this property list.
3419
3420 The new low-level functions process-plist and set-process-plist are
3421 used to access and replace the entire property list of a process.
3422
3423 *** Function accept-process-output now has an optional fourth arg
3424 `just-this-one'. If non-nil, only output from the specified process
3425 is handled, suspending output from other processes. If value is an
3426 integer, also inhibit running timers. This feature is generally not
3427 recommended, but may be necessary for specific applications, such as
3428 speech synthesis.
3429
3430 *** Adaptive read buffering of subprocess output.
3431
3432 On some systems, when emacs reads the output from a subprocess, the
3433 output data is read in very small blocks, potentially resulting in
3434 very poor performance. This behaviour can be remedied to some extent
3435 by setting the new variable process-adaptive-read-buffering to a
3436 non-nil value (the default), as it will automatically delay reading
3437 from such processes, to allowing them to produce more output before
3438 emacs tries to read it.
3439
3440 +++
3441 ** Enhanced networking support.
3442
3443 *** There is a new `make-network-process' function which supports
3444 opening of stream and datagram connections to a server, as well as
3445 create a stream or datagram server inside emacs.
3446
3447 - A server is started using :server t arg.
3448 - Datagram connection is selected using :type 'datagram arg.
3449 - A server can open on a random port using :service t arg.
3450 - Local sockets are supported using :family 'local arg.
3451 - Non-blocking connect is supported using :nowait t arg.
3452 - The process' property list may be initialized using :plist PLIST arg;
3453 a copy of the server process' property list is automatically inherited
3454 by new client processes created to handle incoming connections.
3455
3456 To test for the availability of a given feature, use featurep like this:
3457 (featurep 'make-network-process '(:type datagram))
3458
3459 *** Original open-network-stream is now emulated using make-network-process.
3460
3461 *** New function open-network-stream-nowait.
3462
3463 This function initiates a non-blocking connect and returns immediately
3464 without waiting for the connection to be established. It takes the
3465 filter and sentinel functions as arguments; when the non-blocking
3466 connect completes, the sentinel is called with a status string
3467 matching "open" or "failed".
3468
3469 *** New function open-network-stream-server.
3470
3471 This function creates a network server process for a TCP service.
3472 When a client connects to the specified service, a new subprocess
3473 is created to handle the new connection, and the sentinel function
3474 is called for the new process.
3475
3476 *** New functions process-datagram-address and set-process-datagram-address.
3477
3478 These functions are used with datagram-based network processes to get
3479 and set the current address of the remote partner.
3480
3481 *** New function format-network-address.
3482
3483 This function reformats the lisp representation of a network address
3484 to a printable string. For example, an IP address A.B.C.D and port
3485 number P is represented as a five element vector [A B C D P], and the
3486 printable string returned for this vector is "A.B.C.D:P". See the doc
3487 string for other formatting options.
3488
3489 *** By default, the function process-contact still returns (HOST SERVICE)
3490 for a network process. Using the new optional KEY arg, the complete list
3491 of network process properties or a specific property can be selected.
3492
3493 Using :local and :remote as the KEY, the address of the local or
3494 remote end-point is returned. An Inet address is represented as a 5
3495 element vector, where the first 4 elements contain the IP address and
3496 the fifth is the port number.
3497
3498 *** Network processes can now be stopped and restarted with
3499 `stop-process' and `continue-process'. For a server process, no
3500 connections are accepted in the stopped state. For a client process,
3501 no input is received in the stopped state.
3502
3503 *** New function network-interface-list.
3504
3505 This function returns a list of network interface names and their
3506 current network addresses.
3507
3508 *** New function network-interface-info.
3509
3510 This function returns the network address, hardware address, current
3511 status, and other information about a specific network interface.
3512
3513 +++
3514 ** New function copy-tree.
3515
3516 +++
3517 ** New function substring-no-properties.
3518
3519 +++
3520 ** New function minibuffer-selected-window.
3521
3522 +++
3523 ** New function `call-process-shell-command'.
3524
3525 ** New function `process-file'.
3526
3527 This is similar to `call-process', but obeys file handlers. The file
3528 handler is chosen based on default-directory.
3529
3530 ---
3531 ** The dummy function keys made by easymenu
3532 are now always lower case. If you specify the
3533 menu item name "Ada", for instance, it uses `ada'
3534 as the "key" bound by that key binding.
3535
3536 This is relevant only if Lisp code looks for
3537 the bindings that were made with easymenu.
3538
3539 +++
3540 ** The function `commandp' takes an additional optional
3541 argument. If it is non-nil, then `commandp' checks
3542 for a function that could be called with `call-interactively',
3543 and does not return t for keyboard macros.
3544
3545 ---
3546 ** master-mode.el implements a minor mode for scrolling a slave
3547 buffer without leaving your current buffer, the master buffer.
3548
3549 It can be used by sql.el, for example: the SQL buffer is the master
3550 and its SQLi buffer is the slave. This allows you to scroll the SQLi
3551 buffer containing the output from the SQL buffer containing the
3552 commands.
3553
3554 This is how to use sql.el and master.el together: the variable
3555 sql-buffer contains the slave buffer. It is a local variable in the
3556 SQL buffer.
3557
3558 (add-hook 'sql-mode-hook
3559 (function (lambda ()
3560 (master-mode t)
3561 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
3562 (add-hook 'sql-set-sqli-hook
3563 (function (lambda ()
3564 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
3565
3566 +++
3567 ** File local variables.
3568
3569 A file local variables list cannot specify a string with text
3570 properties--any specified text properties are discarded.
3571
3572 +++
3573 ** New function window-body-height.
3574
3575 This is like window-height but does not count the mode line
3576 or the header line.
3577
3578 +++
3579 ** New function format-mode-line.
3580
3581 This returns the mode-line or header-line of the selected (or a
3582 specified) window as a string with or without text properties.
3583
3584 +++
3585 ** New functions `lax-plist-get' and `lax-plist-put'.
3586
3587 These functions are like `plist-get' and `plist-put' except that they
3588 compare the property name using `equal' rather than `eq'.
3589
3590 +++
3591 ** New function `tool-bar-local-item-from-menu'
3592
3593 The `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' must not be used (as previously
3594 recommended) for making entries in the tool bar for local keymaps.
3595 Instead, use the function `tool-bar-local-item-from-menu', which lets
3596 you specify the map to use as an argument.
3597
3598 +++
3599 ** The function `atan' now accepts an optional second argument.
3600
3601 When called with 2 arguments, as in `(atan Y X)', `atan' returns the
3602 angle in radians between the vector [X, Y] and the X axis. (This is
3603 equivalent to the standard C library function `atan2'.)
3604
3605 +++
3606 ** You can now make a window as short as one line.
3607
3608 A window that is just one line tall does not display either a mode
3609 line or a header line, even if the variables `mode-line-format' and
3610 `header-line-format' call for them. A window that is two lines tall
3611 cannot display both a mode line and a header line at once; if the
3612 variables call for both, only the mode line actually appears.
3613
3614 +++
3615 ** The new frame parameter `tty-color-mode' specifies the mode to use
3616 for color support on character terminal frames. Its value can be a
3617 number of colors to support, or a symbol. See the Emacs Lisp
3618 Reference manual for more detailed documentation.
3619
3620 +++
3621 ** The new mode-line construct `(:propertize ELT PROPS...)' can be
3622 used to add text properties to mode-line elements.
3623
3624 +++
3625 ** Mode line display ignores text properties as well as the
3626 :propertize and :eval forms in the value of a variable whose
3627 `risky-local-variable' property is nil.
3628
3629 +++
3630 ** The new `%i' and `%I' constructs for `mode-line-format' can be used
3631 to display the size of the accessible part of the buffer on the mode
3632 line.
3633
3634 ---
3635 ** Indentation of simple and extended loop forms has been added to the
3636 cl-indent package. The new user options
3637 `lisp-loop-keyword-indentation', `lisp-loop-forms-indentation', and
3638 `lisp-simple-loop-indentation' can be used to customize the
3639 indentation of keywords and forms in loop forms.
3640
3641 ---
3642 ** Indentation of backquoted forms has been made customizable in the
3643 cl-indent package. See the new user option `lisp-backquote-indentation'.
3644
3645 +++
3646 ** Already true in Emacs 21.1, but not emphasized clearly enough:
3647
3648 Multibyte buffers can now faithfully record all 256 character codes
3649 from 0 to 255. As a result, most of the past reasons to use unibyte
3650 buffers no longer exist. We only know of three reasons to use them
3651 now:
3652
3653 1. If you prefer to use unibyte text all of the time.
3654
3655 2. For reading files into temporary buffers, when you want to avoid
3656 the time it takes to convert the format.
3657
3658 3. For binary files where format conversion would be pointless and
3659 wasteful.
3660
3661 +++
3662 ** If text has a `keymap' property, that keymap takes precedence
3663 over minor mode keymaps.
3664
3665 +++
3666 ** A hex escape in a string forces the string to be multibyte.
3667 An octal escape makes it unibyte.
3668
3669 +++
3670 ** At the end of a command, point moves out from within invisible
3671 text, in the same way it moves out from within text covered by an
3672 image or composition property.
3673
3674 This makes it generally unnecessary to mark invisible text as intangible.
3675 This is particularly good because the intangible property often has
3676 unexpected side-effects since the property applies to everything
3677 (including `goto-char', ...) whereas this new code is only run after
3678 post-command-hook and thus does not care about intermediate states.
3679
3680 +++
3681 ** field-beginning and field-end now accept an additional optional
3682 argument, LIMIT.
3683
3684 +++
3685 ** define-abbrev now accepts an optional argument SYSTEM-FLAG. If
3686 non-nil, this marks the abbrev as a "system" abbrev, which means that
3687 it won't be stored in the user's abbrevs file if he saves the abbrevs.
3688 Major modes that predefine some abbrevs should always specify this
3689 flag.
3690
3691 ---
3692 ** Support for Mocklisp has been removed.
3693
3694 ---
3695 ** The function insert-string is now obsolete.
3696
3697 ---
3698 ** The precedence of file-name-handlers has been changed.
3699 Instead of blindly choosing the first handler that matches,
3700 find-file-name-handler now gives precedence to a file-name handler
3701 that matches near the end of the file name. More specifically, the
3702 handler whose (match-beginning 0) is the largest is chosen.
3703 In case of ties, the old "first matched" rule applies.
3704
3705 ---
3706 ** Dense keymaps now handle inheritance correctly.
3707 Previously a dense keymap would hide all of the simple-char key
3708 bindings of the parent keymap.
3709
3710 ---
3711 ** jit-lock obeys a new text-property `jit-lock-defer-multiline'.
3712 If a piece of text with that property gets contextually refontified
3713 (see jit-lock-defer-contextually), then all of that text will
3714 be refontified. This is useful when the syntax of a textual element
3715 depends on text several lines further down (and when font-lock-multiline
3716 is not appropriate to solve that problem). For example in Perl:
3717
3718 s{
3719 foo
3720 }{
3721 bar
3722 }e
3723
3724 Adding/removing the last `e' changes the `bar' from being a piece of
3725 text to being a piece of code, so you'd put a jit-lock-defer-multiline
3726 property over the second half of the command to force (deferred)
3727 refontification of `bar' whenever the `e' is added/removed.
3728
3729 ---
3730 ** describe-vector now takes a second argument `describer' which is
3731 called to print the entries' values. It defaults to `princ'.
3732
3733 ** defcustom and other custom declarations now use a default group
3734 (the last prior group defined in the same file) when no :group was given.
3735
3736 +++
3737 ** emacsserver now runs pre-command-hook and post-command-hook when
3738 it receives a request from emacsclient.
3739
3740 ---
3741 ** The variable `recursive-load-depth-limit' has been deleted.
3742 Emacs now signals an error if the same file is loaded with more
3743 than 3 levels of nesting.
3744
3745 ---
3746 ** If a major mode function has a non-nil `no-clone-indirect'
3747 property, `clone-indirect-buffer' signals an error if you use
3748 it in that buffer.
3749
3750 ---
3751 ** In `replace-match', the replacement text no longer inherits
3752 properties from surrounding text.
3753
3754 +++
3755 ** The list returned by `(match-data t)' now has the buffer as a final
3756 element, if the last match was on a buffer. `set-match-data'
3757 accepts such a list for restoring the match state.
3758
3759 +++
3760 ** New function `buffer-local-value'.
3761
3762 This function returns the buffer-local binding of VARIABLE (a symbol)
3763 in buffer BUFFER. If VARIABLE does not have a buffer-local binding in
3764 buffer BUFFER, it returns the default value of VARIABLE instead.
3765
3766 ---
3767 ** New function `text-clone-create'. Text clones are chunks of text
3768 that are kept identical by transparently propagating changes from one
3769 clone to the other.
3770
3771 +++
3772 ** font-lock can manage arbitrary text-properties beside `face'.
3773 *** the FACENAME returned in font-lock-keywords can be a list
3774 of the form (face FACE PROP1 VAL1 PROP2 VAL2 ...) so you can set
3775 other properties than `face'.
3776 *** font-lock-extra-managed-props can be set to make sure those extra
3777 properties are automatically cleaned up by font-lock.
3778
3779 ---
3780 ** The special treatment of faces whose names are of the form `fg:COLOR'
3781 or `bg:COLOR' has been removed. Lisp programs should use the
3782 `defface' facility for defining faces with specific colors, or use
3783 the feature of specifying the face attributes :foreground and :background
3784 directly in the `face' property instead of using a named face.
3785
3786 +++
3787 ** The new function `run-mode-hooks' and the new macro `delay-mode-hooks'
3788 are used by define-derived-mode to make sure the mode hook for the
3789 parent mode is run at the end of the child mode.
3790
3791 +++
3792 ** define-minor-mode now accepts arbitrary additional keyword arguments
3793 and simply passes them to defcustom, if applicable.
3794
3795 +++
3796 ** define-derived-mode by default creates a new empty abbrev table.
3797 It does not copy abbrevs from the parent mode's abbrev table.
3798
3799 +++
3800 ** `provide' and `featurep' now accept an optional second argument
3801 to test/provide subfeatures. Also `provide' now checks `after-load-alist'
3802 and runs any code associated with the provided feature.
3803
3804 +++
3805 ** Functions `file-name-sans-extension' and `file-name-extension' now
3806 ignore the leading dots in file names, so that file names such as
3807 `.emacs' are treated as extensionless.
3808
3809 +++
3810 ** Functions `user-uid' and `user-real-uid' now return floats if the
3811 user UID doesn't fit in a Lisp integer. Function `user-full-name'
3812 accepts a float as UID parameter.
3813
3814 ---
3815 ** `define-key-after' now accepts keys longer than 1.
3816
3817 +++
3818 ** The local variable `no-byte-compile' in elisp files is now obeyed.
3819
3820 +++
3821 ** The Emacs Lisp byte-compiler now displays the actual line and
3822 character position of errors, where possible. Additionally, the form
3823 of its warning and error messages have been brought more in line with
3824 the output of other GNU tools.
3825
3826 +++
3827 ** New functions `keymap-prompt' and `current-active-maps'.
3828
3829 ---
3830 ** New function `describe-buffer-bindings'.
3831
3832 +++
3833 ** New vars `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' used when
3834 searching for an executable resp. an elisp file.
3835
3836 +++
3837 ** Variable aliases have been implemented:
3838
3839 *** defvaralias ALIAS-VAR BASE-VAR [DOCSTRING]
3840
3841 This function defines the symbol ALIAS-VAR as a variable alias for
3842 symbol BASE-VAR. This means that retrieving the value of ALIAS-VAR
3843 returns the value of BASE-VAR, and changing the value of ALIAS-VAR
3844 changes the value of BASE-VAR.
3845
3846 DOCSTRING, if present, is the documentation for ALIAS-VAR; else it has
3847 the same documentation as BASE-VAR.
3848
3849 *** indirect-variable VARIABLE
3850
3851 This function returns the variable at the end of the chain of aliases
3852 of VARIABLE. If VARIABLE is not a symbol, or if VARIABLE is not
3853 defined as an alias, the function returns VARIABLE.
3854
3855 It might be noteworthy that variables aliases work for all kinds of
3856 variables, including buffer-local and frame-local variables.
3857
3858 +++
3859 ** Functions from `post-gc-hook' are run at the end of garbage
3860 collection. The hook is run with GC inhibited, so use it with care.
3861
3862 +++
3863 ** If the second argument to `copy-file' is the name of a directory,
3864 the file is copied to that directory instead of signaling an error.
3865
3866 +++
3867 ** The variables most-positive-fixnum and most-negative-fixnum
3868 hold the largest and smallest possible integer values.
3869
3870 ---
3871 ** On MS Windows, locale-coding-system is used to interact with the OS.
3872 The Windows specific variable w32-system-coding-system, which was
3873 formerly used for that purpose is now an alias for locale-coding-system.
3874
3875 ** Functions y-or-n-p, read-char, read-key-sequence and the like, that
3876 display a prompt but don't use the minibuffer, now display the prompt
3877 using the text properties (esp. the face) of the prompt string.
3878
3879 ** New function x-send-client-message sends a client message when
3880 running under X.
3881
3882 ** Arguments for remove-overlays are now optional, so that you can remove
3883 all overlays in the buffer by just calling (remove-overlay).
3884
3885 ** New packages:
3886
3887 *** The new package gdb-ui.el provides an enhanced graphical interface to
3888 GDB. You can interact with GDB through the GUD buffer in the usual way, but
3889 there are also further buffers which control the execution and describe the
3890 state of your program. It separates the input/output of your program from
3891 that of GDB and watches expressions in the speedbar. It also uses features of
3892 Emacs 21 such as the display margin for breakpoints, and the toolbar.
3893
3894 Use M-x gdba to start GDB-UI.
3895
3896 *** The new package syntax.el provides an efficient way to find the
3897 current syntactic context (as returned by parse-partial-sexp).
3898
3899 *** The new package bindat.el provides functions to unpack and pack
3900 binary data structures, such as network packets, to and from Lisp
3901 data structures.
3902
3903 *** The TCL package tcl-mode.el was replaced by tcl.el.
3904 This was actually done in Emacs-21.1, and was not documented.
3905
3906 *** The new package button.el implements simple and fast `clickable buttons'
3907 in emacs buffers. `buttons' are much lighter-weight than the `widgets'
3908 implemented by widget.el, and can be used by lisp code that doesn't
3909 require the full power of widgets. Emacs uses buttons for such things
3910 as help and apropos buffers.
3911
3912 \f
3913 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.3
3914
3915 ** Support for GNU/Linux on little-endian MIPS and on IBM S390 has
3916 been added.
3917
3918 \f
3919 * Changes in Emacs 21.3
3920
3921 ** The obsolete C mode (c-mode.el) has been removed to avoid problems
3922 with Custom.
3923
3924 ** UTF-16 coding systems are available, encoding the same characters
3925 as mule-utf-8.
3926
3927 ** There is a new language environment for UTF-8 (set up automatically
3928 in UTF-8 locales).
3929
3930 ** Translation tables are available between equivalent characters in
3931 different Emacs charsets -- for instance `e with acute' coming from the
3932 Latin-1 and Latin-2 charsets. User options `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode'
3933 and `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' respectively turn on translation
3934 between ISO 8859 character sets (`unification') on encoding
3935 (e.g. writing a file) and decoding (e.g. reading a file). Note that
3936 `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is useful and safe, but
3937 `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' can cause text to change when you read
3938 it and write it out again without edits, so it is not generally advisable.
3939 By default `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is turned on.
3940
3941 ** In Emacs running on the X window system, the default value of
3942 `selection-coding-system' is now `compound-text-with-extensions'.
3943
3944 If you want the old behavior, set selection-coding-system to
3945 compound-text, which may be significantly more efficient. Using
3946 compound-text-with-extensions seems to be necessary only for decoding
3947 text from applications under XFree86 4.2, whose behaviour is actually
3948 contrary to the compound text specification.
3949
3950 \f
3951 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.2
3952
3953 ** Support for BSD/OS 5.0 has been added.
3954
3955 ** Support for AIX 5.1 was added.
3956
3957 \f
3958 * Changes in Emacs 21.2
3959
3960 ** Emacs now supports compound-text extended segments in X selections.
3961
3962 X applications can use `extended segments' to encode characters in
3963 compound text that belong to character sets which are not part of the
3964 list of approved standard encodings for X, e.g. Big5. To paste
3965 selections with such characters into Emacs, use the new coding system
3966 compound-text-with-extensions as the value of selection-coding-system.
3967
3968 ** The default values of `tooltip-delay' and `tooltip-hide-delay'
3969 were changed.
3970
3971 ** On terminals whose erase-char is ^H (Backspace), Emacs
3972 now uses normal-erase-is-backspace-mode.
3973
3974 ** When the *scratch* buffer is recreated, its mode is set from
3975 initial-major-mode, which normally is lisp-interaction-mode,
3976 instead of using default-major-mode.
3977
3978 ** The new option `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' causes Info to behave
3979 like the stand-alone Info reader (from the GNU Texinfo package) as far
3980 as motion between nodes and their subnodes is concerned. If it is t
3981 (the default), Emacs behaves as before when you type SPC in a menu: it
3982 visits the subnode pointed to by the first menu entry. If this option
3983 is nil, SPC scrolls to the end of the current node, and only then goes
3984 to the first menu item, like the stand-alone reader does.
3985
3986 This change was already in Emacs 21.1, but wasn't advertised in the
3987 NEWS.
3988
3989 \f
3990 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 21.2
3991
3992 ** The meanings of scroll-up-aggressively and scroll-down-aggressively
3993 have been interchanged, so that the former now controls scrolling up,
3994 and the latter now controls scrolling down.
3995
3996 ** The variable `compilation-parse-errors-filename-function' can
3997 be used to transform filenames found in compilation output.
3998
3999 \f
4000 * Installation Changes in Emacs 21.1
4001
4002 See the INSTALL file for information on installing extra libraries and
4003 fonts to take advantage of the new graphical features and extra
4004 charsets in this release.
4005
4006 ** Support for GNU/Linux on IA64 machines has been added.
4007
4008 ** Support for LynxOS has been added.
4009
4010 ** There are new configure options associated with the support for
4011 images and toolkit scrollbars. Use the --help option in `configure'
4012 to list them.
4013
4014 ** You can build a 64-bit Emacs for SPARC/Solaris systems which
4015 support 64-bit executables and also on Irix 6.5. This increases the
4016 maximum buffer size. See etc/MACHINES for instructions. Changes to
4017 build on other 64-bit systems should be straightforward modulo any
4018 necessary changes to unexec.
4019
4020 ** There is a new configure option `--disable-largefile' to omit
4021 Unix-98-style support for large files if that is available.
4022
4023 ** There is a new configure option `--without-xim' that instructs
4024 Emacs to not use X Input Methods (XIM), if these are available.
4025
4026 ** `movemail' defaults to supporting POP. You can turn this off using
4027 the --without-pop configure option, should that be necessary.
4028
4029 ** This version can be built for the Macintosh, but does not implement
4030 all of the new display features described below. The port currently
4031 lacks unexec, asynchronous processes, and networking support. See the
4032 "Emacs and the Mac OS" appendix in the Emacs manual, for the
4033 description of aspects specific to the Mac.
4034
4035 ** Note that the MS-Windows port does not yet implement various of the
4036 new display features described below.
4037
4038 \f
4039 * Changes in Emacs 21.1
4040
4041 ** Emacs has a new redisplay engine.
4042
4043 The new redisplay handles characters of variable width and height.
4044 Italic text can be used without redisplay problems. Fonts containing
4045 oversized characters, i.e. characters larger than the logical height
4046 of a font can be used. Images of various formats can be displayed in
4047 the text.
4048
4049 ** Emacs has a new face implementation.
4050
4051 The new faces no longer fundamentally use X font names to specify the
4052 font. Instead, each face has several independent attributes--family,
4053 height, width, weight and slant--that it may or may not specify.
4054 These attributes can be merged from various faces, and then together
4055 specify a font.
4056
4057 Faces are supported on terminals that can display color or fonts.
4058 These terminal capabilities are auto-detected. Details can be found
4059 under Lisp changes, below.
4060
4061 ** Emacs can display faces on TTY frames.
4062
4063 Emacs automatically detects terminals that are able to display colors.
4064 Faces with a weight greater than normal are displayed extra-bright, if
4065 the terminal supports it. Faces with a weight less than normal and
4066 italic faces are displayed dimmed, if the terminal supports it.
4067 Underlined faces are displayed underlined if possible. Other face
4068 attributes such as `overline', `strike-through', and `box' are ignored
4069 on terminals.
4070
4071 The command-line options `-fg COLOR', `-bg COLOR', and `-rv' are now
4072 supported on character terminals.
4073
4074 Emacs automatically remaps all X-style color specifications to one of
4075 the colors supported by the terminal. This means you could have the
4076 same color customizations that work both on a windowed display and on
4077 a TTY or when Emacs is invoked with the -nw option.
4078
4079 ** New default font is Courier 12pt under X.
4080
4081 ** Sound support
4082
4083 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and FreeBSD (Voxware
4084 driver and native BSD driver, a.k.a. Luigi's driver). Currently
4085 supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio (*.au).
4086 You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes' to enable
4087 sound support.
4088
4089 ** Emacs now resizes mini-windows if appropriate.
4090
4091 If a message is longer than one line, or minibuffer contents are
4092 longer than one line, Emacs can resize the minibuffer window unless it
4093 is on a frame of its own. You can control resizing and the maximum
4094 minibuffer window size by setting the following variables:
4095
4096 - User option: max-mini-window-height
4097
4098 Maximum height for resizing mini-windows. If a float, it specifies a
4099 fraction of the mini-window frame's height. If an integer, it
4100 specifies a number of lines.
4101
4102 Default is 0.25.
4103
4104 - User option: resize-mini-windows
4105
4106 How to resize mini-windows. If nil, don't resize. If t, always
4107 resize to fit the size of the text. If `grow-only', let mini-windows
4108 grow only, until they become empty, at which point they are shrunk
4109 again.
4110
4111 Default is `grow-only'.
4112
4113 ** LessTif support.
4114
4115 Emacs now runs with the LessTif toolkit (see
4116 <http://www.lesstif.org>). You will need version 0.92.26, or later.
4117
4118 ** LessTif/Motif file selection dialog.
4119
4120 When Emacs is configured to use LessTif or Motif, reading a file name
4121 from a menu will pop up a file selection dialog if `use-dialog-box' is
4122 non-nil.
4123
4124 ** File selection dialog on MS-Windows is supported.
4125
4126 When a file is visited by clicking File->Open, the MS-Windows version
4127 now pops up a standard file selection dialog where you can select a
4128 file to visit. File->Save As also pops up that dialog.
4129
4130 ** Toolkit scroll bars.
4131
4132 Emacs now uses toolkit scroll bars if available. When configured for
4133 LessTif/Motif, it will use that toolkit's scroll bar. Otherwise, when
4134 configured for Lucid and Athena widgets, it will use the Xaw3d scroll
4135 bar if Xaw3d is available. You can turn off the use of toolkit scroll
4136 bars by specifying `--with-toolkit-scroll-bars=no' when configuring
4137 Emacs.
4138
4139 When you encounter problems with the Xaw3d scroll bar, watch out how
4140 Xaw3d is compiled on your system. If the Makefile generated from
4141 Xaw3d's Imakefile contains a `-DNARROWPROTO' compiler option, and your
4142 Emacs system configuration file `s/your-system.h' does not contain a
4143 define for NARROWPROTO, you might consider adding it. Take
4144 `s/freebsd.h' as an example.
4145
4146 Alternatively, if you don't have access to the Xaw3d source code, take
4147 a look at your system's imake configuration file, for example in the
4148 directory `/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/config' (paths are different on
4149 different systems). You will find files `*.cf' there. If your
4150 system's cf-file contains a line like `#define NeedWidePrototypes NO',
4151 add a `#define NARROWPROTO' to your Emacs system configuration file.
4152
4153 The reason for this is that one Xaw3d function uses `double' or
4154 `float' function parameters depending on the setting of NARROWPROTO.
4155 This is not a problem when Imakefiles are used because each system's
4156 imake configuration file contains the necessary information. Since
4157 Emacs doesn't use imake, this has do be done manually.
4158
4159 ** Tool bar support.
4160
4161 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. For details
4162 of how to define a tool bar, see the page describing Lisp-level
4163 changes. Tool-bar global minor mode controls whether or not it is
4164 displayed and is on by default. The appearance of the bar is improved
4165 if Emacs has been built with XPM image support. Otherwise monochrome
4166 icons will be used.
4167
4168 To make the tool bar more useful, we need contributions of extra icons
4169 for specific modes (with copyright assignments).
4170
4171 ** Tooltips.
4172
4173 Tooltips are small X windows displaying a help string at the current
4174 mouse position. The Lisp package `tooltip' implements them. You can
4175 turn them off via the user option `tooltip-mode'.
4176
4177 Tooltips also provides support for GUD debugging. If activated,
4178 variable values can be displayed in tooltips by pointing at them with
4179 the mouse in source buffers. You can customize various aspects of the
4180 tooltip display in the group `tooltip'.
4181
4182 ** Automatic Hscrolling
4183
4184 Horizontal scrolling now happens automatically if
4185 `automatic-hscrolling' is set (the default). This setting can be
4186 customized.
4187
4188 If a window is scrolled horizontally with set-window-hscroll, or
4189 scroll-left/scroll-right (C-x <, C-x >), this serves as a lower bound
4190 for automatic horizontal scrolling. Automatic scrolling will scroll
4191 the text more to the left if necessary, but won't scroll the text more
4192 to the right than the column set with set-window-hscroll etc.
4193
4194 ** When using a windowing terminal, each Emacs window now has a cursor
4195 of its own. By default, when a window is selected, the cursor is
4196 solid; otherwise, it is hollow. The user-option
4197 `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' controls how to display the
4198 cursor in non-selected windows. If nil, no cursor is shown, if
4199 non-nil a hollow box cursor is shown.
4200
4201 ** Fringes to the left and right of windows are used to display
4202 truncation marks, continuation marks, overlay arrows and alike. The
4203 foreground, background, and stipple of these areas can be changed by
4204 customizing face `fringe'.
4205
4206 ** The mode line under X is now drawn with shadows by default.
4207 You can change its appearance by modifying the face `mode-line'.
4208 In particular, setting the `:box' attribute to nil turns off the 3D
4209 appearance of the mode line. (The 3D appearance makes the mode line
4210 occupy more space, and thus might cause the first or the last line of
4211 the window to be partially obscured.)
4212
4213 The variable `mode-line-inverse-video', which was used in older
4214 versions of emacs to make the mode-line stand out, is now deprecated.
4215 However, setting it to nil will cause the `mode-line' face to be
4216 ignored, and mode-lines to be drawn using the default text face.
4217
4218 ** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
4219
4220 Different parts of the mode line have been made mouse-sensitive on all
4221 systems which support the mouse. Moving the mouse to a
4222 mouse-sensitive part in the mode line changes the appearance of the
4223 mouse pointer to an arrow, and help about available mouse actions is
4224 displayed either in the echo area, or in the tooltip window if you
4225 have enabled one.
4226
4227 Currently, the following actions have been defined:
4228
4229 - Mouse-1 on the buffer name in the mode line goes to the next buffer.
4230
4231 - Mouse-3 on the buffer-name goes to the previous buffer.
4232
4233 - Mouse-2 on the read-only or modified status in the mode line (`%' or
4234 `*') toggles the status.
4235
4236 - Mouse-3 on the mode name displays a minor-mode menu.
4237
4238 ** Hourglass pointer
4239
4240 Emacs can optionally display an hourglass pointer under X. You can
4241 turn the display on or off by customizing group `cursor'.
4242
4243 ** Blinking cursor
4244
4245 M-x blink-cursor-mode toggles a blinking cursor under X and on
4246 terminals having terminal capabilities `vi', `vs', and `ve'. Blinking
4247 and related parameters like frequency and delay can be customized in
4248 the group `cursor'.
4249
4250 ** New font-lock support mode `jit-lock-mode'.
4251
4252 This support mode is roughly equivalent to `lazy-lock' but is
4253 generally faster. It supports stealth and deferred fontification.
4254 See the documentation of the function `jit-lock-mode' for more
4255 details.
4256
4257 Font-lock uses jit-lock-mode as default support mode, so you don't
4258 have to do anything to activate it.
4259
4260 ** The default binding of the Delete key has changed.
4261
4262 The new user-option `normal-erase-is-backspace' can be set to
4263 determine the effect of the Delete and Backspace function keys.
4264
4265 On window systems, the default value of this option is chosen
4266 according to the keyboard used. If the keyboard has both a Backspace
4267 key and a Delete key, and both are mapped to their usual meanings, the
4268 option's default value is set to t, so that Backspace can be used to
4269 delete backward, and Delete can be used to delete forward. On
4270 keyboards which either have only one key (usually labeled DEL), or two
4271 keys DEL and BS which produce the same effect, the option's value is
4272 set to nil, and these keys delete backward.
4273
4274 If not running under a window system, setting this option accomplishes
4275 a similar effect by mapping C-h, which is usually generated by the
4276 Backspace key, to DEL, and by mapping DEL to C-d via
4277 `keyboard-translate'. The former functionality of C-h is available on
4278 the F1 key. You should probably not use this setting on a text-only
4279 terminal if you don't have both Backspace, Delete and F1 keys.
4280
4281 Programmatically, you can call function normal-erase-is-backspace-mode
4282 to toggle the behavior of the Delete and Backspace keys.
4283
4284 ** The default for user-option `next-line-add-newlines' has been
4285 changed to nil, i.e. C-n will no longer add newlines at the end of a
4286 buffer by default.
4287
4288 ** The <home> and <end> keys now move to the beginning or end of the
4289 current line, respectively. C-<home> and C-<end> move to the
4290 beginning and end of the buffer.
4291
4292 ** Emacs now checks for recursive loads of Lisp files. If the
4293 recursion depth exceeds `recursive-load-depth-limit', an error is
4294 signaled.
4295
4296 ** When an error is signaled during the loading of the user's init
4297 file, Emacs now pops up the *Messages* buffer.
4298
4299 ** Emacs now refuses to load compiled Lisp files which weren't
4300 compiled with Emacs. Set `load-dangerous-libraries' to t to change
4301 this behavior.
4302
4303 The reason for this change is an incompatible change in XEmacs's byte
4304 compiler. Files compiled with XEmacs can contain byte codes that let
4305 Emacs dump core.
4306
4307 ** Toggle buttons and radio buttons in menus.
4308
4309 When compiled with LessTif (or Motif) support, Emacs uses toolkit
4310 widgets for radio and toggle buttons in menus. When configured for
4311 Lucid, Emacs draws radio buttons and toggle buttons similar to Motif.
4312
4313 ** The menu bar configuration has changed. The new configuration is
4314 more CUA-compliant. The most significant change is that Options is
4315 now a separate menu-bar item, with Mule and Customize as its submenus.
4316
4317 ** Item Save Options on the Options menu allows saving options set
4318 using that menu.
4319
4320 ** Highlighting of trailing whitespace.
4321
4322 When `show-trailing-whitespace' is non-nil, Emacs displays trailing
4323 whitespace in the face `trailing-whitespace'. Trailing whitespace is
4324 defined as spaces or tabs at the end of a line. To avoid busy
4325 highlighting when entering new text, trailing whitespace is not
4326 displayed if point is at the end of the line containing the
4327 whitespace.
4328
4329 ** C-x 5 1 runs the new command delete-other-frames which deletes
4330 all frames except the selected one.
4331
4332 ** The new user-option `confirm-kill-emacs' can be customized to
4333 let Emacs ask for confirmation before exiting.
4334
4335 ** The header line in an Info buffer is now displayed as an emacs
4336 header-line (which is like a mode-line, but at the top of the window),
4337 so that it remains visible even when the buffer has been scrolled.
4338 This behavior may be disabled by customizing the option
4339 `Info-use-header-line'.
4340
4341 ** Polish, Czech, German, and French translations of Emacs' reference card
4342 have been added. They are named `pl-refcard.tex', `cs-refcard.tex',
4343 `de-refcard.tex' and `fr-refcard.tex'. Postscript files are included.
4344
4345 ** An `Emacs Survival Guide', etc/survival.tex, is available.
4346
4347 ** A reference card for Dired has been added. Its name is
4348 `dired-ref.tex'. A French translation is available in
4349 `fr-drdref.tex'.
4350
4351 ** C-down-mouse-3 is bound differently. Now if the menu bar is not
4352 displayed it pops up a menu containing the items which would be on the
4353 menu bar. If the menu bar is displayed, it pops up the major mode
4354 menu or the Edit menu if there is no major mode menu.
4355
4356 ** Variable `load-path' is no longer customizable through Customize.
4357
4358 You can no longer use `M-x customize-variable' to customize `load-path'
4359 because it now contains a version-dependent component. You can still
4360 use `add-to-list' and `setq' to customize this variable in your
4361 `~/.emacs' init file or to modify it from any Lisp program in general.
4362
4363 ** C-u C-x = provides detailed information about the character at
4364 point in a pop-up window.
4365
4366 ** Emacs can now support 'wheeled' mice (such as the MS IntelliMouse)
4367 under XFree86. To enable this, use the `mouse-wheel-mode' command, or
4368 customize the variable `mouse-wheel-mode'.
4369
4370 The variables `mouse-wheel-follow-mouse' and `mouse-wheel-scroll-amount'
4371 determine where and by how much buffers are scrolled.
4372
4373 ** Emacs' auto-save list files are now by default stored in a
4374 sub-directory `.emacs.d/auto-save-list/' of the user's home directory.
4375 (On MS-DOS, this subdirectory's name is `_emacs.d/auto-save.list/'.)
4376 You can customize `auto-save-list-file-prefix' to change this location.
4377
4378 ** The function `getenv' is now callable interactively.
4379
4380 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
4381 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
4382
4383 ** The new command M-x delete-trailing-whitespace RET will delete the
4384 trailing whitespace within the current restriction. You can also add
4385 this function to `write-file-hooks' or `local-write-file-hooks'.
4386
4387 ** When visiting a file with M-x find-file-literally, no newlines will
4388 be added to the end of the buffer even if `require-final-newline' is
4389 non-nil.
4390
4391 ** The new user-option `find-file-suppress-same-file-warnings' can be
4392 set to suppress warnings ``X and Y are the same file'' when visiting a
4393 file that is already visited under a different name.
4394
4395 ** The new user-option `electric-help-shrink-window' can be set to
4396 nil to prevent adjusting the help window size to the buffer size.
4397
4398 ** New command M-x describe-character-set reads a character set name
4399 and displays information about that.
4400
4401 ** The new variable `auto-mode-interpreter-regexp' contains a regular
4402 expression matching interpreters, for file mode determination.
4403
4404 This regular expression is matched against the first line of a file to
4405 determine the file's mode in `set-auto-mode' when Emacs can't deduce a
4406 mode from the file's name. If it matches, the file is assumed to be
4407 interpreted by the interpreter matched by the second group of the
4408 regular expression. The mode is then determined as the mode
4409 associated with that interpreter in `interpreter-mode-alist'.
4410
4411 ** New function executable-make-buffer-file-executable-if-script-p is
4412 suitable as an after-save-hook as an alternative to `executable-chmod'.
4413
4414 ** The most preferred coding-system is now used to save a buffer if
4415 buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and it is safe for the buffer
4416 contents. (The most preferred is set by set-language-environment or
4417 by M-x prefer-coding-system.) Thus if you visit an ASCII file and
4418 insert a non-ASCII character from your current language environment,
4419 the file will be saved silently with the appropriate coding.
4420 Previously you would be prompted for a safe coding system.
4421
4422 ** The many obsolete language `setup-...-environment' commands have
4423 been removed -- use `set-language-environment'.
4424
4425 ** The new Custom option `keyboard-coding-system' specifies a coding
4426 system for keyboard input.
4427
4428 ** New variable `inhibit-iso-escape-detection' determines if Emacs'
4429 coding system detection algorithm should pay attention to ISO2022's
4430 escape sequences. If this variable is non-nil, the algorithm ignores
4431 such escape sequences. The default value is nil, and it is
4432 recommended not to change it except for the special case that you
4433 always want to read any escape code verbatim. If you just want to
4434 read a specific file without decoding escape codes, use C-x RET c
4435 (`universal-coding-system-argument'). For instance, C-x RET c latin-1
4436 RET C-x C-f filename RET.
4437
4438 ** Variable `default-korean-keyboard' is initialized properly from the
4439 environment variable `HANGUL_KEYBOARD_TYPE'.
4440
4441 ** New command M-x list-charset-chars reads a character set name and
4442 displays all characters in that character set.
4443
4444 ** M-x set-terminal-coding-system (C-x RET t) now allows CCL-based
4445 coding systems such as cpXXX and cyrillic-koi8.
4446
4447 ** Emacs now attempts to determine the initial language environment
4448 and preferred and locale coding systems systematically from the
4449 LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG environment variables during startup.
4450
4451 ** New language environments `Polish', `Latin-8' and `Latin-9'.
4452 Latin-8 and Latin-9 correspond respectively to the ISO character sets
4453 8859-14 (Celtic) and 8859-15 (updated Latin-1, with the Euro sign).
4454 GNU Intlfonts doesn't support these yet but recent X releases have
4455 8859-15. See etc/INSTALL for information on obtaining extra fonts.
4456 There are new Leim input methods for Latin-8 and Latin-9 prefix (only)
4457 and Polish `slash'.
4458
4459 ** New language environments `Dutch' and `Spanish'.
4460 These new environments mainly select appropriate translations
4461 of the tutorial.
4462
4463 ** In Ethiopic language environment, special key bindings for
4464 function keys are changed as follows. This is to conform to "Emacs
4465 Lisp Coding Convention".
4466
4467 new command old-binding
4468 --- ------- -----------
4469 f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-buffer f5
4470 S-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-region f5
4471 C-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-mail-or-marker f5
4472
4473 f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-buffer unchanged
4474 S-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-region unchanged
4475 C-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-mail-or-marker unchanged
4476
4477 S-f5 ethio-toggle-punctuation f3
4478 S-f6 ethio-modify-vowel f6
4479 S-f7 ethio-replace-space f7
4480 S-f8 ethio-input-special-character f8
4481 S-f9 ethio-replace-space unchanged
4482 C-f9 ethio-toggle-space f2
4483
4484 ** There are new Leim input methods.
4485 New input methods "turkish-postfix", "turkish-alt-postfix",
4486 "greek-mizuochi", "TeX", and "greek-babel" are now part of the Leim
4487 package.
4488
4489 ** The rule of input method "slovak" is slightly changed. Now the
4490 rules for translating "q" and "Q" to "`" (backquote) are deleted, thus
4491 typing them inserts "q" and "Q" respectively. Rules for translating
4492 "=q", "+q", "=Q", and "+Q" to "`" are also deleted. Now, to input
4493 "`", you must type "=q".
4494
4495 ** When your terminal can't display characters from some of the ISO
4496 8859 character sets but can display Latin-1, you can display
4497 more-or-less mnemonic sequences of ASCII/Latin-1 characters instead of
4498 empty boxes (under a window system) or question marks (not under a
4499 window system). Customize the option `latin1-display' to turn this
4500 on.
4501
4502 ** M-; now calls comment-dwim which tries to do something clever based
4503 on the context. M-x kill-comment is now an alias to comment-kill,
4504 defined in newcomment.el. You can choose different styles of region
4505 commenting with the variable `comment-style'.
4506
4507 ** New user options `display-time-mail-face' and
4508 `display-time-use-mail-icon' control the appearance of mode-line mail
4509 indicator used by the display-time package. On a suitable display the
4510 indicator can be an icon and is mouse-sensitive.
4511
4512 ** On window-systems, additional space can be put between text lines
4513 on the display using several methods
4514
4515 - By setting frame parameter `line-spacing' to PIXELS. PIXELS must be
4516 a positive integer, and specifies that PIXELS number of pixels should
4517 be put below text lines on the affected frame or frames.
4518
4519 - By setting X resource `lineSpacing', class `LineSpacing'. This is
4520 equivalent to specifying the frame parameter.
4521
4522 - By specifying `--line-spacing=N' or `-lsp N' on the command line.
4523
4524 - By setting buffer-local variable `line-spacing'. The meaning is
4525 the same, but applies to the a particular buffer only.
4526
4527 ** The new command `clone-indirect-buffer' can be used to create
4528 an indirect buffer that is a twin copy of the current buffer. The
4529 command `clone-indirect-buffer-other-window', bound to C-x 4 c,
4530 does the same but displays the indirect buffer in another window.
4531
4532 ** New user options `backup-directory-alist' and
4533 `make-backup-file-name-function' control the placement of backups,
4534 typically in a single directory or in an invisible sub-directory.
4535
4536 ** New commands iso-iso2sgml and iso-sgml2iso convert between Latin-1
4537 characters and the corresponding SGML (HTML) entities.
4538
4539 ** New X resources recognized
4540
4541 *** The X resource `synchronous', class `Synchronous', specifies
4542 whether Emacs should run in synchronous mode. Synchronous mode
4543 is useful for debugging X problems.
4544
4545 Example:
4546
4547 emacs.synchronous: true
4548
4549 *** The X resource `visualClass, class `VisualClass', specifies the
4550 visual Emacs should use. The resource's value should be a string of
4551 the form `CLASS-DEPTH', where CLASS is the name of the visual class,
4552 and DEPTH is the requested color depth as a decimal number. Valid
4553 visual class names are
4554
4555 TrueColor
4556 PseudoColor
4557 DirectColor
4558 StaticColor
4559 GrayScale
4560 StaticGray
4561
4562 Visual class names specified as X resource are case-insensitive, i.e.
4563 `pseudocolor', `Pseudocolor' and `PseudoColor' all have the same
4564 meaning.
4565
4566 The program `xdpyinfo' can be used to list the visual classes
4567 supported on your display, and which depths they have. If
4568 `visualClass' is not specified, Emacs uses the display's default
4569 visual.
4570
4571 Example:
4572
4573 emacs.visualClass: TrueColor-8
4574
4575 *** The X resource `privateColormap', class `PrivateColormap',
4576 specifies that Emacs should use a private colormap if it is using the
4577 default visual, and that visual is of class PseudoColor. Recognized
4578 resource values are `true' or `on'.
4579
4580 Example:
4581
4582 emacs.privateColormap: true
4583
4584 ** Faces and frame parameters.
4585
4586 There are four new faces `scroll-bar', `border', `cursor' and `mouse'.
4587 Setting the frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
4588 `scroll-bar-background' sets foreground and background color of face
4589 `scroll-bar' and vice versa. Setting frame parameter `border-color'
4590 sets the background color of face `border' and vice versa. Likewise
4591 for frame parameters `cursor-color' and face `cursor', and frame
4592 parameter `mouse-color' and face `mouse'.
4593
4594 Changing frame parameter `font' sets font-related attributes of the
4595 `default' face and vice versa. Setting frame parameters
4596 `foreground-color' or `background-color' sets the colors of the
4597 `default' face and vice versa.
4598
4599 ** New face `menu'.
4600
4601 The face `menu' can be used to change colors and font of Emacs' menus.
4602
4603 ** New frame parameter `screen-gamma' for gamma correction.
4604
4605 The new frame parameter `screen-gamma' specifies gamma-correction for
4606 colors. Its value may be nil, the default, in which case no gamma
4607 correction occurs, or a number > 0, usually a float, that specifies
4608 the screen gamma of a frame's display.
4609
4610 PC monitors usually have a screen gamma of 2.2. smaller values result
4611 in darker colors. You might want to try a screen gamma of 1.5 for LCD
4612 color displays. The viewing gamma Emacs uses is 0.4545. (1/2.2).
4613
4614 The X resource name of this parameter is `screenGamma', class
4615 `ScreenGamma'.
4616
4617 ** Tabs and variable-width text.
4618
4619 Tabs are now displayed with stretch properties; the width of a tab is
4620 defined as a multiple of the normal character width of a frame, and is
4621 independent of the fonts used in the text where the tab appears.
4622 Thus, tabs can be used to line up text in different fonts.
4623
4624 ** Enhancements of the Lucid menu bar
4625
4626 *** The Lucid menu bar now supports the resource "margin".
4627
4628 emacs.pane.menubar.margin: 5
4629
4630 The default margin is 4 which makes the menu bar appear like the
4631 LessTif/Motif one.
4632
4633 *** Arrows that indicate sub-menus are now drawn with shadows, as in
4634 LessTif and Motif.
4635
4636 ** A block cursor can be drawn as wide as the glyph under it under X.
4637
4638 As an example: if a block cursor is over a tab character, it will be
4639 drawn as wide as that tab on the display. To do this, set
4640 `x-stretch-cursor' to a non-nil value.
4641
4642 ** Empty display lines at the end of a buffer may be marked with a
4643 bitmap (this is similar to the tilde displayed by vi and Less).
4644
4645 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
4646 `indicate-empty-lines' to a non-nil value. The default value of this
4647 variable is found in `default-indicate-empty-lines'.
4648
4649 ** There is a new "aggressive" scrolling method.
4650
4651 When scrolling up because point is above the window start, if the
4652 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-up-aggressively' is a
4653 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
4654 fraction of the window's height from the top of the window.
4655
4656 When scrolling down because point is below the window end, if the
4657 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-down-aggressively' is a
4658 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
4659 fraction of the window's height from the bottom of the window.
4660
4661 ** You can now easily create new *Info* buffers using either
4662 M-x clone-buffer, C-u m <entry> RET or C-u g <entry> RET.
4663 M-x clone-buffer can also be used on *Help* and several other special
4664 buffers.
4665
4666 ** The command `Info-search' now uses a search history.
4667
4668 ** Listing buffers with M-x list-buffers (C-x C-b) now shows
4669 abbreviated file names. Abbreviations can be customized by changing
4670 `directory-abbrev-alist'.
4671
4672 ** A new variable, backup-by-copying-when-privileged-mismatch, gives
4673 the highest file uid for which backup-by-copying-when-mismatch will be
4674 forced on. The assumption is that uids less than or equal to this
4675 value are special uids (root, bin, daemon, etc.--not real system
4676 users) and that files owned by these users should not change ownership,
4677 even if your system policy allows users other than root to edit them.
4678
4679 The default is 200; set the variable to nil to disable the feature.
4680
4681 ** The rectangle commands now avoid inserting undesirable spaces,
4682 notably at the end of lines.
4683
4684 All these functions have been rewritten to avoid inserting unwanted
4685 spaces, and an optional prefix now allows them to behave the old way.
4686
4687 ** The function `replace-rectangle' is an alias for `string-rectangle'.
4688
4689 ** The new command M-x string-insert-rectangle is like `string-rectangle',
4690 but inserts text instead of replacing it.
4691
4692 ** The new command M-x query-replace-regexp-eval acts like
4693 query-replace-regexp, but takes a Lisp expression which is evaluated
4694 after each match to get the replacement text.
4695
4696 ** M-x query-replace recognizes a new command `e' (or `E') that lets
4697 you edit the replacement string.
4698
4699 ** The new command mail-abbrev-complete-alias, bound to `M-TAB'
4700 (if you load the library `mailabbrev'), lets you complete mail aliases
4701 in the text, analogous to lisp-complete-symbol.
4702
4703 ** The variable `echo-keystrokes' may now have a floating point value.
4704
4705 ** If your init file is compiled (.emacs.elc), `user-init-file' is set
4706 to the source name (.emacs.el), if that exists, after loading it.
4707
4708 ** The help string specified for a menu-item whose definition contains
4709 the property `:help HELP' is now displayed under X, on MS-Windows, and
4710 MS-DOS, either in the echo area or with tooltips. Many standard menus
4711 displayed by Emacs now have help strings.
4712
4713 --
4714 ** New user option `read-mail-command' specifies a command to use to
4715 read mail from the menu etc.
4716
4717 ** The environment variable `EMACSLOCKDIR' is no longer used on MS-Windows.
4718 This environment variable was used when creating lock files. Emacs on
4719 MS-Windows does not use this variable anymore. This change was made
4720 before Emacs 21.1, but wasn't documented until now.
4721
4722 ** Highlighting of mouse-sensitive regions is now supported in the
4723 MS-DOS version of Emacs.
4724
4725 ** The new command `msdos-set-mouse-buttons' forces the MS-DOS version
4726 of Emacs to behave as if the mouse had a specified number of buttons.
4727 This comes handy with mice that don't report their number of buttons
4728 correctly. One example is the wheeled mice, which report 3 buttons,
4729 but clicks on the middle button are not passed to the MS-DOS version
4730 of Emacs.
4731
4732 ** Customize changes
4733
4734 *** Customize now supports comments about customized items. Use the
4735 `State' menu to add comments, or give a prefix argument to
4736 M-x customize-set-variable or M-x customize-set-value. Note that
4737 customization comments will cause the customizations to fail in
4738 earlier versions of Emacs.
4739
4740 *** The new option `custom-buffer-done-function' says whether to kill
4741 Custom buffers when you've done with them or just bury them (the
4742 default).
4743
4744 *** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
4745 does not allow you to save customizations in your `~/.emacs' init
4746 file. This is because saving customizations from such a session would
4747 wipe out all the other customizationss you might have on your init
4748 file.
4749
4750 ** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
4751 does not save disabled and enabled commands for future sessions, to
4752 avoid overwriting existing customizations of this kind that are
4753 already in your init file.
4754
4755 ** New features in evaluation commands
4756
4757 *** The commands to evaluate Lisp expressions, such as C-M-x in Lisp
4758 modes, C-j in Lisp Interaction mode, and M-:, now bind the variables
4759 print-level, print-length, and debug-on-error based on the new
4760 customizable variables eval-expression-print-level,
4761 eval-expression-print-length, and eval-expression-debug-on-error.
4762
4763 The default values for the first two of these variables are 12 and 4
4764 respectively, which means that `eval-expression' now prints at most
4765 the first 12 members of a list and at most 4 nesting levels deep (if
4766 the list is longer or deeper than that, an ellipsis `...' is
4767 printed).
4768
4769 <RET> or <mouse-2> on the printed text toggles between an abbreviated
4770 printed representation and an unabbreviated one.
4771
4772 The default value of eval-expression-debug-on-error is t, so any error
4773 during evaluation produces a backtrace.
4774
4775 *** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) now loads Edebug and instruments
4776 code when called with a prefix argument.
4777
4778 ** CC mode changes.
4779
4780 Note: This release contains changes that might not be compatible with
4781 current user setups (although it's believed that these
4782 incompatibilities will only show in very uncommon circumstances).
4783 However, since the impact is uncertain, these changes may be rolled
4784 back depending on user feedback. Therefore there's no forward
4785 compatibility guarantee wrt the new features introduced in this
4786 release.
4787
4788 *** The hardcoded switch to "java" style in Java mode is gone.
4789 CC Mode used to automatically set the style to "java" when Java mode
4790 is entered. This has now been removed since it caused too much
4791 confusion.
4792
4793 However, to keep backward compatibility to a certain extent, the
4794 default value for c-default-style now specifies the "java" style for
4795 java-mode, but "gnu" for all other modes (as before). So you won't
4796 notice the change if you haven't touched that variable.
4797
4798 *** New cleanups, space-before-funcall and compact-empty-funcall.
4799 Two new cleanups have been added to c-cleanup-list:
4800
4801 space-before-funcall causes a space to be inserted before the opening
4802 parenthesis of a function call, which gives the style "foo (bar)".
4803
4804 compact-empty-funcall causes any space before a function call opening
4805 parenthesis to be removed if there are no arguments to the function.
4806 It's typically useful together with space-before-funcall to get the
4807 style "foo (bar)" and "foo()".
4808
4809 *** Some keywords now automatically trigger reindentation.
4810 Keywords like "else", "while", "catch" and "finally" have been made
4811 "electric" to make them reindent automatically when they continue an
4812 earlier statement. An example:
4813
4814 for (i = 0; i < 17; i++)
4815 if (a[i])
4816 res += a[i]->offset;
4817 else
4818
4819 Here, the "else" should be indented like the preceding "if", since it
4820 continues that statement. CC Mode will automatically reindent it after
4821 the "else" has been typed in full, since it's not until then it's
4822 possible to decide whether it's a new statement or a continuation of
4823 the preceding "if".
4824
4825 CC Mode uses Abbrev mode to achieve this, which is therefore turned on
4826 by default.
4827
4828 *** M-a and M-e now moves by sentence in multiline strings.
4829 Previously these two keys only moved by sentence in comments, which
4830 meant that sentence movement didn't work in strings containing
4831 documentation or other natural language text.
4832
4833 The reason it's only activated in multiline strings (i.e. strings that
4834 contain a newline, even when escaped by a '\') is to avoid stopping in
4835 the short strings that often reside inside statements. Multiline
4836 strings almost always contain text in a natural language, as opposed
4837 to other strings that typically contain format specifications,
4838 commands, etc. Also, it's not that bothersome that M-a and M-e misses
4839 sentences in single line strings, since they're short anyway.
4840
4841 *** Support for autodoc comments in Pike mode.
4842 Autodoc comments for Pike are used to extract documentation from the
4843 source, like Javadoc in Java. Pike mode now recognize this markup in
4844 comment prefixes and paragraph starts.
4845
4846 *** The comment prefix regexps on c-comment-prefix may be mode specific.
4847 When c-comment-prefix is an association list, it specifies the comment
4848 line prefix on a per-mode basis, like c-default-style does. This
4849 change came about to support the special autodoc comment prefix in
4850 Pike mode only.
4851
4852 *** Better handling of syntactic errors.
4853 The recovery after unbalanced parens earlier in the buffer has been
4854 improved; CC Mode now reports them by dinging and giving a message
4855 stating the offending line, but still recovers and indent the
4856 following lines in a sane way (most of the time). An "else" with no
4857 matching "if" is handled similarly. If an error is discovered while
4858 indenting a region, the whole region is still indented and the error
4859 is reported afterwards.
4860
4861 *** Lineup functions may now return absolute columns.
4862 A lineup function can give an absolute column to indent the line to by
4863 returning a vector with the desired column as the first element.
4864
4865 *** More robust and warning-free byte compilation.
4866 Although this is strictly not a user visible change (well, depending
4867 on the view of a user), it's still worth mentioning that CC Mode now
4868 can be compiled in the standard ways without causing trouble. Some
4869 code have also been moved between the subpackages to enhance the
4870 modularity somewhat. Thanks to Martin Buchholz for doing the
4871 groundwork.
4872
4873 *** c-style-variables-are-local-p now defaults to t.
4874 This is an incompatible change that has been made to make the behavior
4875 of the style system wrt global variable settings less confusing for
4876 non-advanced users. If you know what this variable does you might
4877 want to set it to nil in your .emacs, otherwise you probably don't
4878 have to bother.
4879
4880 Defaulting c-style-variables-are-local-p to t avoids the confusing
4881 situation that occurs when a user sets some style variables globally
4882 and edits both a Java and a non-Java file in the same Emacs session.
4883 If the style variables aren't buffer local in this case, loading of
4884 the second file will cause the default style (either "gnu" or "java"
4885 by default) to override the global settings made by the user.
4886
4887 *** New initialization procedure for the style system.
4888 When the initial style for a buffer is determined by CC Mode (from the
4889 variable c-default-style), the global values of style variables now
4890 take precedence over the values specified by the chosen style. This
4891 is different than the old behavior: previously, the style-specific
4892 settings would override the global settings. This change makes it
4893 possible to do simple configuration in the intuitive way with
4894 Customize or with setq lines in one's .emacs file.
4895
4896 By default, the global value of every style variable is the new
4897 special symbol set-from-style, which causes the value to be taken from
4898 the style system. This means that in effect, only an explicit setting
4899 of a style variable will cause the "overriding" behavior described
4900 above.
4901
4902 Also note that global settings override style-specific settings *only*
4903 when the initial style of a buffer is chosen by a CC Mode major mode
4904 function. When a style is chosen in other ways --- for example, by a
4905 call like (c-set-style "gnu") in a hook, or via M-x c-set-style ---
4906 then the style-specific values take precedence over any global style
4907 values. In Lisp terms, global values override style-specific values
4908 only when the new second argument to c-set-style is non-nil; see the
4909 function documentation for more info.
4910
4911 The purpose of these changes is to make it easier for users,
4912 especially novice users, to do simple customizations with Customize or
4913 with setq in their .emacs files. On the other hand, the new system is
4914 intended to be compatible with advanced users' customizations as well,
4915 such as those that choose styles in hooks or whatnot. This new system
4916 is believed to be almost entirely compatible with current
4917 configurations, in spite of the changed precedence between style and
4918 global variable settings when a buffer's default style is set.
4919
4920 (Thanks to Eric Eide for clarifying this explanation a bit.)
4921
4922 **** c-offsets-alist is now a customizable variable.
4923 This became possible as a result of the new initialization behavior.
4924
4925 This variable is treated slightly differently from the other style
4926 variables; instead of using the symbol set-from-style, it will be
4927 completed with the syntactic symbols it doesn't already contain when
4928 the style is first initialized. This means it now defaults to the
4929 empty list to make all syntactic elements get their values from the
4930 style system.
4931
4932 **** Compatibility variable to restore the old behavior.
4933 In case your configuration doesn't work with this change, you can set
4934 c-old-style-variable-behavior to non-nil to get the old behavior back
4935 as far as possible.
4936
4937 *** Improvements to line breaking and text filling.
4938 CC Mode now handles this more intelligently and seamlessly wrt the
4939 surrounding code, especially inside comments. For details see the new
4940 chapter about this in the manual.
4941
4942 **** New variable to recognize comment line prefix decorations.
4943 The variable c-comment-prefix-regexp has been added to properly
4944 recognize the line prefix in both block and line comments. It's
4945 primarily used to initialize the various paragraph recognition and
4946 adaptive filling variables that the text handling functions uses.
4947
4948 **** New variable c-block-comment-prefix.
4949 This is a generalization of the now obsolete variable
4950 c-comment-continuation-stars to handle arbitrary strings.
4951
4952 **** CC Mode now uses adaptive fill mode.
4953 This to make it adapt better to the paragraph style inside comments.
4954
4955 It's also possible to use other adaptive filling packages inside CC
4956 Mode, notably Kyle E. Jones' Filladapt mode (http://wonderworks.com/).
4957 A new convenience function c-setup-filladapt sets up Filladapt for use
4958 inside CC Mode.
4959
4960 Note though that the 2.12 version of Filladapt lacks a feature that
4961 causes it to work suboptimally when c-comment-prefix-regexp can match
4962 the empty string (which it commonly does). A patch for that is
4963 available from the CC Mode web site (http://www.python.org/emacs/
4964 cc-mode/).
4965
4966 **** The variables `c-hanging-comment-starter-p' and
4967 `c-hanging-comment-ender-p', which controlled how comment starters and
4968 enders were filled, are not used anymore. The new version of the
4969 function `c-fill-paragraph' keeps the comment starters and enders as
4970 they were before the filling.
4971
4972 **** It's now possible to selectively turn off auto filling.
4973 The variable c-ignore-auto-fill is used to ignore auto fill mode in
4974 specific contexts, e.g. in preprocessor directives and in string
4975 literals.
4976
4977 **** New context sensitive line break function c-context-line-break.
4978 It works like newline-and-indent in normal code, and adapts the line
4979 prefix according to the comment style when used inside comments. If
4980 you're normally using newline-and-indent, you might want to switch to
4981 this function.
4982
4983 *** Fixes to IDL mode.
4984 It now does a better job in recognizing only the constructs relevant
4985 to IDL. E.g. it no longer matches "class" as the beginning of a
4986 struct block, but it does match the CORBA 2.3 "valuetype" keyword.
4987 Thanks to Eric Eide.
4988
4989 *** Improvements to the Whitesmith style.
4990 It now keeps the style consistently on all levels and both when
4991 opening braces hangs and when they don't.
4992
4993 **** New lineup function c-lineup-whitesmith-in-block.
4994
4995 *** New lineup functions c-lineup-template-args and c-indent-multi-line-block.
4996 See their docstrings for details. c-lineup-template-args does a
4997 better job of tracking the brackets used as parens in C++ templates,
4998 and is used by default to line up continued template arguments.
4999
5000 *** c-lineup-comment now preserves alignment with a comment on the
5001 previous line. It used to instead preserve comments that started in
5002 the column specified by comment-column.
5003
5004 *** c-lineup-C-comments handles "free form" text comments.
5005 In comments with a long delimiter line at the start, the indentation
5006 is kept unchanged for lines that start with an empty comment line
5007 prefix. This is intended for the type of large block comments that
5008 contain documentation with its own formatting. In these you normally
5009 don't want CC Mode to change the indentation.
5010
5011 *** The `c' syntactic symbol is now relative to the comment start
5012 instead of the previous line, to make integers usable as lineup
5013 arguments.
5014
5015 *** All lineup functions have gotten docstrings.
5016
5017 *** More preprocessor directive movement functions.
5018 c-down-conditional does the reverse of c-up-conditional.
5019 c-up-conditional-with-else and c-down-conditional-with-else are
5020 variants of these that also stops at "#else" lines (suggested by Don
5021 Provan).
5022
5023 *** Minor improvements to many movement functions in tricky situations.
5024
5025 ** Dired changes
5026
5027 *** New variable `dired-recursive-deletes' determines if the delete
5028 command will delete non-empty directories recursively. The default
5029 is, delete only empty directories.
5030
5031 *** New variable `dired-recursive-copies' determines if the copy
5032 command will copy directories recursively. The default is, do not
5033 copy directories recursively.
5034
5035 *** In command `dired-do-shell-command' (usually bound to `!') a `?'
5036 in the shell command has a special meaning similar to `*', but with
5037 the difference that the command will be run on each file individually.
5038
5039 *** The new command `dired-find-alternate-file' (usually bound to `a')
5040 replaces the Dired buffer with the buffer for an alternate file or
5041 directory.
5042
5043 *** The new command `dired-show-file-type' (usually bound to `y') shows
5044 a message in the echo area describing what type of file the point is on.
5045 This command invokes the external program `file' do its work, and so
5046 will only work on systems with that program, and will be only as
5047 accurate or inaccurate as it is.
5048
5049 *** Dired now properly handles undo changes of adding/removing `-R'
5050 from ls switches.
5051
5052 *** Dired commands that prompt for a destination file now allow the use
5053 of the `M-n' command in the minibuffer to insert the source filename,
5054 which the user can then edit. This only works if there is a single
5055 source file, not when operating on multiple marked files.
5056
5057 ** Gnus changes.
5058
5059 The Gnus NEWS entries are short, but they reflect sweeping changes in
5060 four areas: Article display treatment, MIME treatment,
5061 internationalization and mail-fetching.
5062
5063 *** The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
5064 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
5065
5066 If you used procmail like in
5067
5068 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
5069 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
5070 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
5071 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
5072
5073 this now has changed to
5074
5075 (setq mail-sources
5076 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
5077 :suffix ".in")))
5078
5079 More information is available in the info doc at Select Methods ->
5080 Getting Mail -> Mail Sources
5081
5082 *** Gnus is now a MIME-capable reader. This affects many parts of
5083 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
5084 Separate MIME packages like RMIME, mime-compose etc., will probably no
5085 longer work; remove them and use the native facilities.
5086
5087 The FLIM/SEMI package still works with Emacs 21, but if you want to
5088 use the native facilities, you must remove any mailcap.el[c] that was
5089 installed by FLIM/SEMI version 1.13 or earlier.
5090
5091 *** Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too many
5092 parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables. There
5093 are built-in facilities equivalent to those of gnus-mule.el, which is
5094 now just a compatibility layer.
5095
5096 *** gnus-mule.el is now just a compatibility layer over the built-in
5097 Gnus facilities.
5098
5099 *** gnus-auto-select-first can now be a function to be
5100 called to position point.
5101
5102 *** The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
5103 summary buffers and NOV files.
5104
5105 *** `gnus-article-display-hook' has been removed. Instead, a number
5106 of variables starting with `gnus-treat-' have been added.
5107
5108 *** The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now work in a
5109 subtly different manner.
5110
5111 *** New web-based backends have been added: nnslashdot, nnwarchive
5112 and nnultimate. nnweb has been revamped, again, to keep up with
5113 ever-changing layouts.
5114
5115 *** Gnus can now read IMAP mail via nnimap.
5116
5117 *** There is image support of various kinds and some sound support.
5118
5119 ** Changes in Texinfo mode.
5120
5121 *** A couple of new key bindings have been added for inserting Texinfo
5122 macros
5123
5124 Key binding Macro
5125 -------------------------
5126 C-c C-c C-s @strong
5127 C-c C-c C-e @emph
5128 C-c C-c u @uref
5129 C-c C-c q @quotation
5130 C-c C-c m @email
5131 C-c C-o @<block> ... @end <block>
5132 M-RET @item
5133
5134 *** The " key now inserts either " or `` or '' depending on context.
5135
5136 ** Changes in Outline mode.
5137
5138 There is now support for Imenu to index headings. A new command
5139 `outline-headers-as-kill' copies the visible headings in the region to
5140 the kill ring, e.g. to produce a table of contents.
5141
5142 ** Changes to Emacs Server
5143
5144 *** The new option `server-kill-new-buffers' specifies what to do
5145 with buffers when done with them. If non-nil, the default, buffers
5146 are killed, unless they were already present before visiting them with
5147 Emacs Server. If nil, `server-temp-file-regexp' specifies which
5148 buffers to kill, as before.
5149
5150 Please note that only buffers are killed that still have a client,
5151 i.e. buffers visited with `emacsclient --no-wait' are never killed in
5152 this way.
5153
5154 ** Both emacsclient and Emacs itself now accept command line options
5155 of the form +LINE:COLUMN in addition to +LINE.
5156
5157 ** Changes to Show Paren mode.
5158
5159 *** Overlays used by Show Paren mode now use a priority property.
5160 The new user option show-paren-priority specifies the priority to
5161 use. Default is 1000.
5162
5163 ** New command M-x check-parens can be used to find unbalanced paren
5164 groups and strings in buffers in Lisp mode (or other modes).
5165
5166 ** Changes to hideshow.el
5167
5168 *** Generalized block selection and traversal
5169
5170 A block is now recognized by its start and end regexps (both strings),
5171 and an integer specifying which sub-expression in the start regexp
5172 serves as the place where a `forward-sexp'-like function can operate.
5173 See the documentation of variable `hs-special-modes-alist'.
5174
5175 *** During incremental search, if Hideshow minor mode is active,
5176 hidden blocks are temporarily shown. The variable `hs-headline' can
5177 be used in the mode line format to show the line at the beginning of
5178 the open block.
5179
5180 *** User option `hs-hide-all-non-comment-function' specifies a
5181 function to be called at each top-level block beginning, instead of
5182 the normal block-hiding function.
5183
5184 *** The command `hs-show-region' has been removed.
5185
5186 *** The key bindings have changed to fit the Emacs conventions,
5187 roughly imitating those of Outline minor mode. Notably, the prefix
5188 for all bindings is now `C-c @'. For details, see the documentation
5189 for `hs-minor-mode'.
5190
5191 *** The variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' has been removed, and
5192 hideshow.el now always behaves as if this variable were set to t.
5193
5194 ** Changes to Change Log mode and Add-Log functions
5195
5196 *** If you invoke `add-change-log-entry' from a backup file, it makes
5197 an entry appropriate for the file's parent. This is useful for making
5198 log entries by comparing a version with deleted functions.
5199
5200 **** New command M-x change-log-merge merges another log into the
5201 current buffer.
5202
5203 *** New command M-x change-log-redate fixes any old-style date entries
5204 in a log file.
5205
5206 *** Change Log mode now adds a file's version number to change log
5207 entries if user-option `change-log-version-info-enabled' is non-nil.
5208 Unless the file is under version control the search for a file's
5209 version number is performed based on regular expressions from
5210 `change-log-version-number-regexp-list' which can be customized.
5211 Version numbers are only found in the first 10 percent of a file.
5212
5213 *** Change Log mode now defines its own faces for font-lock highlighting.
5214
5215 ** Changes to cmuscheme
5216
5217 *** The user-option `scheme-program-name' has been renamed
5218 `cmuscheme-program-name' due to conflicts with xscheme.el.
5219
5220 ** Changes in Font Lock
5221
5222 *** The new function `font-lock-remove-keywords' can be used to remove
5223 font-lock keywords from the current buffer or from a specific major mode.
5224
5225 *** Multi-line patterns are now supported. Modes using this, should
5226 set font-lock-multiline to t in their font-lock-defaults.
5227
5228 *** `font-lock-syntactic-face-function' allows major-modes to choose
5229 the face used for each string/comment.
5230
5231 *** A new standard face `font-lock-doc-face'.
5232 Meant for Lisp docstrings, Javadoc comments and other "documentation in code".
5233
5234 ** Changes to Shell mode
5235
5236 *** The `shell' command now accepts an optional argument to specify the buffer
5237 to use, which defaults to "*shell*". When used interactively, a
5238 non-default buffer may be specified by giving the `shell' command a
5239 prefix argument (causing it to prompt for the buffer name).
5240
5241 ** Comint (subshell) changes
5242
5243 These changes generally affect all modes derived from comint mode, which
5244 include shell-mode, gdb-mode, scheme-interaction-mode, etc.
5245
5246 *** Comint now by default interprets some carriage-control characters.
5247 Comint now removes CRs from CR LF sequences, and treats single CRs and
5248 BSs in the output in a way similar to a terminal (by deleting to the
5249 beginning of the line, or deleting the previous character,
5250 respectively). This is achieved by adding `comint-carriage-motion' to
5251 the `comint-output-filter-functions' hook by default.
5252
5253 *** By default, comint no longer uses the variable `comint-prompt-regexp'
5254 to distinguish prompts from user-input. Instead, it notices which
5255 parts of the text were output by the process, and which entered by the
5256 user, and attaches `field' properties to allow emacs commands to use
5257 this information. Common movement commands, notably beginning-of-line,
5258 respect field boundaries in a fairly natural manner. To disable this
5259 feature, and use the old behavior, customize the user option
5260 `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields'.
5261
5262 *** Comint now includes new features to send commands to running processes
5263 and redirect the output to a designated buffer or buffers.
5264
5265 *** The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command reads a command and
5266 buffer name from the mini-buffer. The command is sent to the current
5267 buffer's process, and its output is inserted into the specified buffer.
5268
5269 The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command-to-process acts like
5270 M-x comint-redirect-send-command but additionally reads the name of
5271 the buffer whose process should be used from the mini-buffer.
5272
5273 *** Packages based on comint now highlight user input and program prompts,
5274 and support choosing previous input with mouse-2. To control these features,
5275 see the user-options `comint-highlight-input' and `comint-highlight-prompt'.
5276
5277 *** The new command `comint-write-output' (usually bound to `C-c C-s')
5278 saves the output from the most recent command to a file. With a prefix
5279 argument, it appends to the file.
5280
5281 *** The command `comint-kill-output' has been renamed `comint-delete-output'
5282 (usually bound to `C-c C-o'); the old name is aliased to it for
5283 compatibility.
5284
5285 *** The new function `comint-add-to-input-history' adds commands to the input
5286 ring (history).
5287
5288 *** The new variable `comint-input-history-ignore' is a regexp for
5289 identifying history lines that should be ignored, like tcsh time-stamp
5290 strings, starting with a `#'. The default value of this variable is "^#".
5291
5292 ** Changes to Rmail mode
5293
5294 *** The new user-option rmail-user-mail-address-regexp can be
5295 set to fine tune the identification of the correspondent when
5296 receiving new mail. If it matches the address of the sender, the
5297 recipient is taken as correspondent of a mail. If nil, the default,
5298 `user-login-name' and `user-mail-address' are used to exclude yourself
5299 as correspondent.
5300
5301 Usually you don't have to set this variable, except if you collect
5302 mails sent by you under different user names. Then it should be a
5303 regexp matching your mail addresses.
5304
5305 *** The new user-option rmail-confirm-expunge controls whether and how
5306 to ask for confirmation before expunging deleted messages from an
5307 Rmail file. You can choose between no confirmation, confirmation
5308 with y-or-n-p, or confirmation with yes-or-no-p. Default is to ask
5309 for confirmation with yes-or-no-p.
5310
5311 *** RET is now bound in the Rmail summary to rmail-summary-goto-msg,
5312 like `j'.
5313
5314 *** There is a new user option `rmail-digest-end-regexps' that
5315 specifies the regular expressions to detect the line that ends a
5316 digest message.
5317
5318 *** The new user option `rmail-automatic-folder-directives' specifies
5319 in which folder to put messages automatically.
5320
5321 *** The new function `rmail-redecode-body' allows to fix a message
5322 with non-ASCII characters if Emacs happens to decode it incorrectly
5323 due to missing or malformed "charset=" header.
5324
5325 ** The new user-option `mail-envelope-from' can be used to specify
5326 an envelope-from address different from user-mail-address.
5327
5328 ** The variable mail-specify-envelope-from controls whether to
5329 use the -f option when sending mail.
5330
5331 ** The Rmail command `o' (`rmail-output-to-rmail-file') now writes the
5332 current message in the internal `emacs-mule' encoding, rather than in
5333 the encoding taken from the variable `buffer-file-coding-system'.
5334 This allows to save messages whose characters cannot be safely encoded
5335 by the buffer's coding system, and makes sure the message will be
5336 displayed correctly when you later visit the target Rmail file.
5337
5338 If you want your Rmail files be encoded in a specific coding system
5339 other than `emacs-mule', you can customize the variable
5340 `rmail-file-coding-system' to set its value to that coding system.
5341
5342 ** Changes to TeX mode
5343
5344 *** The default mode has been changed from `plain-tex-mode' to
5345 `latex-mode'.
5346
5347 *** latex-mode now has a simple indentation algorithm.
5348
5349 *** M-f and M-p jump around \begin...\end pairs.
5350
5351 *** Added support for outline-minor-mode.
5352
5353 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
5354
5355 *** RefTeX has new support for index generation. Index entries can be
5356 created with `C-c <', with completion available on index keys.
5357 Pressing `C-c /' indexes the word at the cursor with a default
5358 macro. `C-c >' compiles all index entries into an alphabetically
5359 sorted *Index* buffer which looks like the final index. Entries
5360 can be edited from that buffer.
5361
5362 *** Label and citation key selection now allow to select several
5363 items and reference them together (use `m' to mark items, `a' or
5364 `A' to use all marked entries).
5365
5366 *** reftex.el has been split into a number of smaller files to reduce
5367 memory use when only a part of RefTeX is being used.
5368
5369 *** a new command `reftex-view-crossref-from-bibtex' (bound to `C-c &'
5370 in BibTeX-mode) can be called in a BibTeX database buffer in order
5371 to show locations in LaTeX documents where a particular entry has
5372 been cited.
5373
5374 ** Emacs Lisp mode now allows multiple levels of outline headings.
5375 The level of a heading is determined from the number of leading
5376 semicolons in a heading line. Toplevel forms starting with a `('
5377 in column 1 are always made leaves.
5378
5379 ** The M-x time-stamp command (most commonly used on write-file-hooks)
5380 has the following new features:
5381
5382 *** The patterns for finding the time stamp and for updating a pattern
5383 may match text spanning multiple lines. For example, some people like
5384 to have the filename and date on separate lines. The new variable
5385 time-stamp-inserts-lines controls the matching for multi-line patterns.
5386
5387 *** More than one time stamp can be updated in the same file. This
5388 feature is useful if you need separate time stamps in a program source
5389 file to both include in formatted documentation and insert in the
5390 compiled binary. The same time-stamp will be written at each matching
5391 pattern. The variable time-stamp-count enables this new feature; it
5392 defaults to 1.
5393
5394 ** Partial Completion mode now completes environment variables in
5395 file names.
5396
5397 ** Ispell changes
5398
5399 *** The command `ispell' now spell-checks a region if
5400 transient-mark-mode is on, and the mark is active. Otherwise it
5401 spell-checks the current buffer.
5402
5403 *** Support for synchronous subprocesses - DOS/Windoze - has been
5404 added.
5405
5406 *** An "alignment error" bug was fixed when a manual spelling
5407 correction is made and re-checked.
5408
5409 *** Italian, Portuguese, and Slovak dictionary definitions have been added.
5410
5411 *** Region skipping performance has been vastly improved in some
5412 cases.
5413
5414 *** Spell checking HTML buffers has been improved and isn't so strict
5415 on syntax errors.
5416
5417 *** The buffer-local words are now always placed on a new line at the
5418 end of the buffer.
5419
5420 *** Spell checking now works in the MS-DOS version of Emacs.
5421
5422 ** Makefile mode changes
5423
5424 *** The mode now uses the abbrev table `makefile-mode-abbrev-table'.
5425
5426 *** Conditionals and include statements are now highlighted when
5427 Fontlock mode is active.
5428
5429 ** Isearch changes
5430
5431 *** Isearch now puts a call to `isearch-resume' in the command history,
5432 so that searches can be resumed.
5433
5434 *** In Isearch mode, C-M-s and C-M-r are now bound like C-s and C-r,
5435 respectively, i.e. you can repeat a regexp isearch with the same keys
5436 that started the search.
5437
5438 *** In Isearch mode, mouse-2 in the echo area now yanks the current
5439 selection into the search string rather than giving an error.
5440
5441 *** There is a new lazy highlighting feature in incremental search.
5442
5443 Lazy highlighting is switched on/off by customizing variable
5444 `isearch-lazy-highlight'. When active, all matches for the current
5445 search string are highlighted. The current match is highlighted as
5446 before using face `isearch' or `region'. All other matches are
5447 highlighted using face `isearch-lazy-highlight-face' which defaults to
5448 `secondary-selection'.
5449
5450 The extra highlighting makes it easier to anticipate where the cursor
5451 will end up each time you press C-s or C-r to repeat a pending search.
5452 Highlighting of these additional matches happens in a deferred fashion
5453 using "idle timers," so the cycles needed do not rob isearch of its
5454 usual snappy response.
5455
5456 If `isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup' is set to t, highlights for
5457 matches are automatically cleared when you end the search. If it is
5458 set to nil, you can remove the highlights manually with `M-x
5459 isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup'.
5460
5461 ** VC Changes
5462
5463 VC has been overhauled internally. It is now modular, making it
5464 easier to plug-in arbitrary version control backends. (See Lisp
5465 Changes for details on the new structure.) As a result, the mechanism
5466 to enable and disable support for particular version systems has
5467 changed: everything is now controlled by the new variable
5468 `vc-handled-backends'. Its value is a list of symbols that identify
5469 version systems; the default is '(RCS CVS SCCS). When finding a file,
5470 each of the backends in that list is tried in order to see whether the
5471 file is registered in that backend.
5472
5473 When registering a new file, VC first tries each of the listed
5474 backends to see if any of them considers itself "responsible" for the
5475 directory of the file (e.g. because a corresponding subdirectory for
5476 master files exists). If none of the backends is responsible, then
5477 the first backend in the list that could register the file is chosen.
5478 As a consequence, the variable `vc-default-back-end' is now obsolete.
5479
5480 The old variable `vc-master-templates' is also obsolete, although VC
5481 still supports it for backward compatibility. To define templates for
5482 RCS or SCCS, you should rather use the new variables
5483 vc-{rcs,sccs}-master-templates. (There is no such feature under CVS
5484 where it doesn't make sense.)
5485
5486 The variables `vc-ignore-vc-files' and `vc-handle-cvs' are also
5487 obsolete now, you must set `vc-handled-backends' to nil or exclude
5488 `CVS' from the list, respectively, to achieve their effect now.
5489
5490 *** General Changes
5491
5492 The variable `vc-checkout-carefully' is obsolete: the corresponding
5493 checks are always done now.
5494
5495 VC Dired buffers are now kept up-to-date during all version control
5496 operations.
5497
5498 `vc-diff' output is now displayed in `diff-mode'.
5499 `vc-print-log' uses `log-view-mode'.
5500 `vc-log-mode' (used for *VC-Log*) has been replaced by `log-edit-mode'.
5501
5502 The command C-x v m (vc-merge) now accepts an empty argument as the
5503 first revision number. This means that any recent changes on the
5504 current branch should be picked up from the repository and merged into
5505 the working file (``merge news'').
5506
5507 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
5508 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) now ask for a directory name from which to work
5509 downwards.
5510
5511 *** Multiple Backends
5512
5513 VC now lets you register files in more than one backend. This is
5514 useful, for example, if you are working with a slow remote CVS
5515 repository. You can then use RCS for local editing, and occasionally
5516 commit your changes back to CVS, or pick up changes from CVS into your
5517 local RCS archives.
5518
5519 To make this work, the ``more local'' backend (RCS in our example)
5520 should come first in `vc-handled-backends', and the ``more remote''
5521 backend (CVS) should come later. (The default value of
5522 `vc-handled-backends' already has it that way.)
5523
5524 You can then commit changes to another backend (say, RCS), by typing
5525 C-u C-x v v RCS RET (i.e. vc-next-action now accepts a backend name as
5526 a revision number). VC registers the file in the more local backend
5527 if that hasn't already happened, and commits to a branch based on the
5528 current revision number from the more remote backend.
5529
5530 If a file is registered in multiple backends, you can switch to
5531 another one using C-x v b (vc-switch-backend). This does not change
5532 any files, it only changes VC's perspective on the file. Use this to
5533 pick up changes from CVS while working under RCS locally.
5534
5535 After you are done with your local RCS editing, you can commit your
5536 changes back to CVS using C-u C-x v v CVS RET. In this case, the
5537 local RCS archive is removed after the commit, and the log entry
5538 buffer is initialized to contain the entire RCS change log of the file.
5539
5540 *** Changes for CVS
5541
5542 There is a new user option, `vc-cvs-stay-local'. If it is `t' (the
5543 default), then VC avoids network queries for files registered in
5544 remote repositories. The state of such files is then only determined
5545 by heuristics and past information. `vc-cvs-stay-local' can also be a
5546 regexp to match against repository hostnames; only files from hosts
5547 that match it are treated locally. If the variable is nil, then VC
5548 queries the repository just as often as it does for local files.
5549
5550 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, then VC also makes local backups of
5551 repository versions. This means that ordinary diffs (C-x v =) and
5552 revert operations (C-x v u) can be done completely locally, without
5553 any repository interactions at all. The name of a local version
5554 backup of FILE is FILE.~REV.~, where REV is the repository version
5555 number. This format is similar to that used by C-x v ~
5556 (vc-version-other-window), except for the trailing dot. As a matter
5557 of fact, the two features can each use the files created by the other,
5558 the only difference being that files with a trailing `.' are deleted
5559 automatically after commit. (This feature doesn't work on MS-DOS,
5560 since DOS disallows more than a single dot in the trunk of a file
5561 name.)
5562
5563 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, and there have been changes in the
5564 repository, VC notifies you about it when you actually try to commit.
5565 If you want to check for updates from the repository without trying to
5566 commit, you can either use C-x v m RET to perform an update on the
5567 current file, or you can use C-x v r RET to get an update for an
5568 entire directory tree.
5569
5570 The new user option `vc-cvs-use-edit' indicates whether VC should call
5571 "cvs edit" to make files writeable; it defaults to `t'. (This option
5572 is only meaningful if the CVSREAD variable is set, or if files are
5573 "watched" by other developers.)
5574
5575 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
5576 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) are now also implemented for CVS. If you give
5577 an empty snapshot name to the latter, that performs a `cvs update',
5578 starting at the given directory.
5579
5580 *** Lisp Changes in VC
5581
5582 VC has been restructured internally to make it modular. You can now
5583 add support for arbitrary version control backends by writing a
5584 library that provides a certain set of backend-specific functions, and
5585 then telling VC to use that library. For example, to add support for
5586 a version system named SYS, you write a library named vc-sys.el, which
5587 provides a number of functions vc-sys-... (see commentary at the top
5588 of vc.el for a detailed list of them). To make VC use that library,
5589 you need to put it somewhere into Emacs' load path and add the symbol
5590 `SYS' to the list `vc-handled-backends'.
5591
5592 ** The customizable EDT emulation package now supports the EDT
5593 SUBS command and EDT scroll margins. It also works with more
5594 terminal/keyboard configurations and it now works under XEmacs.
5595 See etc/edt-user.doc for more information.
5596
5597 ** New modes and packages
5598
5599 *** The new global minor mode `minibuffer-electric-default-mode'
5600 automatically hides the `(default ...)' part of minibuffer prompts when
5601 the default is not applicable.
5602
5603 *** Artist is an Emacs lisp package that allows you to draw lines,
5604 rectangles and ellipses by using your mouse and/or keyboard. The
5605 shapes are made up with the ascii characters |, -, / and \.
5606
5607 Features are:
5608
5609 - Intersecting: When a `|' intersects with a `-', a `+' is
5610 drawn, like this: | \ /
5611 --+-- X
5612 | / \
5613
5614 - Rubber-banding: When drawing lines you can interactively see the
5615 result while holding the mouse button down and moving the mouse. If
5616 your machine is not fast enough (a 386 is a bit too slow, but a
5617 pentium is well enough), you can turn this feature off. You will
5618 then see 1's and 2's which mark the 1st and 2nd endpoint of the line
5619 you are drawing.
5620
5621 - Arrows: After having drawn a (straight) line or a (straight)
5622 poly-line, you can set arrows on the line-ends by typing < or >.
5623
5624 - Flood-filling: You can fill any area with a certain character by
5625 flood-filling.
5626
5627 - Cut copy and paste: You can cut, copy and paste rectangular
5628 regions. Artist also interfaces with the rect package (this can be
5629 turned off if it causes you any trouble) so anything you cut in
5630 artist can be yanked with C-x r y and vice versa.
5631
5632 - Drawing with keys: Everything you can do with the mouse, you can
5633 also do without the mouse.
5634
5635 - Aspect-ratio: You can set the variable artist-aspect-ratio to
5636 reflect the height-width ratio for the font you are using. Squares
5637 and circles are then drawn square/round. Note, that once your
5638 ascii-file is shown with font with a different height-width ratio,
5639 the squares won't be square and the circles won't be round.
5640
5641 - Drawing operations: The following drawing operations are implemented:
5642
5643 lines straight-lines
5644 rectangles squares
5645 poly-lines straight poly-lines
5646 ellipses circles
5647 text (see-thru) text (overwrite)
5648 spray-can setting size for spraying
5649 vaporize line vaporize lines
5650 erase characters erase rectangles
5651
5652 Straight lines are lines that go horizontally, vertically or
5653 diagonally. Plain lines go in any direction. The operations in
5654 the right column are accessed by holding down the shift key while
5655 drawing.
5656
5657 It is possible to vaporize (erase) entire lines and connected lines
5658 (rectangles for example) as long as the lines being vaporized are
5659 straight and connected at their endpoints. Vaporizing is inspired
5660 by the drawrect package by Jari Aalto <jari.aalto@poboxes.com>.
5661
5662 - Picture mode compatibility: Artist is picture mode compatible (this
5663 can be turned off).
5664
5665 *** The new package Eshell is an operating system command shell
5666 implemented entirely in Emacs Lisp. Use `M-x eshell' to invoke it.
5667 It functions similarly to bash and zsh, and allows running of Lisp
5668 functions and external commands using the same syntax. It supports
5669 history lists, aliases, extended globbing, smart scrolling, etc. It
5670 will work on any platform Emacs has been ported to. And since most of
5671 the basic commands -- ls, rm, mv, cp, ln, du, cat, etc. -- have been
5672 rewritten in Lisp, it offers an operating-system independent shell,
5673 all within the scope of your Emacs process.
5674
5675 *** The new package timeclock.el is a mode is for keeping track of time
5676 intervals. You can use it for whatever purpose you like, but the
5677 typical scenario is to keep track of how much time you spend working
5678 on certain projects.
5679
5680 *** The new package hi-lock.el provides commands to highlight matches
5681 of interactively entered regexps. For example,
5682
5683 M-x highlight-regexp RET clearly RET RET
5684
5685 will highlight all occurrences of `clearly' using a yellow background
5686 face. New occurrences of `clearly' will be highlighted as they are
5687 typed. `M-x unhighlight-regexp RET' will remove the highlighting.
5688 Any existing face can be used for highlighting and a set of
5689 appropriate faces is provided. The regexps can be written into the
5690 current buffer in a form that will be recognized the next time the
5691 corresponding file is read. There are commands to highlight matches
5692 to phrases and to highlight entire lines containing a match.
5693
5694 *** The new package zone.el plays games with Emacs' display when
5695 Emacs is idle.
5696
5697 *** The new package tildify.el allows to add hard spaces or other text
5698 fragments in accordance with the current major mode.
5699
5700 *** The new package xml.el provides a simple but generic XML
5701 parser. It doesn't parse the DTDs however.
5702
5703 *** The comment operations are now provided by the newcomment.el
5704 package which allows different styles of comment-region and should
5705 be more robust while offering the same functionality.
5706 `comment-region' now doesn't always comment a-line-at-a-time, but only
5707 comments the region, breaking the line at point if necessary.
5708
5709 *** The Ebrowse package implements a C++ class browser and tags
5710 facilities tailored for use with C++. It is documented in a
5711 separate Texinfo file.
5712
5713 *** The PCL-CVS package available by either running M-x cvs-examine or
5714 by visiting a CVS administrative directory (with a prefix argument)
5715 provides an alternative interface to VC-dired for CVS. It comes with
5716 `log-view-mode' to view RCS and SCCS logs and `log-edit-mode' used to
5717 enter check-in log messages.
5718
5719 *** The new package called `woman' allows to browse Unix man pages
5720 without invoking external programs.
5721
5722 The command `M-x woman' formats manual pages entirely in Emacs Lisp
5723 and then displays them, like `M-x manual-entry' does. Unlike
5724 `manual-entry', `woman' does not invoke any external programs, so it
5725 is useful on systems such as MS-DOS/MS-Windows where the `man' and
5726 Groff or `troff' commands are not readily available.
5727
5728 The command `M-x woman-find-file' asks for the file name of a man
5729 page, then formats and displays it like `M-x woman' does.
5730
5731 *** The new command M-x re-builder offers a convenient interface for
5732 authoring regular expressions with immediate visual feedback.
5733
5734 The buffer from which the command was called becomes the target for
5735 the regexp editor popping up in a separate window. Matching text in
5736 the target buffer is immediately color marked during the editing.
5737 Each sub-expression of the regexp will show up in a different face so
5738 even complex regexps can be edited and verified on target data in a
5739 single step.
5740
5741 On displays not supporting faces the matches instead blink like
5742 matching parens to make them stand out. On such a setup you will
5743 probably also want to use the sub-expression mode when the regexp
5744 contains such to get feedback about their respective limits.
5745
5746 *** glasses-mode is a minor mode that makes
5747 unreadableIdentifiersLikeThis readable. It works as glasses, without
5748 actually modifying content of a buffer.
5749
5750 *** The package ebnf2ps translates an EBNF to a syntactic chart in
5751 PostScript.
5752
5753 Currently accepts ad-hoc EBNF, ISO EBNF and Bison/Yacc.
5754
5755 The ad-hoc default EBNF syntax has the following elements:
5756
5757 ; comment (until end of line)
5758 A non-terminal
5759 "C" terminal
5760 ?C? special
5761 $A default non-terminal
5762 $"C" default terminal
5763 $?C? default special
5764 A = B. production (A is the header and B the body)
5765 C D sequence (C occurs before D)
5766 C | D alternative (C or D occurs)
5767 A - B exception (A excluding B, B without any non-terminal)
5768 n * A repetition (A repeats n (integer) times)
5769 (C) group (expression C is grouped together)
5770 [C] optional (C may or not occurs)
5771 C+ one or more occurrences of C
5772 {C}+ one or more occurrences of C
5773 {C}* zero or more occurrences of C
5774 {C} zero or more occurrences of C
5775 C / D equivalent to: C {D C}*
5776 {C || D}+ equivalent to: C {D C}*
5777 {C || D}* equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
5778 {C || D} equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
5779
5780 Please, see ebnf2ps documentation for EBNF syntax and how to use it.
5781
5782 *** The package align.el will align columns within a region, using M-x
5783 align. Its mode-specific rules, based on regular expressions,
5784 determine where the columns should be split. In C and C++, for
5785 example, it will align variable names in declaration lists, or the
5786 equal signs of assignments.
5787
5788 *** `paragraph-indent-minor-mode' is a new minor mode supporting
5789 paragraphs in the same style as `paragraph-indent-text-mode'.
5790
5791 *** bs.el is a new package for buffer selection similar to
5792 list-buffers or electric-buffer-list. Use M-x bs-show to display a
5793 buffer menu with this package. See the Custom group `bs'.
5794
5795 *** find-lisp.el is a package emulating the Unix find command in Lisp.
5796
5797 *** calculator.el is a small calculator package that is intended to
5798 replace desktop calculators such as xcalc and calc.exe. Actually, it
5799 is not too small - it has more features than most desktop calculators,
5800 and can be customized easily to get many more functions. It should
5801 not be confused with "calc" which is a much bigger mathematical tool
5802 which answers different needs.
5803
5804 *** The minor modes cwarn-mode and global-cwarn-mode highlights
5805 suspicious C and C++ constructions. Currently, assignments inside
5806 expressions, semicolon following `if', `for' and `while' (except, of
5807 course, after a `do .. while' statement), and C++ functions with
5808 reference parameters are recognized. The modes require font-lock mode
5809 to be enabled.
5810
5811 *** smerge-mode.el provides `smerge-mode', a simple minor-mode for files
5812 containing diff3-style conflict markers, such as generated by RCS.
5813
5814 *** 5x5.el is a simple puzzle game.
5815
5816 *** hl-line.el provides `hl-line-mode', a minor mode to highlight the
5817 current line in the current buffer. It also provides
5818 `global-hl-line-mode' to provide the same behavior in all buffers.
5819
5820 *** ansi-color.el translates ANSI terminal escapes into text-properties.
5821
5822 Please note: if `ansi-color-for-comint-mode' and
5823 `global-font-lock-mode' are non-nil, loading ansi-color.el will
5824 disable font-lock and add `ansi-color-apply' to
5825 `comint-preoutput-filter-functions' for all shell-mode buffers. This
5826 displays the output of "ls --color=yes" using the correct foreground
5827 and background colors.
5828
5829 *** delphi.el provides a major mode for editing the Delphi (Object
5830 Pascal) language.
5831
5832 *** quickurl.el provides a simple method of inserting a URL based on
5833 the text at point.
5834
5835 *** sql.el provides an interface to SQL data bases.
5836
5837 *** fortune.el uses the fortune program to create mail/news signatures.
5838
5839 *** whitespace.el is a package for warning about and cleaning bogus
5840 whitespace in a file.
5841
5842 *** PostScript mode (ps-mode) is a new major mode for editing PostScript
5843 files. It offers: interaction with a PostScript interpreter, including
5844 (very basic) error handling; fontification, easily customizable for
5845 interpreter messages; auto-indentation; insertion of EPSF templates and
5846 often used code snippets; viewing of BoundingBox; commenting out /
5847 uncommenting regions; conversion of 8bit characters to PostScript octal
5848 codes. All functionality is accessible through a menu.
5849
5850 *** delim-col helps to prettify columns in a text region or rectangle.
5851
5852 Here is an example of columns:
5853
5854 horse apple bus
5855 dog pineapple car EXTRA
5856 porcupine strawberry airplane
5857
5858 Doing the following settings:
5859
5860 (setq delimit-columns-str-before "[ ")
5861 (setq delimit-columns-str-after " ]")
5862 (setq delimit-columns-str-separator ", ")
5863 (setq delimit-columns-separator "\t")
5864
5865
5866 Selecting the lines above and typing:
5867
5868 M-x delimit-columns-region
5869
5870 It results:
5871
5872 [ horse , apple , bus , ]
5873 [ dog , pineapple , car , EXTRA ]
5874 [ porcupine, strawberry, airplane, ]
5875
5876 delim-col has the following options:
5877
5878 delimit-columns-str-before Specify a string to be inserted
5879 before all columns.
5880
5881 delimit-columns-str-separator Specify a string to be inserted
5882 between each column.
5883
5884 delimit-columns-str-after Specify a string to be inserted
5885 after all columns.
5886
5887 delimit-columns-separator Specify a regexp which separates
5888 each column.
5889
5890 delim-col has the following commands:
5891
5892 delimit-columns-region Prettify all columns in a text region.
5893 delimit-columns-rectangle Prettify all columns in a text rectangle.
5894
5895 *** Recentf mode maintains a menu for visiting files that were
5896 operated on recently. User option recentf-menu-filter specifies a
5897 menu filter function to change the menu appearance. For example, the
5898 recent file list can be displayed:
5899
5900 - organized by major modes, directories or user defined rules.
5901 - sorted by file paths, file names, ascending or descending.
5902 - showing paths relative to the current default-directory
5903
5904 The `recentf-filter-changer' menu filter function allows to
5905 dynamically change the menu appearance.
5906
5907 *** elide-head.el provides a mechanism for eliding boilerplate header
5908 text.
5909
5910 *** footnote.el provides `footnote-mode', a minor mode supporting use
5911 of footnotes. It is intended for use with Message mode, but isn't
5912 specific to Message mode.
5913
5914 *** diff-mode.el provides `diff-mode', a major mode for
5915 viewing/editing context diffs (patches). It is selected for files
5916 with extension `.diff', `.diffs', `.patch' and `.rej'.
5917
5918 *** EUDC, the Emacs Unified Directory Client, provides a common user
5919 interface to access directory servers using different directory
5920 protocols. It has a separate manual.
5921
5922 *** autoconf.el provides a major mode for editing configure.in files
5923 for Autoconf, selected automatically.
5924
5925 *** windmove.el provides moving between windows.
5926
5927 *** crm.el provides a facility to read multiple strings from the
5928 minibuffer with completion.
5929
5930 *** todo-mode.el provides management of TODO lists and integration
5931 with the diary features.
5932
5933 *** autoarg.el provides a feature reported from Twenex Emacs whereby
5934 numeric keys supply prefix args rather than self inserting.
5935
5936 *** The function `turn-off-auto-fill' unconditionally turns off Auto
5937 Fill mode.
5938
5939 *** pcomplete.el is a library that provides programmable completion
5940 facilities for Emacs, similar to what zsh and tcsh offer. The main
5941 difference is that completion functions are written in Lisp, meaning
5942 they can be profiled, debugged, etc.
5943
5944 *** antlr-mode is a new major mode for editing ANTLR grammar files.
5945 It is automatically turned on for files whose names have the extension
5946 `.g'.
5947
5948 ** Changes in sort.el
5949
5950 The function sort-numeric-fields interprets numbers starting with `0'
5951 as octal and numbers starting with `0x' or `0X' as hexadecimal. The
5952 new user-option sort-numeric-base can be used to specify a default
5953 numeric base.
5954
5955 ** Changes to Ange-ftp
5956
5957 *** Ange-ftp allows you to specify of a port number in remote file
5958 names cleanly. It is appended to the host name, separated by a hash
5959 sign, e.g. `/foo@bar.org#666:mumble'. (This syntax comes from EFS.)
5960
5961 *** If the new user-option `ange-ftp-try-passive-mode' is set, passive
5962 ftp mode will be used if the ftp client supports that.
5963
5964 *** Ange-ftp handles the output of the w32-style clients which
5965 output ^M at the end of lines.
5966
5967 ** The recommended way of using Iswitchb is via the new global minor
5968 mode `iswitchb-mode'.
5969
5970 ** Just loading the msb package doesn't switch on Msb mode anymore.
5971 If you have `(require 'msb)' in your .emacs, please replace it with
5972 `(msb-mode 1)'.
5973
5974 ** Flyspell mode has various new options. See the `flyspell' Custom
5975 group.
5976
5977 ** The user option `backward-delete-char-untabify-method' controls the
5978 behavior of `backward-delete-char-untabify'. The following values
5979 are recognized:
5980
5981 `untabify' -- turn a tab to many spaces, then delete one space;
5982 `hungry' -- delete all whitespace, both tabs and spaces;
5983 `all' -- delete all whitespace, including tabs, spaces and newlines;
5984 nil -- just delete one character.
5985
5986 Default value is `untabify'.
5987
5988 [This change was made in Emacs 20.3 but not mentioned then.]
5989
5990 ** In Cperl mode `cperl-invalid-face' should now be a normal face
5991 symbol, not double-quoted.
5992
5993 ** Some packages are declared obsolete, to be removed in a future
5994 version. They are: auto-show, c-mode, hilit19, hscroll, ooutline,
5995 profile, rnews, rnewspost, and sc. Their implementations have been
5996 moved to lisp/obsolete.
5997
5998 ** auto-compression mode is no longer enabled just by loading jka-compr.el.
5999 To control it, set `auto-compression-mode' via Custom or use the
6000 `auto-compression-mode' command.
6001
6002 ** `browse-url-gnome-moz' is a new option for
6003 `browse-url-browser-function', invoking Mozilla in GNOME, and
6004 `browse-url-kde' can be chosen for invoking the KDE browser.
6005
6006 ** The user-option `browse-url-new-window-p' has been renamed to
6007 `browse-url-new-window-flag'.
6008
6009 ** The functions `keep-lines', `flush-lines' and `how-many' now
6010 operate on the active region in Transient Mark mode.
6011
6012 ** `gnus-user-agent' is a new possibility for `mail-user-agent'. It
6013 is like `message-user-agent', but with all the Gnus paraphernalia.
6014
6015 ** The Strokes package has been updated. If your Emacs has XPM
6016 support, you can use it for pictographic editing. In Strokes mode,
6017 use C-mouse-2 to compose a complex stoke and insert it into the
6018 buffer. You can encode or decode a strokes buffer with new commands
6019 M-x strokes-encode-buffer and M-x strokes-decode-buffer. There is a
6020 new command M-x strokes-list-strokes.
6021
6022 ** Hexl contains a new command `hexl-insert-hex-string' which inserts
6023 a string of hexadecimal numbers read from the mini-buffer.
6024
6025 ** Hexl mode allows to insert non-ASCII characters.
6026
6027 The non-ASCII characters are encoded using the same encoding as the
6028 file you are visiting in Hexl mode.
6029
6030 ** Shell script mode changes.
6031
6032 Shell script mode (sh-script) can now indent scripts for shells
6033 derived from sh and rc. The indentation style is customizable, and
6034 sh-script can attempt to "learn" the current buffer's style.
6035
6036 ** Etags changes.
6037
6038 *** In DOS, etags looks for file.cgz if it cannot find file.c.
6039
6040 *** New option --ignore-case-regex is an alternative to --regex. It is now
6041 possible to bind a regexp to a language, by prepending the regexp with
6042 {lang}, where lang is one of the languages that `etags --help' prints out.
6043 This feature is useful especially for regex files, where each line contains
6044 a regular expression. The manual contains details.
6045
6046 *** In C and derived languages, etags creates tags for function
6047 declarations when given the --declarations option.
6048
6049 *** In C++, tags are created for "operator". The tags have the form
6050 "operator+", without spaces between the keyword and the operator.
6051
6052 *** You shouldn't generally need any more the -C or -c++ option: etags
6053 automatically switches to C++ parsing when it meets the `class' or
6054 `template' keywords.
6055
6056 *** Etags now is able to delve at arbitrary deeps into nested structures in
6057 C-like languages. Previously, it was limited to one or two brace levels.
6058
6059 *** New language Ada: tags are functions, procedures, packages, tasks, and
6060 types.
6061
6062 *** In Fortran, `procedure' is not tagged.
6063
6064 *** In Java, tags are created for "interface".
6065
6066 *** In Lisp, "(defstruct (foo", "(defun (operator" and similar constructs
6067 are now tagged.
6068
6069 *** In makefiles, tags the targets.
6070
6071 *** In Perl, the --globals option tags global variables. my and local
6072 variables are tagged.
6073
6074 *** New language Python: def and class at the beginning of a line are tags.
6075
6076 *** .ss files are Scheme files, .pdb is Postscript with C syntax, .psw is
6077 for PSWrap.
6078
6079 ** Changes in etags.el
6080
6081 *** The new user-option tags-case-fold-search can be used to make
6082 tags operations case-sensitive or case-insensitive. The default
6083 is to use the same setting as case-fold-search.
6084
6085 *** You can display additional output with M-x tags-apropos by setting
6086 the new variable tags-apropos-additional-actions.
6087
6088 If non-nil, the variable's value should be a list of triples (TITLE
6089 FUNCTION TO-SEARCH). For each triple, M-x tags-apropos processes
6090 TO-SEARCH and lists tags from it. TO-SEARCH should be an alist,
6091 obarray, or symbol. If it is a symbol, the symbol's value is used.
6092
6093 TITLE is a string to use to label the list of tags from TO-SEARCH.
6094
6095 FUNCTION is a function to call when an entry is selected in the Tags
6096 List buffer. It is called with one argument, the selected symbol.
6097
6098 A useful example value for this variable might be something like:
6099
6100 '(("Emacs Lisp" Info-goto-emacs-command-node obarray)
6101 ("Common Lisp" common-lisp-hyperspec common-lisp-hyperspec-obarray)
6102 ("SCWM" scwm-documentation scwm-obarray))
6103
6104 *** The face tags-tag-face can be used to customize the appearance
6105 of tags in the output of M-x tags-apropos.
6106
6107 *** Setting tags-apropos-verbose to a non-nil value displays the
6108 names of tags files in the *Tags List* buffer.
6109
6110 *** You can now search for tags that are part of the filename itself.
6111 If you have tagged the files topfile.c subdir/subfile.c
6112 /tmp/tempfile.c, you can now search for tags "topfile.c", "subfile.c",
6113 "dir/sub", "tempfile", "tempfile.c". If the tag matches the file name,
6114 point will go to the beginning of the file.
6115
6116 *** Compressed files are now transparently supported if
6117 auto-compression-mode is active. You can tag (with Etags) and search
6118 (with find-tag) both compressed and uncompressed files.
6119
6120 *** Tags commands like M-x tags-search no longer change point
6121 in buffers where no match is found. In buffers where a match is
6122 found, the original value of point is pushed on the marker ring.
6123
6124 ** Fortran mode has a new command `fortran-strip-sequence-nos' to
6125 remove text past column 72. The syntax class of `\' in Fortran is now
6126 appropriate for C-style escape sequences in strings.
6127
6128 ** SGML mode's default `sgml-validate-command' is now `nsgmls'.
6129
6130 ** A new command `view-emacs-problems' (C-h P) displays the PROBLEMS file.
6131
6132 ** The Dabbrev package has a new user-option `dabbrev-ignored-regexps'
6133 containing a list of regular expressions. Buffers matching a regular
6134 expression from that list, are not checked.
6135
6136 ** Emacs can now figure out modification times of remote files.
6137 When you do C-x C-f /user@host:/path/file RET and edit the file,
6138 and someone else modifies the file, you will be prompted to revert
6139 the buffer, just like for the local files.
6140
6141 ** The buffer menu (C-x C-b) no longer lists the *Buffer List* buffer.
6142
6143 ** When invoked with a prefix argument, the command `list-abbrevs' now
6144 displays local abbrevs, only.
6145
6146 ** Refill minor mode provides preliminary support for keeping
6147 paragraphs filled as you modify them.
6148
6149 ** The variable `double-click-fuzz' specifies how much the mouse
6150 may be moved between clicks that are recognized as a pair. Its value
6151 is measured in pixels.
6152
6153 ** The new global minor mode `auto-image-file-mode' allows image files
6154 to be visited as images.
6155
6156 ** Two new user-options `grep-command' and `grep-find-command'
6157 were added to compile.el.
6158
6159 ** Withdrawn packages
6160
6161 *** mldrag.el has been removed. mouse.el provides the same
6162 functionality with aliases for the mldrag functions.
6163
6164 *** eval-reg.el has been obsoleted by changes to edebug.el and removed.
6165
6166 *** ph.el has been obsoleted by EUDC and removed.
6167
6168 \f
6169 * Incompatible Lisp changes
6170
6171 There are a few Lisp changes which are not backwards-compatible and
6172 may require changes to existing code. Here is a list for reference.
6173 See the sections below for details.
6174
6175 ** Since `format' preserves text properties, the idiom
6176 `(format "%s" foo)' no longer works to copy and remove properties.
6177 Use `copy-sequence' to copy the string, then use `set-text-properties'
6178 to remove the properties of the copy.
6179
6180 ** Since the `keymap' text property now has significance, some code
6181 which uses both `local-map' and `keymap' properties (for portability)
6182 may, for instance, give rise to duplicate menus when the keymaps from
6183 these properties are active.
6184
6185 ** The change in the treatment of non-ASCII characters in search
6186 ranges may affect some code.
6187
6188 ** A non-nil value for the LOCAL arg of add-hook makes the hook
6189 buffer-local even if `make-local-hook' hasn't been called, which might
6190 make a difference to some code.
6191
6192 ** The new treatment of the minibuffer prompt might affect code which
6193 operates on the minibuffer.
6194
6195 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
6196 cause `no-conversion' and `emacs-mule-unix' coding systems to produce
6197 different results when reading files with non-ASCII characters
6198 (previously, both coding systems would produce the same results).
6199 Specifically, `no-conversion' interprets each 8-bit byte as a separate
6200 character. This makes `no-conversion' inappropriate for reading
6201 multibyte text, e.g. buffers written to disk in their internal MULE
6202 encoding (auto-saving does that, for example). If a Lisp program
6203 reads such files with `no-conversion', each byte of the multibyte
6204 sequence, including the MULE leading codes such as \201, is treated as
6205 a separate character, which prevents them from being interpreted in
6206 the buffer as multibyte characters.
6207
6208 Therefore, Lisp programs that read files which contain the internal
6209 MULE encoding should use `emacs-mule-unix'. `no-conversion' is only
6210 appropriate for reading truly binary files.
6211
6212 ** Code that relies on the obsolete `before-change-function' and
6213 `after-change-function' to detect buffer changes will now fail. Use
6214 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions' instead.
6215
6216 ** Code that uses `concat' with integer args now gets an error, as
6217 long promised. So does any code that uses derivatives of `concat',
6218 such as `mapconcat'.
6219
6220 ** The function base64-decode-string now always returns a unibyte
6221 string.
6222
6223 ** Not a Lisp incompatibility as such but, with the introduction of
6224 extra private charsets, there is now only one slot free for a new
6225 dimension-2 private charset. User code which tries to add more than
6226 one extra will fail unless you rebuild Emacs with some standard
6227 charset(s) removed; that is probably inadvisable because it changes
6228 the emacs-mule encoding. Also, files stored in the emacs-mule
6229 encoding using Emacs 20 with additional private charsets defined will
6230 probably not be read correctly by Emacs 21.
6231
6232 ** The variable `directory-sep-char' is slated for removal.
6233 Not really a change (yet), but a projected one that you should be
6234 aware of: The variable `directory-sep-char' is deprecated, and should
6235 not be used. It was always ignored on GNU/Linux and Unix systems and
6236 on MS-DOS, but the MS-Windows port tried to support it by adapting the
6237 behavior of certain primitives to the value of this variable. It
6238 turned out that such support cannot be reliable, so it was decided to
6239 remove this variable in the near future. Lisp programs are well
6240 advised not to set it to anything but '/', because any different value
6241 will not have any effect when support for this variable is removed.
6242
6243 \f
6244 * Lisp changes made after edition 2.6 of the Emacs Lisp Manual,
6245 (Display-related features are described in a page of their own below.)
6246
6247 ** Function assq-delete-all replaces function assoc-delete-all.
6248
6249 ** The new function animate-string, from lisp/play/animate.el
6250 allows the animated display of strings.
6251
6252 ** The new function `interactive-form' can be used to obtain the
6253 interactive form of a function.
6254
6255 ** The keyword :set-after in defcustom allows to specify dependencies
6256 between custom options. Example:
6257
6258 (defcustom default-input-method nil
6259 "*Default input method for multilingual text (a string).
6260 This is the input method activated automatically by the command
6261 `toggle-input-method' (\\[toggle-input-method])."
6262 :group 'mule
6263 :type '(choice (const nil) string)
6264 :set-after '(current-language-environment))
6265
6266 This specifies that default-input-method should be set after
6267 current-language-environment even if default-input-method appears
6268 first in a custom-set-variables statement.
6269
6270 ** The new hook `kbd-macro-termination-hook' is run at the end of
6271 function execute-kbd-macro. Functions on this hook are called with no
6272 args. The hook is run independent of how the macro was terminated
6273 (signal or normal termination).
6274
6275 ** Functions `butlast' and `nbutlast' for removing trailing elements
6276 from a list are now available without requiring the CL package.
6277
6278 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
6279 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
6280
6281 ** The user-option `face-font-registry-alternatives' specifies
6282 alternative font registry names to try when looking for a font.
6283
6284 ** Function `md5' calculates the MD5 "message digest"/"checksum".
6285
6286 ** Function `delete-frame' runs `delete-frame-hook' before actually
6287 deleting the frame. The hook is called with one arg, the frame
6288 being deleted.
6289
6290 ** `add-hook' now makes the hook local if called with a non-nil LOCAL arg.
6291
6292 ** The treatment of non-ASCII characters in search ranges has changed.
6293 If a range in a regular expression or the arg of
6294 skip-chars-forward/backward starts with a unibyte character C and ends
6295 with a multibyte character C2, the range is divided into two: one is
6296 C..?\377, the other is C1..C2, where C1 is the first character of C2's
6297 charset.
6298
6299 ** The new function `display-message-or-buffer' displays a message in
6300 the echo area or pops up a buffer, depending on the length of the
6301 message.
6302
6303 ** The new macro `with-auto-compression-mode' allows evaluating an
6304 expression with auto-compression-mode enabled.
6305
6306 ** In image specifications, `:heuristic-mask' has been replaced
6307 with the more general `:mask' property.
6308
6309 ** Image specifications accept more `:conversion's.
6310
6311 ** A `?' can be used in a symbol name without escaping it with a
6312 backslash.
6313
6314 ** Reading from the mini-buffer now reads from standard input if Emacs
6315 is running in batch mode. For example,
6316
6317 (message "%s" (read t))
6318
6319 will read a Lisp expression from standard input and print the result
6320 to standard output.
6321
6322 ** The argument of `down-list', `backward-up-list', `up-list',
6323 `kill-sexp', `backward-kill-sexp' and `mark-sexp' is now optional.
6324
6325 ** If `display-buffer-reuse-frames' is set, function `display-buffer'
6326 will raise frames displaying a buffer, instead of creating a new
6327 frame or window.
6328
6329 ** Two new functions for removing elements from lists/sequences
6330 were added
6331
6332 - Function: remove ELT SEQ
6333
6334 Return a copy of SEQ with all occurrences of ELT removed. SEQ must be
6335 a list, vector, or string. The comparison is done with `equal'.
6336
6337 - Function: remq ELT LIST
6338
6339 Return a copy of LIST with all occurrences of ELT removed. The
6340 comparison is done with `eq'.
6341
6342 ** The function `delete' now also works with vectors and strings.
6343
6344 ** The meaning of the `:weakness WEAK' argument of make-hash-table
6345 has been changed: WEAK can now have new values `key-or-value' and
6346 `key-and-value', in addition to `nil', `key', `value', and `t'.
6347
6348 ** Function `aset' stores any multibyte character in any string
6349 without signaling "Attempt to change char length of a string". It may
6350 convert a unibyte string to multibyte if necessary.
6351
6352 ** The value of the `help-echo' text property is called as a function
6353 or evaluated, if it is not a string already, to obtain a help string.
6354
6355 ** Function `make-obsolete' now has an optional arg to say when the
6356 function was declared obsolete.
6357
6358 ** Function `plist-member' is renamed from `widget-plist-member' (which is
6359 retained as an alias).
6360
6361 ** Easy-menu's :filter now works as in XEmacs.
6362 It takes the unconverted (i.e. XEmacs) form of the menu and the result
6363 is automatically converted to Emacs' form.
6364
6365 ** The new function `window-list' has been defined
6366
6367 - Function: window-list &optional FRAME WINDOW MINIBUF
6368
6369 Return a list of windows on FRAME, starting with WINDOW. FRAME nil or
6370 omitted means use the selected frame. WINDOW nil or omitted means use
6371 the selected window. MINIBUF t means include the minibuffer window,
6372 even if it isn't active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means include the
6373 minibuffer window only if it's active. MINIBUF neither nil nor t
6374 means never include the minibuffer window.
6375
6376 ** There's a new function `get-window-with-predicate' defined as follows
6377
6378 - Function: get-window-with-predicate PREDICATE &optional MINIBUF ALL-FRAMES DEFAULT
6379
6380 Return a window satisfying PREDICATE.
6381
6382 This function cycles through all visible windows using `walk-windows',
6383 calling PREDICATE on each one. PREDICATE is called with a window as
6384 argument. The first window for which PREDICATE returns a non-nil
6385 value is returned. If no window satisfies PREDICATE, DEFAULT is
6386 returned.
6387
6388 Optional second arg MINIBUF t means count the minibuffer window even
6389 if not active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means count the minibuffer iff
6390 it is active. MINIBUF neither t nor nil means not to count the
6391 minibuffer even if it is active.
6392
6393 Several frames may share a single minibuffer; if the minibuffer
6394 counts, all windows on all frames that share that minibuffer count
6395 too. Therefore, if you are using a separate minibuffer frame
6396 and the minibuffer is active and MINIBUF says it counts,
6397 `walk-windows' includes the windows in the frame from which you
6398 entered the minibuffer, as well as the minibuffer window.
6399
6400 ALL-FRAMES is the optional third argument.
6401 ALL-FRAMES nil or omitted means cycle within the frames as specified above.
6402 ALL-FRAMES = `visible' means include windows on all visible frames.
6403 ALL-FRAMES = 0 means include windows on all visible and iconified frames.
6404 ALL-FRAMES = t means include windows on all frames including invisible frames.
6405 If ALL-FRAMES is a frame, it means include windows on that frame.
6406 Anything else means restrict to the selected frame.
6407
6408 ** The function `single-key-description' now encloses function key and
6409 event names in angle brackets. When called with a second optional
6410 argument non-nil, angle brackets won't be printed.
6411
6412 ** If the variable `message-truncate-lines' is bound to t around a
6413 call to `message', the echo area will not be resized to display that
6414 message; it will be truncated instead, as it was done in 20.x.
6415 Default value is nil.
6416
6417 ** The user option `line-number-display-limit' can now be set to nil,
6418 meaning no limit.
6419
6420 ** The new user option `line-number-display-limit-width' controls
6421 the maximum width of lines in a buffer for which Emacs displays line
6422 numbers in the mode line. The default is 200.
6423
6424 ** `select-safe-coding-system' now also checks the most preferred
6425 coding-system if buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and
6426 DEFAULT-CODING-SYSTEM is not specified,
6427
6428 ** The function `subr-arity' provides information about the argument
6429 list of a primitive.
6430
6431 ** `where-is-internal' now also accepts a list of keymaps.
6432
6433 ** The text property `keymap' specifies a key map which overrides the
6434 buffer's local map and the map specified by the `local-map' property.
6435 This is probably what most current uses of `local-map' want, rather
6436 than replacing the local map.
6437
6438 ** The obsolete variables `before-change-function' and
6439 `after-change-function' are no longer acted upon and have been
6440 removed. Use `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions'
6441 instead.
6442
6443 ** The function `apropos-mode' runs the hook `apropos-mode-hook'.
6444
6445 ** `concat' no longer accepts individual integer arguments,
6446 as promised long ago.
6447
6448 ** The new function `float-time' returns the current time as a float.
6449
6450 ** The new variable auto-coding-regexp-alist specifies coding systems
6451 for reading specific files, analogous to auto-coding-alist, but
6452 patterns are checked against file contents instead of file names.
6453
6454 \f
6455 * Lisp changes in Emacs 21.1 (see following page for display-related features)
6456
6457 ** The new package rx.el provides an alternative sexp notation for
6458 regular expressions.
6459
6460 - Function: rx-to-string SEXP
6461
6462 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
6463
6464 - Macro: rx SEXP
6465
6466 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
6467
6468 The following are valid subforms of regular expressions in sexp
6469 notation.
6470
6471 STRING
6472 matches string STRING literally.
6473
6474 CHAR
6475 matches character CHAR literally.
6476
6477 `not-newline'
6478 matches any character except a newline.
6479 .
6480 `anything'
6481 matches any character
6482
6483 `(any SET)'
6484 matches any character in SET. SET may be a character or string.
6485 Ranges of characters can be specified as `A-Z' in strings.
6486
6487 '(in SET)'
6488 like `any'.
6489
6490 `(not (any SET))'
6491 matches any character not in SET
6492
6493 `line-start'
6494 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of a line
6495 in the text being matched
6496
6497 `line-end'
6498 is similar to `line-start' but matches only at the end of a line
6499
6500 `string-start'
6501 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
6502 string being matched against.
6503
6504 `string-end'
6505 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
6506 string being matched against.
6507
6508 `buffer-start'
6509 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
6510 buffer being matched against.
6511
6512 `buffer-end'
6513 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
6514 buffer being matched against.
6515
6516 `point'
6517 matches the empty string, but only at point.
6518
6519 `word-start'
6520 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
6521 word.
6522
6523 `word-end'
6524 matches the empty string, but only at the end of a word.
6525
6526 `word-boundary'
6527 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
6528 word.
6529
6530 `(not word-boundary)'
6531 matches the empty string, but not at the beginning or end of a
6532 word.
6533
6534 `digit'
6535 matches 0 through 9.
6536
6537 `control'
6538 matches ASCII control characters.
6539
6540 `hex-digit'
6541 matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
6542
6543 `blank'
6544 matches space and tab only.
6545
6546 `graphic'
6547 matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
6548 space, and DEL.
6549
6550 `printing'
6551 matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
6552 and DEL.
6553
6554 `alphanumeric'
6555 matches letters and digits. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
6556 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
6557
6558 `letter'
6559 matches letters. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
6560 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
6561
6562 `ascii'
6563 matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
6564
6565 `nonascii'
6566 matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
6567
6568 `lower'
6569 matches anything lower-case.
6570
6571 `upper'
6572 matches anything upper-case.
6573
6574 `punctuation'
6575 matches punctuation. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
6576 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
6577
6578 `space'
6579 matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
6580
6581 `word'
6582 matches anything that has word syntax.
6583
6584 `(syntax SYNTAX)'
6585 matches a character with syntax SYNTAX. SYNTAX must be one
6586 of the following symbols.
6587
6588 `whitespace' (\\s- in string notation)
6589 `punctuation' (\\s.)
6590 `word' (\\sw)
6591 `symbol' (\\s_)
6592 `open-parenthesis' (\\s()
6593 `close-parenthesis' (\\s))
6594 `expression-prefix' (\\s')
6595 `string-quote' (\\s\")
6596 `paired-delimiter' (\\s$)
6597 `escape' (\\s\\)
6598 `character-quote' (\\s/)
6599 `comment-start' (\\s<)
6600 `comment-end' (\\s>)
6601
6602 `(not (syntax SYNTAX))'
6603 matches a character that has not syntax SYNTAX.
6604
6605 `(category CATEGORY)'
6606 matches a character with category CATEGORY. CATEGORY must be
6607 either a character to use for C, or one of the following symbols.
6608
6609 `consonant' (\\c0 in string notation)
6610 `base-vowel' (\\c1)
6611 `upper-diacritical-mark' (\\c2)
6612 `lower-diacritical-mark' (\\c3)
6613 `tone-mark' (\\c4)
6614 `symbol' (\\c5)
6615 `digit' (\\c6)
6616 `vowel-modifying-diacritical-mark' (\\c7)
6617 `vowel-sign' (\\c8)
6618 `semivowel-lower' (\\c9)
6619 `not-at-end-of-line' (\\c<)
6620 `not-at-beginning-of-line' (\\c>)
6621 `alpha-numeric-two-byte' (\\cA)
6622 `chinse-two-byte' (\\cC)
6623 `greek-two-byte' (\\cG)
6624 `japanese-hiragana-two-byte' (\\cH)
6625 `indian-two-byte' (\\cI)
6626 `japanese-katakana-two-byte' (\\cK)
6627 `korean-hangul-two-byte' (\\cN)
6628 `cyrillic-two-byte' (\\cY)
6629 `ascii' (\\ca)
6630 `arabic' (\\cb)
6631 `chinese' (\\cc)
6632 `ethiopic' (\\ce)
6633 `greek' (\\cg)
6634 `korean' (\\ch)
6635 `indian' (\\ci)
6636 `japanese' (\\cj)
6637 `japanese-katakana' (\\ck)
6638 `latin' (\\cl)
6639 `lao' (\\co)
6640 `tibetan' (\\cq)
6641 `japanese-roman' (\\cr)
6642 `thai' (\\ct)
6643 `vietnamese' (\\cv)
6644 `hebrew' (\\cw)
6645 `cyrillic' (\\cy)
6646 `can-break' (\\c|)
6647
6648 `(not (category CATEGORY))'
6649 matches a character that has not category CATEGORY.
6650
6651 `(and SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
6652 matches what SEXP1 matches, followed by what SEXP2 matches, etc.
6653
6654 `(submatch SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
6655 like `and', but makes the match accessible with `match-end',
6656 `match-beginning', and `match-string'.
6657
6658 `(group SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
6659 another name for `submatch'.
6660
6661 `(or SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
6662 matches anything that matches SEXP1 or SEXP2, etc. If all
6663 args are strings, use `regexp-opt' to optimize the resulting
6664 regular expression.
6665
6666 `(minimal-match SEXP)'
6667 produce a non-greedy regexp for SEXP. Normally, regexps matching
6668 zero or more occurrences of something are \"greedy\" in that they
6669 match as much as they can, as long as the overall regexp can
6670 still match. A non-greedy regexp matches as little as possible.
6671
6672 `(maximal-match SEXP)'
6673 produce a greedy regexp for SEXP. This is the default.
6674
6675 `(zero-or-more SEXP)'
6676 matches zero or more occurrences of what SEXP matches.
6677
6678 `(0+ SEXP)'
6679 like `zero-or-more'.
6680
6681 `(* SEXP)'
6682 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
6683
6684 `(*? SEXP)'
6685 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
6686
6687 `(one-or-more SEXP)'
6688 matches one or more occurrences of A.
6689
6690 `(1+ SEXP)'
6691 like `one-or-more'.
6692
6693 `(+ SEXP)'
6694 like `one-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
6695
6696 `(+? SEXP)'
6697 like `one-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
6698
6699 `(zero-or-one SEXP)'
6700 matches zero or one occurrences of A.
6701
6702 `(optional SEXP)'
6703 like `zero-or-one'.
6704
6705 `(? SEXP)'
6706 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a greedy regexp.
6707
6708 `(?? SEXP)'
6709 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
6710
6711 `(repeat N SEXP)'
6712 matches N occurrences of what SEXP matches.
6713
6714 `(repeat N M SEXP)'
6715 matches N to M occurrences of what SEXP matches.
6716
6717 `(eval FORM)'
6718 evaluate FORM and insert result. If result is a string,
6719 `regexp-quote' it.
6720
6721 `(regexp REGEXP)'
6722 include REGEXP in string notation in the result.
6723
6724 *** The features `md5' and `overlay' are now provided by default.
6725
6726 *** The special form `save-restriction' now works correctly even if the
6727 buffer is widened inside the save-restriction and changes made outside
6728 the original restriction. Previously, doing this would cause the saved
6729 restriction to be restored incorrectly.
6730
6731 *** The functions `find-charset-region' and `find-charset-string' include
6732 `eight-bit-control' and/or `eight-bit-graphic' in the returned list
6733 when they find 8-bit characters. Previously, they included `ascii' in a
6734 multibyte buffer and `unknown' in a unibyte buffer.
6735
6736 *** The functions `set-buffer-multibyte', `string-as-multibyte' and
6737 `string-as-unibyte' change the byte sequence of a buffer or a string
6738 if it contains a character from the `eight-bit-control' character set.
6739
6740 *** The handling of multibyte sequences in a multibyte buffer is
6741 changed. Previously, a byte sequence matching the pattern
6742 [\200-\237][\240-\377]+ was interpreted as a single character
6743 regardless of the length of the trailing bytes [\240-\377]+. Thus, if
6744 the sequence was longer than what the leading byte indicated, the
6745 extra trailing bytes were ignored by Lisp functions. Now such extra
6746 bytes are independent 8-bit characters belonging to the charset
6747 eight-bit-graphic.
6748
6749 ** Fontsets are now implemented using char-tables.
6750
6751 A fontset can now be specified for each independent character, for
6752 a group of characters or for a character set rather than just for a
6753 character set as previously.
6754
6755 *** The arguments of the function `set-fontset-font' are changed.
6756 They are NAME, CHARACTER, FONTNAME, and optional FRAME. The function
6757 modifies fontset NAME to use FONTNAME for CHARACTER.
6758
6759 CHARACTER may be a cons (FROM . TO), where FROM and TO are non-generic
6760 characters. In that case FONTNAME is used for all characters in the
6761 range FROM and TO (inclusive). CHARACTER may be a charset. In that
6762 case FONTNAME is used for all character in the charset.
6763
6764 FONTNAME may be a cons (FAMILY . REGISTRY), where FAMILY is the family
6765 name of a font and REGISTRY is a registry name of a font.
6766
6767 *** Variable x-charset-registry has been deleted. The default charset
6768 registries of character sets are set in the default fontset
6769 "fontset-default".
6770
6771 *** The function `create-fontset-from-fontset-spec' ignores the second
6772 argument STYLE-VARIANT. It never creates style-variant fontsets.
6773
6774 ** The method of composing characters is changed. Now character
6775 composition is done by a special text property `composition' in
6776 buffers and strings.
6777
6778 *** Charset composition is deleted. Emacs never creates a `composite
6779 character' which is an independent character with a unique character
6780 code. Thus the following functions handling `composite characters'
6781 have been deleted: composite-char-component,
6782 composite-char-component-count, composite-char-composition-rule,
6783 composite-char-composition-rule and decompose-composite-char delete.
6784 The variables leading-code-composition and min-composite-char have
6785 also been deleted.
6786
6787 *** Three more glyph reference points are added. They can be used to
6788 specify a composition rule. See the documentation of the variable
6789 `reference-point-alist' for more detail.
6790
6791 *** The function `compose-region' takes new arguments COMPONENTS and
6792 MODIFICATION-FUNC. With COMPONENTS, you can specify not only a
6793 composition rule but also characters to be composed. Such characters
6794 may differ between buffer and string text.
6795
6796 *** The function `compose-string' takes new arguments START, END,
6797 COMPONENTS, and MODIFICATION-FUNC.
6798
6799 *** The function `compose-string' puts text property `composition'
6800 directly on the argument STRING instead of returning a new string.
6801 Likewise, the function `decompose-string' just removes text property
6802 `composition' from STRING.
6803
6804 *** The new function `find-composition' returns information about
6805 a composition at a specified position in a buffer or a string.
6806
6807 *** The function `decompose-composite-char' is now labeled as
6808 obsolete.
6809
6810 ** The new coding system `mac-roman' is primarily intended for use on
6811 the Macintosh but may be used generally for Macintosh-encoded text.
6812
6813 ** The new character sets `mule-unicode-0100-24ff',
6814 `mule-unicode-2500-33ff', and `mule-unicode-e000-ffff' have been
6815 introduced for Unicode characters in the range U+0100..U+24FF,
6816 U+2500..U+33FF, U+E000..U+FFFF respectively.
6817
6818 Note that the character sets are not yet unified in Emacs, so
6819 characters which belong to charsets such as Latin-2, Greek, Hebrew,
6820 etc. and the same characters in the `mule-unicode-*' charsets are
6821 different characters, as far as Emacs is concerned. For example, text
6822 which includes Unicode characters from the Latin-2 locale cannot be
6823 encoded by Emacs with ISO 8859-2 coding system.
6824
6825 ** The new coding system `mule-utf-8' has been added.
6826 It provides limited support for decoding/encoding UTF-8 text. For
6827 details, please see the documentation string of this coding system.
6828
6829 ** The new character sets `japanese-jisx0213-1' and
6830 `japanese-jisx0213-2' have been introduced for the new Japanese
6831 standard JIS X 0213 Plane 1 and Plane 2.
6832
6833 ** The new character sets `latin-iso8859-14' and `latin-iso8859-15'
6834 have been introduced.
6835
6836 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
6837 have been introduced for 8-bit characters in the ranges 0x80..0x9F and
6838 0xA0..0xFF respectively. Note that the multibyte representation of
6839 eight-bit-control is never exposed; this leads to an exception in the
6840 emacs-mule coding system, which encodes everything else to the
6841 buffer/string internal representation. Note that to search for
6842 eight-bit-graphic characters in a multibyte buffer, the search string
6843 must be multibyte, otherwise such characters will be converted to
6844 their multibyte equivalent.
6845
6846 ** If the APPEND argument of `write-region' is an integer, it seeks to
6847 that offset in the file before writing.
6848
6849 ** The function `add-minor-mode' has been added for convenience and
6850 compatibility with XEmacs (and is used internally by define-minor-mode).
6851
6852 ** The function `shell-command' now sets the default directory of the
6853 `*Shell Command Output*' buffer to the default directory of the buffer
6854 from which the command was issued.
6855
6856 ** The functions `query-replace', `query-replace-regexp',
6857 `query-replace-regexp-eval' `map-query-replace-regexp',
6858 `replace-string', `replace-regexp', and `perform-replace' take two
6859 additional optional arguments START and END that specify the region to
6860 operate on.
6861
6862 ** The new function `count-screen-lines' is a more flexible alternative
6863 to `window-buffer-height'.
6864
6865 - Function: count-screen-lines &optional BEG END COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE WINDOW
6866
6867 Return the number of screen lines in the region between BEG and END.
6868 The number of screen lines may be different from the number of actual
6869 lines, due to line breaking, display table, etc.
6870
6871 Optional arguments BEG and END default to `point-min' and `point-max'
6872 respectively.
6873
6874 If region ends with a newline, ignore it unless optional third argument
6875 COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE is non-nil.
6876
6877 The optional fourth argument WINDOW specifies the window used for
6878 obtaining parameters such as width, horizontal scrolling, and so
6879 on. The default is to use the selected window's parameters.
6880
6881 Like `vertical-motion', `count-screen-lines' always uses the current
6882 buffer, regardless of which buffer is displayed in WINDOW. This makes
6883 possible to use `count-screen-lines' in any buffer, whether or not it
6884 is currently displayed in some window.
6885
6886 ** The new function `mapc' is like `mapcar' but doesn't collect the
6887 argument function's results.
6888
6889 ** The functions base64-decode-region and base64-decode-string now
6890 signal an error instead of returning nil if decoding fails. Also,
6891 `base64-decode-string' now always returns a unibyte string (in Emacs
6892 20, it returned a multibyte string when the result was a valid multibyte
6893 sequence).
6894
6895 ** The function sendmail-user-agent-compose now recognizes a `body'
6896 header in the list of headers passed to it.
6897
6898 ** The new function member-ignore-case works like `member', but
6899 ignores differences in case and text representation.
6900
6901 ** The buffer-local variable cursor-type can be used to specify the
6902 cursor to use in windows displaying a buffer. Values are interpreted
6903 as follows:
6904
6905 t use the cursor specified for the frame (default)
6906 nil don't display a cursor
6907 `bar' display a bar cursor with default width
6908 (bar . WIDTH) display a bar cursor with width WIDTH
6909 others display a box cursor.
6910
6911 ** The variable open-paren-in-column-0-is-defun-start controls whether
6912 an open parenthesis in column 0 is considered to be the start of a
6913 defun. If set, the default, it is considered a defun start. If not
6914 set, an open parenthesis in column 0 has no special meaning.
6915
6916 ** The new function `string-to-syntax' can be used to translate syntax
6917 specifications in string form as accepted by `modify-syntax-entry' to
6918 the cons-cell form that is used for the values of the `syntax-table'
6919 text property, and in `font-lock-syntactic-keywords'.
6920
6921 Example:
6922
6923 (string-to-syntax "()")
6924 => (4 . 41)
6925
6926 ** Emacs' reader supports CL read syntax for integers in bases
6927 other than 10.
6928
6929 *** `#BINTEGER' or `#bINTEGER' reads INTEGER in binary (radix 2).
6930 INTEGER optionally contains a sign.
6931
6932 #b1111
6933 => 15
6934 #b-1111
6935 => -15
6936
6937 *** `#OINTEGER' or `#oINTEGER' reads INTEGER in octal (radix 8).
6938
6939 #o666
6940 => 438
6941
6942 *** `#XINTEGER' or `#xINTEGER' reads INTEGER in hexadecimal (radix 16).
6943
6944 #xbeef
6945 => 48815
6946
6947 *** `#RADIXrINTEGER' reads INTEGER in radix RADIX, 2 <= RADIX <= 36.
6948
6949 #2R-111
6950 => -7
6951 #25rah
6952 => 267
6953
6954 ** The function `documentation-property' now evaluates the value of
6955 the given property to obtain a string if it doesn't refer to etc/DOC
6956 and isn't a string.
6957
6958 ** If called for a symbol, the function `documentation' now looks for
6959 a `function-documentation' property of that symbol. If it has a non-nil
6960 value, the documentation is taken from that value. If the value is
6961 not a string, it is evaluated to obtain a string.
6962
6963 ** The last argument of `define-key-after' defaults to t for convenience.
6964
6965 ** The new function `replace-regexp-in-string' replaces all matches
6966 for a regexp in a string.
6967
6968 ** `mouse-position' now runs the abnormal hook
6969 `mouse-position-function'.
6970
6971 ** The function string-to-number now returns a float for numbers
6972 that don't fit into a Lisp integer.
6973
6974 ** The variable keyword-symbols-constants-flag has been removed.
6975 Keywords are now always considered constants.
6976
6977 ** The new function `delete-and-extract-region' deletes text and
6978 returns it.
6979
6980 ** The function `clear-this-command-keys' now also clears the vector
6981 returned by function `recent-keys'.
6982
6983 ** Variables `beginning-of-defun-function' and `end-of-defun-function'
6984 can be used to define handlers for the functions that find defuns.
6985 Major modes can define these locally instead of rebinding C-M-a
6986 etc. if the normal conventions for defuns are not appropriate for the
6987 mode.
6988
6989 ** easy-mmode-define-minor-mode now takes an additional BODY argument
6990 and is renamed `define-minor-mode'.
6991
6992 ** If an abbrev has a hook function which is a symbol, and that symbol
6993 has a non-nil `no-self-insert' property, the return value of the hook
6994 function specifies whether an expansion has been done or not. If it
6995 returns nil, abbrev-expand also returns nil, meaning "no expansion has
6996 been performed."
6997
6998 When abbrev expansion is done by typing a self-inserting character,
6999 and the abbrev has a hook with the `no-self-insert' property, and the
7000 hook function returns non-nil meaning expansion has been done,
7001 then the self-inserting character is not inserted.
7002
7003 ** The function `intern-soft' now accepts a symbol as first argument.
7004 In this case, that exact symbol is looked up in the specified obarray,
7005 and the function's value is nil if it is not found.
7006
7007 ** The new macro `with-syntax-table' can be used to evaluate forms
7008 with the syntax table of the current buffer temporarily set to a
7009 specified table.
7010
7011 (with-syntax-table TABLE &rest BODY)
7012
7013 Evaluate BODY with syntax table of current buffer set to a copy of
7014 TABLE. The current syntax table is saved, BODY is evaluated, and the
7015 saved table is restored, even in case of an abnormal exit. Value is
7016 what BODY returns.
7017
7018 ** Regular expressions now support intervals \{n,m\} as well as
7019 Perl's shy-groups \(?:...\) and non-greedy *? +? and ?? operators.
7020 Also back-references like \2 are now considered as an error if the
7021 corresponding subgroup does not exist (or is not closed yet).
7022 Previously it would have been silently turned into `2' (ignoring the `\').
7023
7024 ** The optional argument BUFFER of function file-local-copy has been
7025 removed since it wasn't used by anything.
7026
7027 ** The file name argument of function `file-locked-p' is now required
7028 instead of being optional.
7029
7030 ** The new built-in error `text-read-only' is signaled when trying to
7031 modify read-only text.
7032
7033 ** New functions and variables for locales.
7034
7035 The new variable `locale-coding-system' specifies how to encode and
7036 decode strings passed to low-level message functions like strerror and
7037 time functions like strftime. The new variables
7038 `system-messages-locale' and `system-time-locale' give the system
7039 locales to be used when invoking these two types of functions.
7040
7041 The new function `set-locale-environment' sets the language
7042 environment, preferred coding system, and locale coding system from
7043 the system locale as specified by the LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG
7044 environment variables. Normally, it is invoked during startup and need
7045 not be invoked thereafter. It uses the new variables
7046 `locale-language-names', `locale-charset-language-names', and
7047 `locale-preferred-coding-systems' to make its decisions.
7048
7049 ** syntax tables now understand nested comments.
7050 To declare a comment syntax as allowing nesting, just add an `n'
7051 modifier to either of the characters of the comment end and the comment
7052 start sequences.
7053
7054 ** The function `pixmap-spec-p' has been renamed `bitmap-spec-p'
7055 because `bitmap' is more in line with the usual X terminology.
7056
7057 ** New function `propertize'
7058
7059 The new function `propertize' can be used to conveniently construct
7060 strings with text properties.
7061
7062 - Function: propertize STRING &rest PROPERTIES
7063
7064 Value is a copy of STRING with text properties assigned as specified
7065 by PROPERTIES. PROPERTIES is a sequence of pairs PROPERTY VALUE, with
7066 PROPERTY being the name of a text property and VALUE being the
7067 specified value of that property. Example:
7068
7069 (propertize "foo" 'face 'bold 'read-only t)
7070
7071 ** push and pop macros.
7072
7073 Simple versions of the push and pop macros of Common Lisp
7074 are now defined in Emacs Lisp. These macros allow only symbols
7075 as the place that holds the list to be changed.
7076
7077 (push NEWELT LISTNAME) add NEWELT to the front of LISTNAME's value.
7078 (pop LISTNAME) return first elt of LISTNAME, and remove it
7079 (thus altering the value of LISTNAME).
7080
7081 ** New dolist and dotimes macros.
7082
7083 Simple versions of the dolist and dotimes macros of Common Lisp
7084 are now defined in Emacs Lisp.
7085
7086 (dolist (VAR LIST [RESULT]) BODY...)
7087 Execute body once for each element of LIST,
7088 using the variable VAR to hold the current element.
7089 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
7090
7091 (dotimes (VAR COUNT [RESULT]) BODY...)
7092 Execute BODY with VAR bound to successive integers running from 0,
7093 inclusive, to COUNT, exclusive.
7094 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
7095
7096 ** Regular expressions now support Posix character classes such as
7097 [:alpha:], [:space:] and so on. These must be used within a character
7098 class--for instance, [-[:digit:].+] matches digits or a period
7099 or a sign.
7100
7101 [:digit:] matches 0 through 9
7102 [:cntrl:] matches ASCII control characters
7103 [:xdigit:] matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
7104 [:blank:] matches space and tab only
7105 [:graph:] matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
7106 space, and DEL.
7107 [:print:] matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
7108 and DEL.
7109 [:alnum:] matches letters and digits.
7110 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7111 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7112 [:alpha:] matches letters.
7113 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7114 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7115 [:ascii:] matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
7116 [:nonascii:] matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
7117 [:lower:] matches anything lower-case.
7118 [:punct:] matches punctuation.
7119 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7120 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
7121 [:space:] matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
7122 [:upper:] matches anything upper-case.
7123 [:word:] matches anything that has word syntax.
7124
7125 ** Emacs now has built-in hash tables.
7126
7127 The following functions are defined for hash tables:
7128
7129 - Function: make-hash-table ARGS
7130
7131 The argument list ARGS consists of keyword/argument pairs. All arguments
7132 are optional. The following arguments are defined:
7133
7134 :test TEST
7135
7136 TEST must be a symbol specifying how to compare keys. Default is `eql'.
7137 Predefined are `eq', `eql' and `equal'. If TEST is not predefined,
7138 it must have been defined with `define-hash-table-test'.
7139
7140 :size SIZE
7141
7142 SIZE must be an integer > 0 giving a hint to the implementation how
7143 many elements will be put in the hash table. Default size is 65.
7144
7145 :rehash-size REHASH-SIZE
7146
7147 REHASH-SIZE specifies by how much to grow a hash table once it becomes
7148 full. If REHASH-SIZE is an integer, add that to the hash table's old
7149 size to get the new size. Otherwise, REHASH-SIZE must be a float >
7150 1.0, and the new size is computed by multiplying REHASH-SIZE with the
7151 old size. Default rehash size is 1.5.
7152
7153 :rehash-threshold THRESHOLD
7154
7155 THRESHOLD must be a float > 0 and <= 1.0 specifying when to resize the
7156 hash table. It is resized when the ratio of (number of entries) /
7157 (size of hash table) is >= THRESHOLD. Default threshold is 0.8.
7158
7159 :weakness WEAK
7160
7161 WEAK must be either nil, one of the symbols `key, `value',
7162 `key-or-value', `key-and-value', or t, meaning the same as
7163 `key-and-value'. Entries are removed from weak tables during garbage
7164 collection if their key and/or value are not referenced elsewhere
7165 outside of the hash table. Default are non-weak hash tables.
7166
7167 - Function: makehash &optional TEST
7168
7169 Similar to make-hash-table, but only TEST can be specified.
7170
7171 - Function: hash-table-p TABLE
7172
7173 Returns non-nil if TABLE is a hash table object.
7174
7175 - Function: copy-hash-table TABLE
7176
7177 Returns a copy of TABLE. Only the table itself is copied, keys and
7178 values are shared.
7179
7180 - Function: hash-table-count TABLE
7181
7182 Returns the number of entries in TABLE.
7183
7184 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
7185
7186 Returns the rehash size of TABLE.
7187
7188 - Function: hash-table-rehash-threshold TABLE
7189
7190 Returns the rehash threshold of TABLE.
7191
7192 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
7193
7194 Returns the size of TABLE.
7195
7196 - Function: hash-table-test TABLE
7197
7198 Returns the test TABLE uses to compare keys.
7199
7200 - Function: hash-table-weakness TABLE
7201
7202 Returns the weakness specified for TABLE.
7203
7204 - Function: clrhash TABLE
7205
7206 Clear TABLE.
7207
7208 - Function: gethash KEY TABLE &optional DEFAULT
7209
7210 Look up KEY in TABLE and return its associated VALUE or DEFAULT if
7211 not found.
7212
7213 - Function: puthash KEY VALUE TABLE
7214
7215 Associate KEY with VALUE in TABLE. If KEY is already associated with
7216 another value, replace the old value with VALUE.
7217
7218 - Function: remhash KEY TABLE
7219
7220 Remove KEY from TABLE if it is there.
7221
7222 - Function: maphash FUNCTION TABLE
7223
7224 Call FUNCTION for all elements in TABLE. FUNCTION must take two
7225 arguments KEY and VALUE.
7226
7227 - Function: sxhash OBJ
7228
7229 Return a hash code for Lisp object OBJ.
7230
7231 - Function: define-hash-table-test NAME TEST-FN HASH-FN
7232
7233 Define a new hash table test named NAME. If NAME is specified as
7234 a test in `make-hash-table', the table created will use TEST-FN for
7235 comparing keys, and HASH-FN to compute hash codes for keys. Test
7236 and hash function are stored as symbol property `hash-table-test'
7237 of NAME with a value of (TEST-FN HASH-FN).
7238
7239 TEST-FN must take two arguments and return non-nil if they are the same.
7240
7241 HASH-FN must take one argument and return an integer that is the hash
7242 code of the argument. The function should use the whole range of
7243 integer values for hash code computation, including negative integers.
7244
7245 Example: The following creates a hash table whose keys are supposed to
7246 be strings that are compared case-insensitively.
7247
7248 (defun case-fold-string= (a b)
7249 (compare-strings a nil nil b nil nil t))
7250
7251 (defun case-fold-string-hash (a)
7252 (sxhash (upcase a)))
7253
7254 (define-hash-table-test 'case-fold 'case-fold-string=
7255 'case-fold-string-hash))
7256
7257 (make-hash-table :test 'case-fold)
7258
7259 ** The Lisp reader handles circular structure.
7260
7261 It now works to use the #N= and #N# constructs to represent
7262 circular structures. For example, #1=(a . #1#) represents
7263 a cons cell which is its own cdr.
7264
7265 ** The Lisp printer handles circular structure.
7266
7267 If you bind print-circle to a non-nil value, the Lisp printer outputs
7268 #N= and #N# constructs to represent circular and shared structure.
7269
7270 ** If the second argument to `move-to-column' is anything but nil or
7271 t, that means replace a tab with spaces if necessary to reach the
7272 specified column, but do not add spaces at the end of the line if it
7273 is too short to reach that column.
7274
7275 ** perform-replace has a new feature: the REPLACEMENTS argument may
7276 now be a cons cell (FUNCTION . DATA). This means to call FUNCTION
7277 after each match to get the replacement text. FUNCTION is called with
7278 two arguments: DATA, and the number of replacements already made.
7279
7280 If the FROM-STRING contains any upper-case letters,
7281 perform-replace also turns off `case-fold-search' temporarily
7282 and inserts the replacement text without altering case in it.
7283
7284 ** The function buffer-size now accepts an optional argument
7285 to specify which buffer to return the size of.
7286
7287 ** The calendar motion commands now run the normal hook
7288 calendar-move-hook after moving point.
7289
7290 ** The new variable small-temporary-file-directory specifies a
7291 directory to use for creating temporary files that are likely to be
7292 small. (Certain Emacs features use this directory.) If
7293 small-temporary-file-directory is nil, they use
7294 temporary-file-directory instead.
7295
7296 ** The variable `inhibit-modification-hooks', if non-nil, inhibits all
7297 the hooks that track changes in the buffer. This affects
7298 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions', as well as
7299 hooks attached to text properties and overlay properties.
7300
7301 ** assq-delete-all is a new function that deletes all the
7302 elements of an alist which have a car `eq' to a particular value.
7303
7304 ** make-temp-file provides a more reliable way to create a temporary file.
7305
7306 make-temp-file is used like make-temp-name, except that it actually
7307 creates the file before it returns. This prevents a timing error,
7308 ensuring that no other job can use the same name for a temporary file.
7309
7310 ** New exclusive-open feature in `write-region'
7311
7312 The optional seventh arg is now called MUSTBENEW. If non-nil, it insists
7313 on a check for an existing file with the same name. If MUSTBENEW
7314 is `excl', that means to get an error if the file already exists;
7315 never overwrite. If MUSTBENEW is neither nil nor `excl', that means
7316 ask for confirmation before overwriting, but do go ahead and
7317 overwrite the file if the user gives confirmation.
7318
7319 If the MUSTBENEW argument in `write-region' is `excl',
7320 that means to use a special feature in the `open' system call
7321 to get an error if the file exists at that time.
7322 The error reported is `file-already-exists'.
7323
7324 ** Function `format' now handles text properties.
7325
7326 Text properties of the format string are applied to the result string.
7327 If the result string is longer than the format string, text properties
7328 ending at the end of the format string are extended to the end of the
7329 result string.
7330
7331 Text properties from string arguments are applied to the result
7332 string where arguments appear in the result string.
7333
7334 Example:
7335
7336 (let ((s1 "hello, %s")
7337 (s2 "world"))
7338 (put-text-property 0 (length s1) 'face 'bold s1)
7339 (put-text-property 0 (length s2) 'face 'italic s2)
7340 (format s1 s2))
7341
7342 results in a bold-face string with an italic `world' at the end.
7343
7344 ** Messages can now be displayed with text properties.
7345
7346 Text properties are handled as described above for function `format'.
7347 The following example displays a bold-face message with an italic
7348 argument in it.
7349
7350 (let ((msg "hello, %s!")
7351 (arg "world"))
7352 (put-text-property 0 (length msg) 'face 'bold msg)
7353 (put-text-property 0 (length arg) 'face 'italic arg)
7354 (message msg arg))
7355
7356 ** Sound support
7357
7358 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and the free BSDs
7359 (Voxware driver and native BSD driver, aka as Luigi's driver).
7360
7361 Currently supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio
7362 (*.au). You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes'
7363 to enable sound support.
7364
7365 Sound files can be played by calling (play-sound SOUND). SOUND is a
7366 list of the form `(sound PROPERTY...)'. The function is only defined
7367 when sound support is present for the system on which Emacs runs. The
7368 functions runs `play-sound-functions' with one argument which is the
7369 sound to play, before playing the sound.
7370
7371 The following sound properties are supported:
7372
7373 - `:file FILE'
7374
7375 FILE is a file name. If FILE isn't an absolute name, it will be
7376 searched relative to `data-directory'.
7377
7378 - `:data DATA'
7379
7380 DATA is a string containing sound data. Either :file or :data
7381 may be present, but not both.
7382
7383 - `:volume VOLUME'
7384
7385 VOLUME must be an integer in the range 0..100 or a float in the range
7386 0..1. This property is optional.
7387
7388 - `:device DEVICE'
7389
7390 DEVICE is a string specifying the system device on which to play the
7391 sound. The default device is system-dependent.
7392
7393 Other properties are ignored.
7394
7395 An alternative interface is called as
7396 (play-sound-file FILE &optional VOLUME DEVICE).
7397
7398 ** `multimedia' is a new Finder keyword and Custom group.
7399
7400 ** keywordp is a new predicate to test efficiently for an object being
7401 a keyword symbol.
7402
7403 ** Changes to garbage collection
7404
7405 *** The function garbage-collect now additionally returns the number
7406 of live and free strings.
7407
7408 *** There is a new variable `strings-consed' holding the number of
7409 strings that have been consed so far.
7410
7411 \f
7412 * Lisp-level Display features added after release 2.6 of the Emacs
7413 Lisp Manual
7414
7415 ** The user-option `resize-mini-windows' controls how Emacs resizes
7416 mini-windows.
7417
7418 ** The function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now has a third optional
7419 argument, PARTIALLY. If a character is only partially visible, nil is
7420 returned, unless PARTIALLY is non-nil.
7421
7422 ** On window systems, `glyph-table' is no longer used.
7423
7424 ** Help strings in menu items are now used to provide `help-echo' text.
7425
7426 ** The function `image-size' can be used to determine the size of an
7427 image.
7428
7429 - Function: image-size SPEC &optional PIXELS FRAME
7430
7431 Return the size of an image as a pair (WIDTH . HEIGHT).
7432
7433 SPEC is an image specification. PIXELS non-nil means return sizes
7434 measured in pixels, otherwise return sizes measured in canonical
7435 character units (fractions of the width/height of the frame's default
7436 font). FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed.
7437 FRAME nil or omitted means use the selected frame.
7438
7439 ** The function `image-mask-p' can be used to determine if an image
7440 has a mask bitmap.
7441
7442 - Function: image-mask-p SPEC &optional FRAME
7443
7444 Return t if image SPEC has a mask bitmap.
7445 FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed. FRAME nil
7446 or omitted means use the selected frame.
7447
7448 ** The function `find-image' can be used to find a usable image
7449 satisfying one of a list of specifications.
7450
7451 ** The STRING argument of `put-image' and `insert-image' is now
7452 optional.
7453
7454 ** Image specifications may contain the property `:ascent center' (see
7455 below).
7456
7457 \f
7458 * New Lisp-level Display features in Emacs 21.1
7459
7460 ** The function tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors can be used
7461 to make Emacs avoid displaying text with bold black foreground on TTYs.
7462
7463 Some terminals, notably PC consoles, emulate bold text by displaying
7464 text in brighter colors. On such a console, a bold black foreground
7465 is displayed in a gray color. If this turns out to be hard to read on
7466 your monitor---the problem occurred with the mode line on
7467 laptops---you can instruct Emacs to ignore the text's boldness, and to
7468 just display it black instead.
7469
7470 This situation can't be detected automatically. You will have to put
7471 a line like
7472
7473 (tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors t)
7474
7475 in your `.emacs'.
7476
7477 ** New face implementation.
7478
7479 Emacs faces have been reimplemented from scratch. They don't use XLFD
7480 font names anymore and face merging now works as expected.
7481
7482 *** New faces.
7483
7484 Each face can specify the following display attributes:
7485
7486 1. Font family or fontset alias name.
7487
7488 2. Relative proportionate width, aka character set width or set
7489 width (swidth), e.g. `semi-compressed'.
7490
7491 3. Font height in 1/10pt
7492
7493 4. Font weight, e.g. `bold'.
7494
7495 5. Font slant, e.g. `italic'.
7496
7497 6. Foreground color.
7498
7499 7. Background color.
7500
7501 8. Whether or not characters should be underlined, and in what color.
7502
7503 9. Whether or not characters should be displayed in inverse video.
7504
7505 10. A background stipple, a bitmap.
7506
7507 11. Whether or not characters should be overlined, and in what color.
7508
7509 12. Whether or not characters should be strike-through, and in what
7510 color.
7511
7512 13. Whether or not a box should be drawn around characters, its
7513 color, the width of the box lines, and 3D appearance.
7514
7515 Faces are frame-local by nature because Emacs allows to define the
7516 same named face (face names are symbols) differently for different
7517 frames. Each frame has an alist of face definitions for all named
7518 faces. The value of a named face in such an alist is a Lisp vector
7519 with the symbol `face' in slot 0, and a slot for each of the face
7520 attributes mentioned above.
7521
7522 There is also a global face alist `face-new-frame-defaults'. Face
7523 definitions from this list are used to initialize faces of newly
7524 created frames.
7525
7526 A face doesn't have to specify all attributes. Those not specified
7527 have a nil value. Faces specifying all attributes are called
7528 `fully-specified'.
7529
7530 *** Face merging.
7531
7532 The display style of a given character in the text is determined by
7533 combining several faces. This process is called `face merging'. Any
7534 aspect of the display style that isn't specified by overlays or text
7535 properties is taken from the `default' face. Since it is made sure
7536 that the default face is always fully-specified, face merging always
7537 results in a fully-specified face.
7538
7539 *** Face realization.
7540
7541 After all face attributes for a character have been determined by
7542 merging faces of that character, that face is `realized'. The
7543 realization process maps face attributes to what is physically
7544 available on the system where Emacs runs. The result is a `realized
7545 face' in form of an internal structure which is stored in the face
7546 cache of the frame on which it was realized.
7547
7548 Face realization is done in the context of the charset of the
7549 character to display because different fonts and encodings are used
7550 for different charsets. In other words, for characters of different
7551 charsets, different realized faces are needed to display them.
7552
7553 Except for composite characters, faces are always realized for a
7554 specific character set and contain a specific font, even if the face
7555 being realized specifies a fontset. The reason is that the result of
7556 the new font selection stage is better than what can be done with
7557 statically defined font name patterns in fontsets.
7558
7559 In unibyte text, Emacs' charsets aren't applicable; function
7560 `char-charset' reports ASCII for all characters, including those >
7561 0x7f. The X registry and encoding of fonts to use is determined from
7562 the variable `face-default-registry' in this case. The variable is
7563 initialized at Emacs startup time from the font the user specified for
7564 Emacs.
7565
7566 Currently all unibyte text, i.e. all buffers with
7567 `enable-multibyte-characters' nil are displayed with fonts of the same
7568 registry and encoding `face-default-registry'. This is consistent
7569 with the fact that languages can also be set globally, only.
7570
7571 **** Clearing face caches.
7572
7573 The Lisp function `clear-face-cache' can be called to clear face caches
7574 on all frames. If called with a non-nil argument, it will also unload
7575 unused fonts.
7576
7577 *** Font selection.
7578
7579 Font selection tries to find the best available matching font for a
7580 given (charset, face) combination. This is done slightly differently
7581 for faces specifying a fontset, or a font family name.
7582
7583 If the face specifies a fontset name, that fontset determines a
7584 pattern for fonts of the given charset. If the face specifies a font
7585 family, a font pattern is constructed. Charset symbols have a
7586 property `x-charset-registry' for that purpose that maps a charset to
7587 an XLFD registry and encoding in the font pattern constructed.
7588
7589 Available fonts on the system on which Emacs runs are then matched
7590 against the font pattern. The result of font selection is the best
7591 match for the given face attributes in this font list.
7592
7593 Font selection can be influenced by the user.
7594
7595 The user can specify the relative importance he gives the face
7596 attributes width, height, weight, and slant by setting
7597 face-font-selection-order (faces.el) to a list of face attribute
7598 names. The default is (:width :height :weight :slant), and means
7599 that font selection first tries to find a good match for the font
7600 width specified by a face, then---within fonts with that width---tries
7601 to find a best match for the specified font height, etc.
7602
7603 Setting `face-font-family-alternatives' allows the user to specify
7604 alternative font families to try if a family specified by a face
7605 doesn't exist.
7606
7607 Setting `face-font-registry-alternatives' allows the user to specify
7608 all alternative font registry names to try for a face specifying a
7609 registry.
7610
7611 Please note that the interpretations of the above two variables are
7612 slightly different.
7613
7614 Setting face-ignored-fonts allows the user to ignore specific fonts.
7615
7616
7617 **** Scalable fonts
7618
7619 Emacs can make use of scalable fonts but doesn't do so by default,
7620 since the use of too many or too big scalable fonts may crash XFree86
7621 servers.
7622
7623 To enable scalable font use, set the variable
7624 `scalable-fonts-allowed'. A value of nil, the default, means never use
7625 scalable fonts. A value of t means any scalable font may be used.
7626 Otherwise, the value must be a list of regular expressions. A
7627 scalable font may then be used if it matches a regular expression from
7628 that list. Example:
7629
7630 (setq scalable-fonts-allowed '("muleindian-2$"))
7631
7632 allows the use of scalable fonts with registry `muleindian-2'.
7633
7634 *** Functions and variables related to font selection.
7635
7636 - Function: x-family-fonts &optional FAMILY FRAME
7637
7638 Return a list of available fonts of family FAMILY on FRAME. If FAMILY
7639 is omitted or nil, list all families. Otherwise, FAMILY must be a
7640 string, possibly containing wildcards `?' and `*'.
7641
7642 If FRAME is omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Each element of
7643 the result is a vector [FAMILY WIDTH POINT-SIZE WEIGHT SLANT FIXED-P
7644 FULL REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING]. FAMILY is the font family name.
7645 POINT-SIZE is the size of the font in 1/10 pt. WIDTH, WEIGHT, and
7646 SLANT are symbols describing the width, weight and slant of the font.
7647 These symbols are the same as for face attributes. FIXED-P is non-nil
7648 if the font is fixed-pitch. FULL is the full name of the font, and
7649 REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING is a string giving the registry and encoding of
7650 the font. The result list is sorted according to the current setting
7651 of the face font sort order.
7652
7653 - Function: x-font-family-list
7654
7655 Return a list of available font families on FRAME. If FRAME is
7656 omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Value is a list of conses
7657 (FAMILY . FIXED-P) where FAMILY is a font family, and FIXED-P is
7658 non-nil if fonts of that family are fixed-pitch.
7659
7660 - Variable: font-list-limit
7661
7662 Limit for font matching. If an integer > 0, font matching functions
7663 won't load more than that number of fonts when searching for a
7664 matching font. The default is currently 100.
7665
7666 *** Setting face attributes.
7667
7668 For the most part, the new face implementation is interface-compatible
7669 with the old one. Old face attribute related functions are now
7670 implemented in terms of the new functions `set-face-attribute' and
7671 `face-attribute'.
7672
7673 Face attributes are identified by their names which are keyword
7674 symbols. All attributes can be set to `unspecified'.
7675
7676 The following attributes are recognized:
7677
7678 `:family'
7679
7680 VALUE must be a string specifying the font family, e.g. ``courier'',
7681 or a fontset alias name. If a font family is specified, wild-cards `*'
7682 and `?' are allowed.
7683
7684 `:width'
7685
7686 VALUE specifies the relative proportionate width of the font to use.
7687 It must be one of the symbols `ultra-condensed', `extra-condensed',
7688 `condensed', `semi-condensed', `normal', `semi-expanded', `expanded',
7689 `extra-expanded', or `ultra-expanded'.
7690
7691 `:height'
7692
7693 VALUE must be either an integer specifying the height of the font to use
7694 in 1/10 pt, a floating point number specifying the amount by which to
7695 scale any underlying face, or a function, which is called with the old
7696 height (from the underlying face), and should return the new height.
7697
7698 `:weight'
7699
7700 VALUE specifies the weight of the font to use. It must be one of the
7701 symbols `ultra-bold', `extra-bold', `bold', `semi-bold', `normal',
7702 `semi-light', `light', `extra-light', `ultra-light'.
7703
7704 `:slant'
7705
7706 VALUE specifies the slant of the font to use. It must be one of the
7707 symbols `italic', `oblique', `normal', `reverse-italic', or
7708 `reverse-oblique'.
7709
7710 `:foreground', `:background'
7711
7712 VALUE must be a color name, a string.
7713
7714 `:underline'
7715
7716 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be underlined. If
7717 VALUE is t, underline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is
7718 a string, underline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly
7719 don't underline.
7720
7721 `:overline'
7722
7723 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be overlined. If
7724 VALUE is t, overline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is a
7725 string, overline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't
7726 overline.
7727
7728 `:strike-through'
7729
7730 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be drawn with a line
7731 striking through them. If VALUE is t, use the foreground color of the
7732 face. If VALUE is a string, strike-through with that color. If VALUE
7733 is nil, explicitly don't strike through.
7734
7735 `:box'
7736
7737 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should have a box drawn
7738 around them. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't draw boxes. If
7739 VALUE is t, draw a box with lines of width 1 in the foreground color
7740 of the face. If VALUE is a string, the string must be a color name,
7741 and the box is drawn in that color with a line width of 1. Otherwise,
7742 VALUE must be a property list of the form `(:line-width WIDTH
7743 :color COLOR :style STYLE)'. If a keyword/value pair is missing from
7744 the property list, a default value will be used for the value, as
7745 specified below. WIDTH specifies the width of the lines to draw; it
7746 defaults to 1. COLOR is the name of the color to draw in, default is
7747 the foreground color of the face for simple boxes, and the background
7748 color of the face for 3D boxes. STYLE specifies whether a 3D box
7749 should be draw. If STYLE is `released-button', draw a box looking
7750 like a released 3D button. If STYLE is `pressed-button' draw a box
7751 that appears like a pressed button. If STYLE is nil, the default if
7752 the property list doesn't contain a style specification, draw a 2D
7753 box.
7754
7755 `:inverse-video'
7756
7757 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be displayed in
7758 inverse video. VALUE must be one of t or nil.
7759
7760 `:stipple'
7761
7762 If VALUE is a string, it must be the name of a file of pixmap data.
7763 The directories listed in the `x-bitmap-file-path' variable are
7764 searched. Alternatively, VALUE may be a list of the form (WIDTH
7765 HEIGHT DATA) where WIDTH and HEIGHT are the size in pixels, and DATA
7766 is a string containing the raw bits of the bitmap. VALUE nil means
7767 explicitly don't use a stipple pattern.
7768
7769 For convenience, attributes `:family', `:width', `:height', `:weight',
7770 and `:slant' may also be set in one step from an X font name:
7771
7772 `:font'
7773
7774 Set font-related face attributes from VALUE. VALUE must be a valid
7775 XLFD font name. If it is a font name pattern, the first matching font
7776 is used--this is for compatibility with the behavior of previous
7777 versions of Emacs.
7778
7779 For compatibility with Emacs 20, keywords `:bold' and `:italic' can
7780 be used to specify that a bold or italic font should be used. VALUE
7781 must be t or nil in that case. A value of `unspecified' is not allowed."
7782
7783 Please see also the documentation of `set-face-attribute' and
7784 `defface'.
7785
7786 `:inherit'
7787
7788 VALUE is the name of a face from which to inherit attributes, or a list
7789 of face names. Attributes from inherited faces are merged into the face
7790 like an underlying face would be, with higher priority than underlying faces.
7791
7792 *** Face attributes and X resources
7793
7794 The following X resource names can be used to set face attributes
7795 from X resources:
7796
7797 Face attribute X resource class
7798 -----------------------------------------------------------------------
7799 :family attributeFamily . Face.AttributeFamily
7800 :width attributeWidth Face.AttributeWidth
7801 :height attributeHeight Face.AttributeHeight
7802 :weight attributeWeight Face.AttributeWeight
7803 :slant attributeSlant Face.AttributeSlant
7804 foreground attributeForeground Face.AttributeForeground
7805 :background attributeBackground . Face.AttributeBackground
7806 :overline attributeOverline Face.AttributeOverline
7807 :strike-through attributeStrikeThrough Face.AttributeStrikeThrough
7808 :box attributeBox Face.AttributeBox
7809 :underline attributeUnderline Face.AttributeUnderline
7810 :inverse-video attributeInverse Face.AttributeInverse
7811 :stipple attributeStipple Face.AttributeStipple
7812 or attributeBackgroundPixmap
7813 Face.AttributeBackgroundPixmap
7814 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
7815 :bold attributeBold Face.AttributeBold
7816 :italic attributeItalic . Face.AttributeItalic
7817 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
7818
7819 *** Text property `face'.
7820
7821 The value of the `face' text property can now be a single face
7822 specification or a list of such specifications. Each face
7823 specification can be
7824
7825 1. A symbol or string naming a Lisp face.
7826
7827 2. A property list of the form (KEYWORD VALUE ...) where each
7828 KEYWORD is a face attribute name, and VALUE is an appropriate value
7829 for that attribute. Please see the doc string of `set-face-attribute'
7830 for face attribute names.
7831
7832 3. Conses of the form (FOREGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) or
7833 (BACKGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) where COLOR is a color name. This is
7834 for compatibility with previous Emacs versions.
7835
7836 ** Support functions for colors on text-only terminals.
7837
7838 The function `tty-color-define' can be used to define colors for use
7839 on TTY and MSDOS frames. It maps a color name to a color number on
7840 the terminal. Emacs defines a couple of common color mappings by
7841 default. You can get defined colors with a call to
7842 `defined-colors'. The function `tty-color-clear' can be
7843 used to clear the mapping table.
7844
7845 ** Unified support for colors independent of frame type.
7846
7847 The new functions `defined-colors', `color-defined-p', `color-values',
7848 and `display-color-p' work for any type of frame. On frames whose
7849 type is neither x nor w32, these functions transparently map X-style
7850 color specifications to the closest colors supported by the frame
7851 display. Lisp programs should use these new functions instead of the
7852 old `x-defined-colors', `x-color-defined-p', `x-color-values', and
7853 `x-display-color-p'. (The old function names are still available for
7854 compatibility; they are now aliases of the new names.) Lisp programs
7855 should no more look at the value of the variable window-system to
7856 modify their color-related behavior.
7857
7858 The primitives `color-gray-p' and `color-supported-p' also work for
7859 any frame type.
7860
7861 ** Platform-independent functions to describe display capabilities.
7862
7863 The new functions `display-mouse-p', `display-popup-menus-p',
7864 `display-graphic-p', `display-selections-p', `display-screens',
7865 `display-pixel-width', `display-pixel-height', `display-mm-width',
7866 `display-mm-height', `display-backing-store', `display-save-under',
7867 `display-planes', `display-color-cells', `display-visual-class', and
7868 `display-grayscale-p' describe the basic capabilities of a particular
7869 display. Lisp programs should call these functions instead of testing
7870 the value of the variables `window-system' or `system-type', or calling
7871 platform-specific functions such as `x-display-pixel-width'.
7872
7873 The new function `display-images-p' returns non-nil if a particular
7874 display can display image files.
7875
7876 ** The minibuffer prompt is now actually inserted in the minibuffer.
7877
7878 This makes it possible to scroll through the prompt, if you want to.
7879 To disallow this completely (like previous versions of emacs), customize
7880 the variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', and turn on the
7881 `Inviolable' option.
7882
7883 The function `minibuffer-prompt-end' returns the current position of the
7884 end of the minibuffer prompt, if the minibuffer is current.
7885 Otherwise, it returns `(point-min)'.
7886
7887 ** New `field' abstraction in buffers.
7888
7889 There is now code to support an abstraction called `fields' in emacs
7890 buffers. A field is a contiguous region of text with the same `field'
7891 property (which can be a text property or an overlay).
7892
7893 Many emacs functions, such as forward-word, forward-sentence,
7894 forward-paragraph, beginning-of-line, etc., stop moving when they come
7895 to the boundary between fields; beginning-of-line and end-of-line will
7896 not let the point move past the field boundary, but other movement
7897 commands continue into the next field if repeated. Stopping at field
7898 boundaries can be suppressed programmatically by binding
7899 `inhibit-field-text-motion' to a non-nil value around calls to these
7900 functions.
7901
7902 Now that the minibuffer prompt is inserted into the minibuffer, it is in
7903 a separate field from the user-input part of the buffer, so that common
7904 editing commands treat the user's text separately from the prompt.
7905
7906 The following functions are defined for operating on fields:
7907
7908 - Function: constrain-to-field NEW-POS OLD-POS &optional ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE ONLY-IN-LINE INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY
7909
7910 Return the position closest to NEW-POS that is in the same field as OLD-POS.
7911
7912 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
7913 If NEW-POS is nil, then the current point is used instead, and set to the
7914 constrained position if that is different.
7915
7916 If OLD-POS is at the boundary of two fields, then the allowable
7917 positions for NEW-POS depends on the value of the optional argument
7918 ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE: If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is nil, then NEW-POS is
7919 constrained to the field that has the same `field' char-property
7920 as any new characters inserted at OLD-POS, whereas if ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
7921 is non-nil, NEW-POS is constrained to the union of the two adjacent
7922 fields. Additionally, if two fields are separated by another field with
7923 the special value `boundary', then any point within this special field is
7924 also considered to be `on the boundary'.
7925
7926 If the optional argument ONLY-IN-LINE is non-nil and constraining
7927 NEW-POS would move it to a different line, NEW-POS is returned
7928 unconstrained. This useful for commands that move by line, like
7929 C-n or C-a, which should generally respect field boundaries
7930 only in the case where they can still move to the right line.
7931
7932 If the optional argument INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY is non-nil, and OLD-POS has
7933 a non-nil property of that name, then any field boundaries are ignored.
7934
7935 Field boundaries are not noticed if `inhibit-field-text-motion' is non-nil.
7936
7937 - Function: delete-field &optional POS
7938
7939 Delete the field surrounding POS.
7940 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
7941 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
7942
7943 - Function: field-beginning &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
7944
7945 Return the beginning of the field surrounding POS.
7946 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
7947 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
7948 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the beginning of its
7949 field, then the beginning of the *previous* field is returned.
7950
7951 - Function: field-end &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
7952
7953 Return the end of the field surrounding POS.
7954 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
7955 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
7956 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the end of its field,
7957 then the end of the *following* field is returned.
7958
7959 - Function: field-string &optional POS
7960
7961 Return the contents of the field surrounding POS as a string.
7962 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
7963 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
7964
7965 - Function: field-string-no-properties &optional POS
7966
7967 Return the contents of the field around POS, without text-properties.
7968 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
7969 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
7970
7971 ** Image support.
7972
7973 Emacs can now display images. Images are inserted into text by giving
7974 strings or buffer text a `display' text property containing one of
7975 (AREA IMAGE) or IMAGE. The display of the `display' property value
7976 replaces the display of the characters having that property.
7977
7978 If the property value has the form (AREA IMAGE), AREA must be one of
7979 `(margin left-margin)', `(margin right-margin)' or `(margin nil)'. If
7980 AREA is `(margin nil)', IMAGE will be displayed in the text area of a
7981 window, otherwise it will be displayed in the left or right marginal
7982 area.
7983
7984 IMAGE is an image specification.
7985
7986 *** Image specifications
7987
7988 Image specifications are lists of the form `(image PROPS)' where PROPS
7989 is a property list whose keys are keyword symbols. Each
7990 specifications must contain a property `:type TYPE' with TYPE being a
7991 symbol specifying the image type, e.g. `xbm'. Properties not
7992 described below are ignored.
7993
7994 The following is a list of properties all image types share.
7995
7996 `:ascent ASCENT'
7997
7998 ASCENT must be a number in the range 0..100, or the symbol `center'.
7999 If it is a number, it specifies the percentage of the image's height
8000 to use for its ascent.
8001
8002 If not specified, ASCENT defaults to the value 50 which means that the
8003 image will be centered with the base line of the row it appears in.
8004
8005 If ASCENT is `center' the image is vertically centered around a
8006 centerline which is the vertical center of text drawn at the position
8007 of the image, in the manner specified by the text properties and
8008 overlays that apply to the image.
8009
8010 `:margin MARGIN'
8011
8012 MARGIN must be either a number >= 0 specifying how many pixels to put
8013 as margin around the image, or a pair (X . Y) with X specifying the
8014 horizontal margin and Y specifying the vertical margin. Default is 0.
8015
8016 `:relief RELIEF'
8017
8018 RELIEF is analogous to the `:relief' attribute of faces. Puts a relief
8019 around an image.
8020
8021 `:conversion ALGO'
8022
8023 Apply an image algorithm to the image before displaying it.
8024
8025 ALGO `laplace' or `emboss' means apply a Laplace or ``emboss''
8026 edge-detection algorithm to the image.
8027
8028 ALGO `(edge-detection :matrix MATRIX :color-adjust ADJUST)' means
8029 apply a general edge-detection algorithm. MATRIX must be either a
8030 nine-element list or a nine-element vector of numbers. A pixel at
8031 position x/y in the transformed image is computed from original pixels
8032 around that position. MATRIX specifies, for each pixel in the
8033 neighborhood of x/y, a factor with which that pixel will influence the
8034 transformed pixel; element 0 specifies the factor for the pixel at
8035 x-1/y-1, element 1 the factor for the pixel at x/y-1 etc. as shown
8036 below.
8037
8038 (x-1/y-1 x/y-1 x+1/y-1
8039 x-1/y x/y x+1/y
8040 x-1/y+1 x/y+1 x+1/y+1)
8041
8042 The resulting pixel is computed from the color intensity of the color
8043 resulting from summing up the RGB values of surrounding pixels,
8044 multiplied by the specified factors, and dividing that sum by the sum
8045 of the factors' absolute values.
8046
8047 Laplace edge-detection currently uses a matrix of
8048
8049 (1 0 0
8050 0 0 0
8051 9 9 -1)
8052
8053 Emboss edge-detection uses a matrix of
8054
8055 ( 2 -1 0
8056 -1 0 1
8057 0 1 -2)
8058
8059 ALGO `disabled' means transform the image so that it looks
8060 ``disabled''.
8061
8062 `:mask MASK'
8063
8064 If MASK is `heuristic' or `(heuristic BG)', build a clipping mask for
8065 the image, so that the background of a frame is visible behind the
8066 image. If BG is not specified, or if BG is t, determine the
8067 background color of the image by looking at the 4 corners of the
8068 image, assuming the most frequently occurring color from the corners is
8069 the background color of the image. Otherwise, BG must be a list `(RED
8070 GREEN BLUE)' specifying the color to assume for the background of the
8071 image.
8072
8073 If MASK is nil, remove a mask from the image, if it has one. Images
8074 in some formats include a mask which can be removed by specifying
8075 `:mask nil'.
8076
8077 `:file FILE'
8078
8079 Load image from FILE. If FILE is not absolute after expanding it,
8080 search for the image in `data-directory'. Some image types support
8081 building images from data. When this is done, no `:file' property
8082 may be present in the image specification.
8083
8084 `:data DATA'
8085
8086 Get image data from DATA. (As of this writing, this is not yet
8087 supported for image type `postscript'). Either :file or :data may be
8088 present in an image specification, but not both. All image types
8089 support strings as DATA, some types allow additional types of DATA.
8090
8091 *** Supported image types
8092
8093 **** XBM, image type `xbm'.
8094
8095 XBM images don't require an external library. Additional image
8096 properties supported are:
8097
8098 `:foreground FG'
8099
8100 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
8101 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
8102
8103 `:background BG'
8104
8105 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
8106 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
8107
8108 XBM images can be constructed from data instead of file. In this
8109 case, the image specification must contain the following properties
8110 instead of a `:file' property.
8111
8112 `:width WIDTH'
8113
8114 WIDTH specifies the width of the image in pixels.
8115
8116 `:height HEIGHT'
8117
8118 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pixels.
8119
8120 `:data DATA'
8121
8122 DATA must be either
8123
8124 1. a string large enough to hold the bitmap data, i.e. it must
8125 have a size >= (WIDTH + 7) / 8 * HEIGHT
8126
8127 2. a bool-vector of size >= WIDTH * HEIGHT
8128
8129 3. a vector of strings or bool-vectors, one for each line of the
8130 bitmap.
8131
8132 4. a string that's an in-memory XBM file. Neither width nor
8133 height may be specified in this case because these are defined
8134 in the file.
8135
8136 **** XPM, image type `xpm'
8137
8138 XPM images require the external library `libXpm', package
8139 `xpm-3.4k.tar.gz', version 3.4k or later. Make sure the library is
8140 found when Emacs is configured by supplying appropriate paths via
8141 `--x-includes' and `--x-libraries'.
8142
8143 Additional image properties supported are:
8144
8145 `:color-symbols SYMBOLS'
8146
8147 SYMBOLS must be a list of pairs (NAME . COLOR), with NAME being the
8148 name of color as it appears in an XPM file, and COLOR being an X color
8149 name.
8150
8151 XPM images can be built from memory instead of files. In that case,
8152 add a `:data' property instead of a `:file' property.
8153
8154 The XPM library uses libz in its implementation so that it is able
8155 to display compressed images.
8156
8157 **** PBM, image type `pbm'
8158
8159 PBM images don't require an external library. Color, gray-scale and
8160 mono images are supported. Additional image properties supported for
8161 mono images are:
8162
8163 `:foreground FG'
8164
8165 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
8166 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
8167
8168 `:background FG'
8169
8170 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
8171 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
8172
8173 **** JPEG, image type `jpeg'
8174
8175 Support for JPEG images requires the external library `libjpeg',
8176 package `jpegsrc.v6a.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
8177 properties defined.
8178
8179 **** TIFF, image type `tiff'
8180
8181 Support for TIFF images requires the external library `libtiff',
8182 package `tiff-v3.4-tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
8183 properties defined.
8184
8185 **** GIF, image type `gif'
8186
8187 Support for GIF images requires the external library `libungif', package
8188 `libungif-4.1.0', or later.
8189
8190 Additional image properties supported are:
8191
8192 `:index INDEX'
8193
8194 INDEX must be an integer >= 0. Load image number INDEX from a
8195 multi-image GIF file. If INDEX is too large, the image displays
8196 as a hollow box.
8197
8198 This could be used to implement limited support for animated GIFs.
8199 For example, the following function displays a multi-image GIF file
8200 at point-min in the current buffer, switching between sub-images
8201 every 0.1 seconds.
8202
8203 (defun show-anim (file max)
8204 "Display multi-image GIF file FILE which contains MAX subimages."
8205 (display-anim (current-buffer) file 0 max t))
8206
8207 (defun display-anim (buffer file idx max first-time)
8208 (when (= idx max)
8209 (setq idx 0))
8210 (let ((img (create-image file nil nil :index idx)))
8211 (save-excursion
8212 (set-buffer buffer)
8213 (goto-char (point-min))
8214 (unless first-time (delete-char 1))
8215 (insert-image img "x"))
8216 (run-with-timer 0.1 nil 'display-anim buffer file (1+ idx) max nil)))
8217
8218 **** PNG, image type `png'
8219
8220 Support for PNG images requires the external library `libpng',
8221 package `libpng-1.0.2.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
8222 properties defined.
8223
8224 **** Ghostscript, image type `postscript'.
8225
8226 Additional image properties supported are:
8227
8228 `:pt-width WIDTH'
8229
8230 WIDTH is width of the image in pt (1/72 inch). WIDTH must be an
8231 integer. This is a required property.
8232
8233 `:pt-height HEIGHT'
8234
8235 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pt (1/72 inch). HEIGHT
8236 must be a integer. This is an required property.
8237
8238 `:bounding-box BOX'
8239
8240 BOX must be a list or vector of 4 integers giving the bounding box of
8241 the PS image, analogous to the `BoundingBox' comment found in PS
8242 files. This is an required property.
8243
8244 Part of the Ghostscript interface is implemented in Lisp. See
8245 lisp/gs.el.
8246
8247 *** Lisp interface.
8248
8249 The variable `image-types' contains a list of those image types
8250 which are supported in the current configuration.
8251
8252 Images are stored in an image cache and removed from the cache when
8253 they haven't been displayed for `image-cache-eviction-delay seconds.
8254 The function `clear-image-cache' can be used to clear the image cache
8255 manually. Images in the cache are compared with `equal', i.e. all
8256 images with `equal' specifications share the same image.
8257
8258 *** Simplified image API, image.el
8259
8260 The new Lisp package image.el contains functions that simplify image
8261 creation and putting images into text. The function `create-image'
8262 can be used to create images. The macro `defimage' can be used to
8263 define an image based on available image types. The functions
8264 `put-image' and `insert-image' can be used to insert an image into a
8265 buffer.
8266
8267 ** Display margins.
8268
8269 Windows can now have margins which are used for special text
8270 and images.
8271
8272 To give a window margins, either set the buffer-local variables
8273 `left-margin-width' and `right-margin-width', or call
8274 `set-window-margins'. The function `window-margins' can be used to
8275 obtain the current settings. To make `left-margin-width' and
8276 `right-margin-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
8277 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
8278 of the display margins.
8279
8280 You can put text in margins by giving it a `display' text property
8281 containing a pair of the form `(LOCATION . VALUE)', where LOCATION is
8282 one of `left-margin' or `right-margin' or nil. VALUE can be either a
8283 string, an image specification or a stretch specification (see later
8284 in this file).
8285
8286 ** Help display
8287
8288 Emacs displays short help messages in the echo area, when the mouse
8289 moves over a tool-bar item or a piece of text that has a text property
8290 `help-echo'. This feature also applies to strings in the mode line
8291 that have a `help-echo' property.
8292
8293 If the value of the `help-echo' property is a function, that function
8294 is called with three arguments WINDOW, OBJECT and POSITION. WINDOW is
8295 the window in which the help was found.
8296
8297 If OBJECT is a buffer, POS is the position in the buffer where the
8298 `help-echo' text property was found.
8299
8300 If OBJECT is an overlay, that overlay has a `help-echo' property, and
8301 POS is the position in the overlay's buffer under the mouse.
8302
8303 If OBJECT is a string (an overlay string or a string displayed with
8304 the `display' property), POS is the position in that string under the
8305 mouse.
8306
8307 If the value of the `help-echo' property is neither a function nor a
8308 string, it is evaluated to obtain a help string.
8309
8310 For tool-bar and menu-bar items, their key definition is used to
8311 determine the help to display. If their definition contains a
8312 property `:help FORM', FORM is evaluated to determine the help string.
8313 For tool-bar items without a help form, the caption of the item is
8314 used as help string.
8315
8316 The hook `show-help-function' can be set to a function that displays
8317 the help string differently. For example, enabling a tooltip window
8318 causes the help display to appear there instead of in the echo area.
8319
8320 ** Vertical fractional scrolling.
8321
8322 The display of text in windows can be scrolled smoothly in pixels.
8323 This is useful, for example, for making parts of large images visible.
8324
8325 The function `window-vscroll' returns the current value of vertical
8326 scrolling, a non-negative fraction of the canonical character height.
8327 The function `set-window-vscroll' can be used to set the vertical
8328 scrolling value. Here is an example of how these function might be
8329 used.
8330
8331 (global-set-key [A-down]
8332 #'(lambda ()
8333 (interactive)
8334 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
8335 (+ 0.5 (window-vscroll)))))
8336 (global-set-key [A-up]
8337 #'(lambda ()
8338 (interactive)
8339 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
8340 (- (window-vscroll) 0.5)))))
8341
8342 ** New hook `fontification-functions'.
8343
8344 Functions from `fontification-functions' are called from redisplay
8345 when it encounters a region of text that is not yet fontified. This
8346 variable automatically becomes buffer-local when set. Each function
8347 is called with one argument, POS.
8348
8349 At least one of the hook functions should fontify one or more
8350 characters starting at POS in the current buffer. It should mark them
8351 as fontified by giving them a non-nil value of the `fontified' text
8352 property. It may be reasonable for these functions to check for the
8353 `fontified' property and not put it back on, but they do not have to.
8354
8355 ** Tool bar support.
8356
8357 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. The frame
8358 parameter `tool-bar-lines' (X resource "toolBar", class "ToolBar")
8359 controls how may lines to reserve for the tool bar. A zero value
8360 suppresses the tool bar. If the value is non-zero and
8361 `auto-resize-tool-bars' is non-nil the tool bar's size will be changed
8362 automatically so that all tool bar items are visible.
8363
8364 *** Tool bar item definitions
8365
8366 Tool bar items are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
8367 `tool-bar'. For example `(define-key global-map [tool-bar item1] ITEM)'
8368 where ITEM is a list `(menu-item CAPTION BINDING PROPS...)'.
8369
8370 CAPTION is the caption of the item, If it's not a string, it is
8371 evaluated to get a string. The caption is currently not displayed in
8372 the tool bar, but it is displayed if the item doesn't have a `:help'
8373 property (see below).
8374
8375 BINDING is the tool bar item's binding. Tool bar items with keymaps as
8376 binding are currently ignored.
8377
8378 The following properties are recognized:
8379
8380 `:enable FORM'.
8381
8382 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is enabled
8383 or disabled.
8384
8385 `:visible FORM'
8386
8387 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is displayed.
8388
8389 `:filter FUNCTION'
8390
8391 FUNCTION is called with one parameter, the same list BINDING in which
8392 FUNCTION is specified as the filter. The value FUNCTION returns is
8393 used instead of BINDING to display this item.
8394
8395 `:button (TYPE SELECTED)'
8396
8397 TYPE must be one of `:radio' or `:toggle'. SELECTED is evaluated
8398 and specifies whether the button is selected (pressed) or not.
8399
8400 `:image IMAGES'
8401
8402 IMAGES is either a single image specification or a vector of four
8403 image specifications. If it is a vector, this table lists the
8404 meaning of each of the four elements:
8405
8406 Index Use when item is
8407 ----------------------------------------
8408 0 enabled and selected
8409 1 enabled and deselected
8410 2 disabled and selected
8411 3 disabled and deselected
8412
8413 If IMAGE is a single image specification, a Laplace edge-detection
8414 algorithm is used on that image to draw the image in disabled state.
8415
8416 `:help HELP-STRING'.
8417
8418 Gives a help string to display for the tool bar item. This help
8419 is displayed when the mouse is moved over the item.
8420
8421 The function `toolbar-add-item' is a convenience function for adding
8422 toolbar items generally, and `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' can be used
8423 to define a toolbar item with a binding copied from an item on the
8424 menu bar.
8425
8426 The default bindings use a menu-item :filter to derive the tool-bar
8427 dynamically from variable `tool-bar-map' which may be set
8428 buffer-locally to override the global map.
8429
8430 *** Tool-bar-related variables.
8431
8432 If `auto-resize-tool-bar' is non-nil, the tool bar will automatically
8433 resize to show all defined tool bar items. It will never grow larger
8434 than 1/4 of the frame's size.
8435
8436 If `auto-raise-tool-bar-buttons' is non-nil, tool bar buttons will be
8437 raised when the mouse moves over them.
8438
8439 You can add extra space between tool bar items by setting
8440 `tool-bar-button-margin' to a positive integer specifying a number of
8441 pixels, or a pair of integers (X . Y) specifying horizontal and
8442 vertical margins . Default is 1.
8443
8444 You can change the shadow thickness of tool bar buttons by setting
8445 `tool-bar-button-relief' to an integer. Default is 3.
8446
8447 *** Tool-bar clicks with modifiers.
8448
8449 You can bind commands to clicks with control, shift, meta etc. on
8450 a tool bar item. If
8451
8452 (define-key global-map [tool-bar shell]
8453 '(menu-item "Shell" shell
8454 :image (image :type xpm :file "shell.xpm")))
8455
8456 is the original tool bar item definition, then
8457
8458 (define-key global-map [tool-bar S-shell] 'some-command)
8459
8460 makes a binding to run `some-command' for a shifted click on the same
8461 item.
8462
8463 ** Mode line changes.
8464
8465 *** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
8466
8467 The mode line can be made mouse-sensitive by displaying strings there
8468 that have a `local-map' text property. There are three ways to display
8469 a string with a `local-map' property in the mode line.
8470
8471 1. The mode line spec contains a variable whose string value has
8472 a `local-map' text property.
8473
8474 2. The mode line spec contains a format specifier (e.g. `%12b'), and
8475 that format specifier has a `local-map' property.
8476
8477 3. The mode line spec contains a list containing `:eval FORM'. FORM
8478 is evaluated. If the result is a string, and that string has a
8479 `local-map' property.
8480
8481 The same mechanism is used to determine the `face' and `help-echo'
8482 properties of strings in the mode line. See `bindings.el' for an
8483 example.
8484
8485 *** If a mode line element has the form `(:eval FORM)', FORM is
8486 evaluated and the result is used as mode line element.
8487
8488 *** You can suppress mode-line display by setting the buffer-local
8489 variable mode-line-format to nil.
8490
8491 *** A headerline can now be displayed at the top of a window.
8492
8493 This mode line's contents are controlled by the new variable
8494 `header-line-format' and `default-header-line-format' which are
8495 completely analogous to `mode-line-format' and
8496 `default-mode-line-format'. A value of nil means don't display a top
8497 line.
8498
8499 The appearance of top mode lines is controlled by the face
8500 `header-line'.
8501
8502 The function `coordinates-in-window-p' returns `header-line' for a
8503 position in the header-line.
8504
8505 ** Text property `display'
8506
8507 The `display' text property is used to insert images into text,
8508 replace text with other text, display text in marginal area, and it is
8509 also used to control other aspects of how text displays. The value of
8510 the `display' property should be a display specification, as described
8511 below, or a list or vector containing display specifications.
8512
8513 *** Replacing text, displaying text in marginal areas
8514
8515 To replace the text having the `display' property with some other
8516 text, use a display specification of the form `(LOCATION STRING)'.
8517
8518 If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)', STRING is displayed in the left
8519 marginal area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in
8520 the right marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' STRING
8521 is displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
8522 simpler form STRING as property value.
8523
8524 *** Variable width and height spaces
8525
8526 To display a space of fractional width or height, use a display
8527 specification of the form `(LOCATION STRECH)'. If LOCATION is
8528 `(margin left-margin)', the space is displayed in the left marginal
8529 area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in the right
8530 marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the space is
8531 displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
8532 simpler form STRETCH as property value.
8533
8534 The stretch specification STRETCH itself is a list of the form `(space
8535 PROPS)', where PROPS is a property list which can contain the
8536 properties described below.
8537
8538 The display of the fractional space replaces the display of the
8539 characters having the `display' property.
8540
8541 - :width WIDTH
8542
8543 Specifies that the space width should be WIDTH times the normal
8544 character width. WIDTH can be an integer or floating point number.
8545
8546 - :relative-width FACTOR
8547
8548 Specifies that the width of the stretch should be computed from the
8549 first character in a group of consecutive characters that have the
8550 same `display' property. The computation is done by multiplying the
8551 width of that character by FACTOR.
8552
8553 - :align-to HPOS
8554
8555 Specifies that the space should be wide enough to reach HPOS. The
8556 value HPOS is measured in units of the normal character width.
8557
8558 Exactly one of the above properties should be used.
8559
8560 - :height HEIGHT
8561
8562 Specifies the height of the space, as HEIGHT, measured in terms of the
8563 normal line height.
8564
8565 - :relative-height FACTOR
8566
8567 The height of the space is computed as the product of the height
8568 of the text having the `display' property and FACTOR.
8569
8570 - :ascent ASCENT
8571
8572 Specifies that ASCENT percent of the height of the stretch should be
8573 used for the ascent of the stretch, i.e. for the part above the
8574 baseline. The value of ASCENT must be a non-negative number less or
8575 equal to 100.
8576
8577 You should not use both `:height' and `:relative-height' together.
8578
8579 *** Images
8580
8581 A display specification for an image has the form `(LOCATION
8582 . IMAGE)', where IMAGE is an image specification. The image replaces,
8583 in the display, the characters having this display specification in
8584 their `display' text property. If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)',
8585 the image will be displayed in the left marginal area, if it is
8586 `(margin right-margin)' it will be displayed in the right marginal
8587 area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the image will be displayed in
8588 the text. In the latter case you can also use the simpler form IMAGE
8589 as display specification.
8590
8591 *** Other display properties
8592
8593 - (space-width FACTOR)
8594
8595 Specifies that space characters in the text having that property
8596 should be displayed FACTOR times as wide as normal; FACTOR must be an
8597 integer or float.
8598
8599 - (height HEIGHT)
8600
8601 Display text having this property in a font that is smaller or larger.
8602
8603 If HEIGHT is a list of the form `(+ N)', where N is an integer, that
8604 means to use a font that is N steps larger. If HEIGHT is a list of
8605 the form `(- N)', that means to use a font that is N steps smaller. A
8606 ``step'' is defined by the set of available fonts; each size for which
8607 a font is available counts as a step.
8608
8609 If HEIGHT is a number, that means to use a font that is HEIGHT times
8610 as tall as the frame's default font.
8611
8612 If HEIGHT is a symbol, it is called as a function with the current
8613 height as argument. The function should return the new height to use.
8614
8615 Otherwise, HEIGHT is evaluated to get the new height, with the symbol
8616 `height' bound to the current specified font height.
8617
8618 - (raise FACTOR)
8619
8620 FACTOR must be a number, specifying a multiple of the current
8621 font's height. If it is positive, that means to display the characters
8622 raised. If it is negative, that means to display them lower down. The
8623 amount of raising or lowering is computed without taking account of the
8624 `height' subproperty.
8625
8626 *** Conditional display properties
8627
8628 All display specifications can be conditionalized. If a specification
8629 has the form `(when CONDITION . SPEC)', the specification SPEC applies
8630 only when CONDITION yields a non-nil value when evaluated. During the
8631 evaluation, `object' is bound to the string or buffer having the
8632 conditional display property; `position' and `buffer-position' are
8633 bound to the position within `object' and the buffer position where
8634 the display property was found, respectively. Both positions can be
8635 different when object is a string.
8636
8637 The normal specification consisting of SPEC only is equivalent to
8638 `(when t . SPEC)'.
8639
8640 ** New menu separator types.
8641
8642 Emacs now supports more than one menu separator type. Menu items with
8643 item names consisting of dashes only (including zero dashes) are
8644 treated like before. In addition, the following item names are used
8645 to specify other menu separator types.
8646
8647 - `--no-line' or `--space', or `--:space', or `--:noLine'
8648
8649 No separator lines are drawn, but a small space is inserted where the
8650 separator occurs.
8651
8652 - `--single-line' or `--:singleLine'
8653
8654 A single line in the menu's foreground color.
8655
8656 - `--double-line' or `--:doubleLine'
8657
8658 A double line in the menu's foreground color.
8659
8660 - `--single-dashed-line' or `--:singleDashedLine'
8661
8662 A single dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
8663
8664 - `--double-dashed-line' or `--:doubleDashedLine'
8665
8666 A double dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
8667
8668 - `--shadow-etched-in' or `--:shadowEtchedIn'
8669
8670 A single line with 3D sunken appearance. This is the form
8671 displayed for item names consisting of dashes only.
8672
8673 - `--shadow-etched-out' or `--:shadowEtchedOut'
8674
8675 A single line with 3D raised appearance.
8676
8677 - `--shadow-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedInDash'
8678
8679 A single dashed line with 3D sunken appearance.
8680
8681 - `--shadow-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedOutDash'
8682
8683 A single dashed line with 3D raise appearance.
8684
8685 - `--shadow-double-etched-in' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedIn'
8686
8687 Two lines with 3D sunken appearance.
8688
8689 - `--shadow-double-etched-out' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOut'
8690
8691 Two lines with 3D raised appearance.
8692
8693 - `--shadow-double-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedInDash'
8694
8695 Two dashed lines with 3D sunken appearance.
8696
8697 - `--shadow-double-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOutDash'
8698
8699 Two dashed lines with 3D raised appearance.
8700
8701 Under LessTif/Motif, the last four separator types are displayed like
8702 the corresponding single-line separators.
8703
8704 ** New frame parameters for scroll bar colors.
8705
8706 The new frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
8707 `scroll-bar-background' can be used to change scroll bar colors.
8708 Their value must be either a color name, a string, or nil to specify
8709 that scroll bars should use a default color. For toolkit scroll bars,
8710 default colors are toolkit specific. For non-toolkit scroll bars, the
8711 default background is the background color of the frame, and the
8712 default foreground is black.
8713
8714 The X resource name of these parameters are `scrollBarForeground'
8715 (class ScrollBarForeground) and `scrollBarBackground' (class
8716 `ScrollBarBackground').
8717
8718 Setting these parameters overrides toolkit specific X resource
8719 settings for scroll bar colors.
8720
8721 ** You can set `redisplay-dont-pause' to a non-nil value to prevent
8722 display updates from being interrupted when input is pending.
8723
8724 ** Changing a window's width may now change its window start if it
8725 starts on a continuation line. The new window start is computed based
8726 on the window's new width, starting from the start of the continued
8727 line as the start of the screen line with the minimum distance from
8728 the original window start.
8729
8730 ** The variable `hscroll-step' and the functions
8731 `hscroll-point-visible' and `hscroll-window-column' have been removed
8732 now that proper horizontal scrolling is implemented.
8733
8734 ** Windows can now be made fixed-width and/or fixed-height.
8735
8736 A window is fixed-size if its buffer has a buffer-local variable
8737 `window-size-fixed' whose value is not nil. A value of `height' makes
8738 windows fixed-height, a value of `width' makes them fixed-width, any
8739 other non-nil value makes them both fixed-width and fixed-height.
8740
8741 The following code makes all windows displaying the current buffer
8742 fixed-width and fixed-height.
8743
8744 (set (make-local-variable 'window-size-fixed) t)
8745
8746 A call to enlarge-window on a window gives an error if that window is
8747 fixed-width and it is tried to change the window's width, or if the
8748 window is fixed-height, and it is tried to change its height. To
8749 change the size of a fixed-size window, bind `window-size-fixed'
8750 temporarily to nil, for example
8751
8752 (let ((window-size-fixed nil))
8753 (enlarge-window 10))
8754
8755 Likewise, an attempt to split a fixed-height window vertically,
8756 or a fixed-width window horizontally results in a error.
8757
8758 ** The cursor-type frame parameter is now supported on MS-DOS
8759 terminals. When Emacs starts, it by default changes the cursor shape
8760 to a solid box, as it does on Unix. The `cursor-type' frame parameter
8761 overrides this as it does on Unix, except that the bar cursor is
8762 horizontal rather than vertical (since the MS-DOS display doesn't
8763 support a vertical-bar cursor).
8764
8765
8766 \f
8767 * Emacs 20.7 is a bug-fix release with few user-visible changes
8768
8769 ** It is now possible to use CCL-based coding systems for keyboard
8770 input.
8771
8772 ** ange-ftp now handles FTP security extensions, like Kerberos.
8773
8774 ** Rmail has been extended to recognize more forms of digest messages.
8775
8776 ** Now, most coding systems set in keyboard coding system work not
8777 only for character input, but also in incremental search. The
8778 exceptions are such coding systems that handle 2-byte character sets
8779 (e.g euc-kr, euc-jp) and that use ISO's escape sequence
8780 (e.g. iso-2022-jp). They are ignored in incremental search.
8781
8782 ** Support for Macintosh PowerPC-based machines running GNU/Linux has
8783 been added.
8784
8785 \f
8786 * Emacs 20.6 is a bug-fix release with one user-visible change
8787
8788 ** Support for ARM-based non-RISCiX machines has been added.
8789
8790
8791 \f
8792 * Emacs 20.5 is a bug-fix release with no user-visible changes.
8793
8794 ** Not new, but not mentioned before:
8795 M-w when Transient Mark mode is enabled disables the mark.
8796 \f
8797 * Changes in Emacs 20.4
8798
8799 ** Init file may be called .emacs.el.
8800
8801 You can now call the Emacs init file `.emacs.el'.
8802 Formerly the name had to be `.emacs'. If you use the name
8803 `.emacs.el', you can byte-compile the file in the usual way.
8804
8805 If both `.emacs' and `.emacs.el' exist, the latter file
8806 is the one that is used.
8807
8808 ** shell-command, and shell-command-on-region, now return
8809 the exit code of the command (unless it is asynchronous).
8810 Also, you can specify a place to put the error output,
8811 separate from the command's regular output.
8812 Interactively, the variable shell-command-default-error-buffer
8813 says where to put error output; set it to a buffer name.
8814 In calls from Lisp, an optional argument ERROR-BUFFER specifies
8815 the buffer name.
8816
8817 When you specify a non-nil error buffer (or buffer name), any error
8818 output is inserted before point in that buffer, with \f\n to separate
8819 it from the previous batch of error output. The error buffer is not
8820 cleared, so error output from successive commands accumulates there.
8821
8822 ** Setting the default value of enable-multibyte-characters to nil in
8823 the .emacs file, either explicitly using setq-default, or via Custom,
8824 is now essentially equivalent to using --unibyte: all buffers
8825 created during startup will be made unibyte after loading .emacs.
8826
8827 ** C-x C-f now handles the wildcards * and ? in file names. For
8828 example, typing C-x C-f c*.c RET visits all the files whose names
8829 match c*.c. To visit a file whose name contains * or ?, add the
8830 quoting sequence /: to the beginning of the file name.
8831
8832 ** The M-x commands keep-lines, flush-lines and count-matches
8833 now have the same feature as occur and query-replace:
8834 if the pattern contains any upper case letters, then
8835 they never ignore case.
8836
8837 ** The end-of-line format conversion feature previously mentioned
8838 under `* Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows' actually
8839 applies to all operating systems. Emacs recognizes from the contents
8840 of a file what convention it uses to separate lines--newline, CRLF, or
8841 just CR--and automatically converts the contents to the normal Emacs
8842 convention (using newline to separate lines) for editing. This is a
8843 part of the general feature of coding system conversion.
8844
8845 If you subsequently save the buffer, Emacs converts the text back to
8846 the same format that was used in the file before.
8847
8848 You can turn off end-of-line conversion by setting the variable
8849 `inhibit-eol-conversion' to non-nil, e.g. with Custom in the MULE group.
8850
8851 ** The character set property `prefered-coding-system' has been
8852 renamed to `preferred-coding-system', for the sake of correct spelling.
8853 This is a fairly internal feature, so few programs should be affected.
8854
8855 ** Mode-line display of end-of-line format is changed.
8856 The indication of the end-of-line format of the file visited by a
8857 buffer is now more explicit when that format is not the usual one for
8858 your operating system. For example, the DOS-style end-of-line format
8859 is displayed as "(DOS)" on Unix and GNU/Linux systems. The usual
8860 end-of-line format is still displayed as a single character (colon for
8861 Unix, backslash for DOS and Windows, and forward slash for the Mac).
8862
8863 The values of the variables eol-mnemonic-unix, eol-mnemonic-dos,
8864 eol-mnemonic-mac, and eol-mnemonic-undecided, which are strings,
8865 control what is displayed in the mode line for each end-of-line
8866 format. You can now customize these variables.
8867
8868 ** In the previous version of Emacs, tar-mode didn't work well if a
8869 filename contained non-ASCII characters. Now this is fixed. Such a
8870 filename is decoded by file-name-coding-system if the default value of
8871 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil.
8872
8873 ** The command temp-buffer-resize-mode toggles a minor mode
8874 in which temporary buffers (such as help buffers) are given
8875 windows just big enough to hold the whole contents.
8876
8877 ** If you use completion.el, you must now run the function
8878 dynamic-completion-mode to enable it. Just loading the file
8879 doesn't have any effect.
8880
8881 ** In Flyspell mode, the default is now to make just one Ispell process,
8882 not one per buffer.
8883
8884 ** If you use iswitchb but do not call (iswitchb-default-keybindings) to
8885 use the default keybindings, you will need to add the following line:
8886 (add-hook 'minibuffer-setup-hook 'iswitchb-minibuffer-setup)
8887
8888 ** Auto-show mode is no longer enabled just by loading auto-show.el.
8889 To control it, set `auto-show-mode' via Custom or use the
8890 `auto-show-mode' command.
8891
8892 ** Handling of X fonts' ascent/descent parameters has been changed to
8893 avoid redisplay problems. As a consequence, compared with previous
8894 versions the line spacing and frame size now differ with some font
8895 choices, typically increasing by a pixel per line. This change
8896 occurred in version 20.3 but was not documented then.
8897
8898 ** If you select the bar cursor style, it uses the frame's
8899 cursor-color, rather than the cursor foreground pixel.
8900
8901 ** In multibyte mode, Rmail decodes incoming MIME messages using the
8902 character set specified in the message. If you want to disable this
8903 feature, set the variable rmail-decode-mime-charset to nil.
8904
8905 ** Not new, but not mentioned previously in NEWS: when you use #! at
8906 the beginning of a file to make it executable and specify an
8907 interpreter program, Emacs looks on the second line for the -*- mode
8908 and variable specification, as well as on the first line.
8909
8910 ** Support for IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters.
8911
8912 The new command M-x codepage-setup creates a special coding system
8913 that can be used to convert text between a specific IBM codepage and
8914 one of the character sets built into Emacs which matches that
8915 codepage. For example, codepage 850 corresponds to Latin-1 character
8916 set, codepage 855 corresponds to Cyrillic-ISO character set, etc.
8917
8918 Windows codepages 1250, 1251 and some others, where Windows deviates
8919 from the corresponding ISO character set, are also supported.
8920
8921 IBM box-drawing characters and other glyphs which don't have
8922 equivalents in the corresponding ISO character set, are converted to
8923 a character defined by dos-unsupported-char-glyph on MS-DOS, and to
8924 `?' on other systems.
8925
8926 IBM codepages are widely used on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, so this
8927 feature is most useful on those platforms, but it can also be used on
8928 Unix.
8929
8930 Emacs compiled for MS-DOS automatically loads the support for the
8931 current codepage when it starts.
8932
8933 ** Mail changes
8934
8935 *** When mail is sent using compose-mail (C-x m), and if
8936 `mail-send-nonascii' is set to the new default value `mime',
8937 appropriate MIME headers are added. The headers are added only if
8938 non-ASCII characters are present in the body of the mail, and no other
8939 MIME headers are already present. For example, the following three
8940 headers are added if the coding system used in the *mail* buffer is
8941 latin-1:
8942
8943 MIME-version: 1.0
8944 Content-type: text/plain; charset=iso-8859-1
8945 Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit
8946
8947 *** The new variable default-sendmail-coding-system specifies the
8948 default way to encode outgoing mail. This has higher priority than
8949 default-buffer-file-coding-system but has lower priority than
8950 sendmail-coding-system and the local value of
8951 buffer-file-coding-system.
8952
8953 You should not set this variable manually. Instead, set
8954 sendmail-coding-system to specify a fixed encoding for all outgoing
8955 mail.
8956
8957 *** When you try to send a message that contains non-ASCII characters,
8958 if the coding system specified by those variables doesn't handle them,
8959 Emacs will ask you to select a suitable coding system while showing a
8960 list of possible coding systems.
8961
8962 ** CC Mode changes
8963
8964 *** c-default-style can now take an association list that maps major
8965 modes to style names. When this variable is an alist, Java mode no
8966 longer hardcodes a setting to "java" style. See the variable's
8967 docstring for details.
8968
8969 *** It's now possible to put a list as the offset on a syntactic
8970 symbol. The list is evaluated recursively until a non-nil offset is
8971 found. This is useful to combine several lineup functions to act in a
8972 prioritized order on a single line. However, none of the supplied
8973 lineup functions use this feature currently.
8974
8975 *** New syntactic symbol catch-clause, which is used on the "catch" and
8976 "finally" lines in try-catch constructs in C++ and Java.
8977
8978 *** New cleanup brace-catch-brace on c-cleanup-list, which does for
8979 "catch" lines what brace-elseif-brace does for "else if" lines.
8980
8981 *** The braces of Java anonymous inner classes are treated separately
8982 from the braces of other classes in auto-newline mode. Two new
8983 symbols inexpr-class-open and inexpr-class-close may be used on
8984 c-hanging-braces-alist to control the automatic newlines used for
8985 anonymous classes.
8986
8987 *** Support for the Pike language added, along with new Pike specific
8988 syntactic symbols: inlambda, lambda-intro-cont
8989
8990 *** Support for Java anonymous classes via new syntactic symbol
8991 inexpr-class. New syntactic symbol inexpr-statement for Pike
8992 support and gcc-style statements inside expressions. New lineup
8993 function c-lineup-inexpr-block.
8994
8995 *** New syntactic symbol brace-entry-open which is used in brace lists
8996 (i.e. static initializers) when a list entry starts with an open
8997 brace. These used to be recognized as brace-list-entry's.
8998 c-electric-brace also recognizes brace-entry-open braces
8999 (brace-list-entry's can no longer be electrified).
9000
9001 *** New command c-indent-line-or-region, not bound by default.
9002
9003 *** `#' is only electric when typed in the indentation of a line.
9004
9005 *** Parentheses are now electric (via the new command c-electric-paren)
9006 for auto-reindenting lines when parens are typed.
9007
9008 *** In "gnu" style, inline-open offset is now set to zero.
9009
9010 *** Uniform handling of the inclass syntactic symbol. The indentation
9011 associated with it is now always relative to the class opening brace.
9012 This means that the indentation behavior has changed in some
9013 circumstances, but only if you've put anything besides 0 on the
9014 class-open syntactic symbol (none of the default styles do that).
9015
9016 ** Gnus changes.
9017
9018 *** New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
9019 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added. See the
9020 Gnus manual for the full story.
9021
9022 *** The nndraft backend has returned, but works differently than
9023 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the nndraft
9024 group, which is created automatically.
9025
9026 *** `gnus-alter-header-function' can now be used to alter header
9027 values.
9028
9029 *** `gnus-summary-goto-article' now accept Message-ID's.
9030
9031 *** A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
9032 outside the region: `C-c C-v'.
9033
9034 *** You can now post to component group in nnvirtual groups with
9035 `C-u C-c C-c'.
9036
9037 *** `nntp-rlogin-program' -- new variable to ease customization.
9038
9039 *** `C-u C-c C-c' in `gnus-article-edit-mode' will now inhibit
9040 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
9041
9042 *** New element in `gnus-boring-article-headers' -- `long-to'.
9043
9044 *** `M-i' symbolic prefix command. See the section "Symbolic
9045 Prefixes" in the Gnus manual for details.
9046
9047 *** `L' and `I' in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
9048 `a' to add the score rule to the "all.SCORE" file.
9049
9050 *** `gnus-simplify-subject-functions' variable to allow greater
9051 control over simplification.
9052
9053 *** `A T' -- new command for fetching the current thread.
9054
9055 *** `/ T' -- new command for including the current thread in the
9056 limit.
9057
9058 *** `M-RET' is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
9059
9060 *** \\1-expressions are now valid in `nnmail-split-methods'.
9061
9062 *** The `custom-face-lookup' function has been removed.
9063 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
9064 rewrite them to use `face-spec-set' instead.
9065
9066 *** Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
9067 `a' forces normal posting method.
9068
9069 *** New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper text
9070 -- `W d'.
9071
9072 *** For easier debugging of nntp, you can set `nntp-record-commands'
9073 to a non-nil value.
9074
9075 *** nntp now uses ~/.authinfo, a .netrc-like file, for controlling
9076 where and how to send AUTHINFO to NNTP servers.
9077
9078 *** A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
9079 has been added.
9080
9081 *** A history of where mails have been split is available.
9082
9083 *** A new article date command has been added -- `article-date-iso8601'.
9084
9085 *** Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
9086 `gnus-score-thread-simplify'.
9087
9088 *** A new function for citing in Message has been added --
9089 `message-cite-original-without-signature'.
9090
9091 *** `article-strip-all-blank-lines' -- new article command.
9092
9093 *** A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
9094 been added.
9095
9096 *** A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
9097 `gnus-adaptive-word-minimum' variable.
9098
9099 *** The "lapsed date" article header can be kept continually
9100 updated by the `gnus-start-date-timer' command.
9101
9102 *** Web listserv archives can be read with the nnlistserv backend.
9103
9104 *** Old dejanews archives can now be read by nnweb.
9105
9106 *** `gnus-posting-styles' has been re-activated.
9107
9108 ** Changes to TeX and LaTeX mode
9109
9110 *** The new variable `tex-start-options-string' can be used to give
9111 options for the TeX run. The default value causes TeX to run in
9112 nonstopmode. For an interactive TeX run set it to nil or "".
9113
9114 *** The command `tex-feed-input' sends input to the Tex Shell. In a
9115 TeX buffer it is bound to the keys C-RET, C-c RET, and C-c C-m (some
9116 of these keys may not work on all systems). For instance, if you run
9117 TeX interactively and if the TeX run stops because of an error, you
9118 can continue it without leaving the TeX buffer by typing C-RET.
9119
9120 *** The Tex Shell Buffer is now in `compilation-shell-minor-mode'.
9121 All error-parsing commands of the Compilation major mode are available
9122 but bound to keys that don't collide with the shell. Thus you can use
9123 the Tex Shell for command line executions like a usual shell.
9124
9125 *** The commands `tex-validate-region' and `tex-validate-buffer' check
9126 the matching of braces and $'s. The errors are listed in a *Occur*
9127 buffer and you can use C-c C-c or mouse-2 to go to a particular
9128 mismatch.
9129
9130 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
9131
9132 *** The table of contents buffer can now also display labels and
9133 file boundaries in addition to sections. Use `l', `i', and `c' keys.
9134
9135 *** Labels derived from context (the section heading) are now
9136 lowercase by default. To make the label legal in LaTeX, latin-1
9137 characters will lose their accent. All Mule characters will be
9138 removed from the label.
9139
9140 *** The automatic display of cross reference information can also use
9141 a window instead of the echo area. See variable `reftex-auto-view-crossref'.
9142
9143 *** kpsewhich can be used by RefTeX to find TeX and BibTeX files. See the
9144 customization group `reftex-finding-files'.
9145
9146 *** The option `reftex-bibfile-ignore-list' has been renamed to
9147 `reftex-bibfile-ignore-regexps' and indeed can be fed with regular
9148 expressions.
9149
9150 *** Multiple Selection buffers are now hidden buffers.
9151
9152 ** New/deleted modes and packages
9153
9154 *** The package snmp-mode.el provides major modes for editing SNMP and
9155 SNMPv2 MIBs. It has entries on `auto-mode-alist'.
9156
9157 *** The package sql.el provides a major mode, M-x sql-mode, for
9158 editing SQL files, and M-x sql-interactive-mode for interacting with
9159 SQL interpreters. It has an entry on `auto-mode-alist'.
9160
9161 *** M-x highlight-changes-mode provides a minor mode displaying buffer
9162 changes with a special face.
9163
9164 *** ispell4.el has been deleted. It got in the way of ispell.el and
9165 this was hard to fix reliably. It has long been obsolete -- use
9166 Ispell 3.1 and ispell.el.
9167 \f
9168 * MS-DOS changes in Emacs 20.4
9169
9170 ** Emacs compiled for MS-DOS now supports MULE features better.
9171 This includes support for display of all ISO 8859-N character sets,
9172 conversion to and from IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters,
9173 and automatic setup of the MULE environment at startup. For details,
9174 check out the section `MS-DOS and MULE' in the manual.
9175
9176 The MS-DOS installation procedure automatically configures and builds
9177 Emacs with input method support if it finds an unpacked Leim
9178 distribution when the config.bat script is run.
9179
9180 ** Formerly, the value of lpr-command did not affect printing on
9181 MS-DOS unless print-region-function was set to nil, but now it
9182 controls whether an external program is invoked or output is written
9183 directly to a printer port. Similarly, in the previous version of
9184 Emacs, the value of ps-lpr-command did not affect PostScript printing
9185 on MS-DOS unless ps-printer-name was set to something other than a
9186 string (eg. t or `pipe'), but now it controls whether an external
9187 program is used. (These changes were made so that configuration of
9188 printing variables would be almost identical across all platforms.)
9189
9190 ** In the previous version of Emacs, PostScript and non-PostScript
9191 output was piped to external programs, but because most print programs
9192 available for MS-DOS and MS-Windows cannot read data from their standard
9193 input, on those systems the data to be output is now written to a
9194 temporary file whose name is passed as the last argument to the external
9195 program.
9196
9197 An exception is made for `print', a standard program on Windows NT,
9198 and `nprint', a standard program on Novell Netware. For both of these
9199 programs, the command line is constructed in the appropriate syntax
9200 automatically, using only the value of printer-name or ps-printer-name
9201 as appropriate--the value of the relevant `-switches' variable is
9202 ignored, as both programs have no useful switches.
9203
9204 ** The value of the variable dos-printer (cf. dos-ps-printer), if it has
9205 a value, overrides the value of printer-name (cf. ps-printer-name), on
9206 MS-DOS and MS-Windows only. This has been true since version 20.3, but
9207 was not documented clearly before.
9208
9209 ** All the Emacs games now work on MS-DOS terminals.
9210 This includes Tetris and Snake.
9211 \f
9212 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.4
9213
9214 ** New functions line-beginning-position and line-end-position
9215 return the position of the beginning or end of the current line.
9216 They both accept an optional argument, which has the same
9217 meaning as the argument to beginning-of-line or end-of-line.
9218
9219 ** find-file and allied functions now have an optional argument
9220 WILDCARD. If this is non-nil, they do wildcard processing,
9221 and visit all files that match the wildcard pattern.
9222
9223 ** Changes in the file-attributes function.
9224
9225 *** The file size returned by file-attributes may be an integer or a float.
9226 It is an integer if the size fits in a Lisp integer, float otherwise.
9227
9228 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
9229 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a cons cell containing two
9230 integers.
9231
9232 ** The new function directory-files-and-attributes returns a list of
9233 files in a directory and their attributes. It accepts the same
9234 arguments as directory-files and has similar semantics, except that
9235 file names and attributes are returned.
9236
9237 ** The new function file-attributes-lessp is a helper function for
9238 sorting the list generated by directory-files-and-attributes. It
9239 accepts two arguments, each a list of a file name and its attributes.
9240 It compares the file names of each according to string-lessp and
9241 returns the result.
9242
9243 ** The new function file-expand-wildcards expands a wildcard-pattern
9244 to produce a list of existing files that match the pattern.
9245
9246 ** New functions for base64 conversion:
9247
9248 The function base64-encode-region converts a part of the buffer
9249 into the base64 code used in MIME. base64-decode-region
9250 performs the opposite conversion. Line-breaking is supported
9251 optionally.
9252
9253 Functions base64-encode-string and base64-decode-string do a similar
9254 job on the text in a string. They return the value as a new string.
9255
9256 **
9257 The new function process-running-child-p
9258 will tell you if a subprocess has given control of its
9259 terminal to its own child process.
9260
9261 ** interrupt-process and such functions have a new feature:
9262 when the second argument is `lambda', they send a signal
9263 to the running child of the subshell, if any, but if the shell
9264 itself owns its terminal, no signal is sent.
9265
9266 ** There are new widget types `plist' and `alist' which can
9267 be used for customizing variables whose values are plists or alists.
9268
9269 ** easymenu.el now understands `:key-sequence' and `:style button'.
9270 :included is an alias for :visible.
9271
9272 easy-menu-add-item now understands the values returned by
9273 easy-menu-remove-item and easy-menu-item-present-p. This can be used
9274 to move or copy menu entries.
9275
9276 ** Multibyte editing changes
9277
9278 *** The definitions of sref and char-bytes are changed. Now, sref is
9279 an alias of aref and char-bytes always returns 1. This change is to
9280 make some Emacs Lisp code which works on 20.2 and earlier also
9281 work on the latest Emacs. Such code uses a combination of sref and
9282 char-bytes in a loop typically as below:
9283 (setq char (sref str idx)
9284 idx (+ idx (char-bytes idx)))
9285 The byte-compiler now warns that this is obsolete.
9286
9287 If you want to know how many bytes a specific multibyte character
9288 (say, CH) occupies in a multibyte buffer, use this code:
9289 (charset-bytes (char-charset ch))
9290
9291 *** In multibyte mode, when you narrow a buffer to some region, and the
9292 region is preceded or followed by non-ASCII codes, inserting or
9293 deleting at the head or the end of the region may signal this error:
9294
9295 Byte combining across boundary of accessible buffer text inhibited
9296
9297 This is to avoid some bytes being combined together into a character
9298 across the boundary.
9299
9300 *** The functions find-charset-region and find-charset-string include
9301 `unknown' in the returned list in the following cases:
9302 o The current buffer or the target string is unibyte and
9303 contains 8-bit characters.
9304 o The current buffer or the target string is multibyte and
9305 contains invalid characters.
9306
9307 *** The functions decode-coding-region and encode-coding-region remove
9308 text properties of the target region. Ideally, they should correctly
9309 preserve text properties, but for the moment, it's hard. Removing
9310 text properties is better than preserving them in a less-than-correct
9311 way.
9312
9313 *** prefer-coding-system sets EOL conversion of default coding systems.
9314 If the argument to prefer-coding-system specifies a certain type of
9315 end of line conversion, the default coding systems set by
9316 prefer-coding-system will specify that conversion type for end of line.
9317
9318 *** The new function thai-compose-string can be used to properly
9319 compose Thai characters in a string.
9320
9321 ** The primitive `define-prefix-command' now takes an optional third
9322 argument NAME, which should be a string. It supplies the menu name
9323 for the created keymap. Keymaps created in order to be displayed as
9324 menus should always use the third argument.
9325
9326 ** The meanings of optional second arguments for read-char,
9327 read-event, and read-char-exclusive are flipped. Now the second
9328 arguments are INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. These functions use the current
9329 input method (if any) if and only if INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD is non-nil.
9330
9331 ** The new function clear-this-command-keys empties out the contents
9332 of the vector that (this-command-keys) returns. This is useful in
9333 programs that read passwords, to prevent the passwords from echoing
9334 inadvertently as part of the next command in certain cases.
9335
9336 ** The new macro `with-temp-message' displays a temporary message in
9337 the echo area, while executing some Lisp code. Like `progn', it
9338 returns the value of the last form, but it also restores the previous
9339 echo area contents.
9340
9341 (with-temp-message MESSAGE &rest BODY)
9342
9343 ** The function `require' now takes an optional third argument
9344 NOERROR. If it is non-nil, then there is no error if the
9345 requested feature cannot be loaded.
9346
9347 ** In the function modify-face, an argument of (nil) for the
9348 foreground color, background color or stipple pattern
9349 means to clear out that attribute.
9350
9351 ** The `outer-window-id' frame property of an X frame
9352 gives the window number of the outermost X window for the frame.
9353
9354 ** Temporary buffers made with with-output-to-temp-buffer are now
9355 read-only by default, and normally use the major mode Help mode
9356 unless you put them in some other non-Fundamental mode before the
9357 end of with-output-to-temp-buffer.
9358
9359 ** The new functions gap-position and gap-size return information on
9360 the gap of the current buffer.
9361
9362 ** The new functions position-bytes and byte-to-position provide a way
9363 to convert between character positions and byte positions in the
9364 current buffer.
9365
9366 ** vc.el defines two new macros, `edit-vc-file' and `with-vc-file', to
9367 facilitate working with version-controlled files from Lisp programs.
9368 These macros check out a given file automatically if needed, and check
9369 it back in after any modifications have been made.
9370 \f
9371 * Installation Changes in Emacs 20.3
9372
9373 ** The default value of load-path now includes most subdirectories of
9374 the site-specific directories /usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp and
9375 /usr/local/share/emacs/VERSION/site-lisp, in addition to those
9376 directories themselves. Both immediate subdirectories and
9377 subdirectories multiple levels down are added to load-path.
9378
9379 Not all subdirectories are included, though. Subdirectories whose
9380 names do not start with a letter or digit are excluded.
9381 Subdirectories named RCS or CVS are excluded. Also, a subdirectory
9382 which contains a file named `.nosearch' is excluded. You can use
9383 these methods to prevent certain subdirectories from being searched.
9384
9385 Emacs finds these subdirectories and adds them to load-path when it
9386 starts up. While it would be cleaner to find the subdirectories each
9387 time Emacs loads a file, that would be much slower.
9388
9389 This feature is an incompatible change. If you have stored some Emacs
9390 Lisp files in a subdirectory of the site-lisp directory specifically
9391 to prevent them from being used, you will need to rename the
9392 subdirectory to start with a non-alphanumeric character, or create a
9393 `.nosearch' file in it, in order to continue to achieve the desired
9394 results.
9395
9396 ** Emacs no longer includes an old version of the C preprocessor from
9397 GCC. This was formerly used to help compile Emacs with C compilers
9398 that had limits on the significant length of an identifier, but in
9399 fact we stopped supporting such compilers some time ago.
9400 \f
9401 * Changes in Emacs 20.3
9402
9403 ** The new command C-x z (repeat) repeats the previous command
9404 including its argument. If you repeat the z afterward,
9405 it repeats the command additional times; thus, you can
9406 perform many repetitions with one keystroke per repetition.
9407
9408 ** Emacs now supports "selective undo" which undoes only within a
9409 specified region. To do this, set point and mark around the desired
9410 region and type C-u C-x u (or C-u C-_). You can then continue undoing
9411 further, within the same region, by repeating the ordinary undo
9412 command C-x u or C-_. This will keep undoing changes that were made
9413 within the region you originally specified, until either all of them
9414 are undone, or it encounters a change which crosses the edge of that
9415 region.
9416
9417 In Transient Mark mode, undoing when a region is active requests
9418 selective undo.
9419
9420 ** If you specify --unibyte when starting Emacs, then all buffers are
9421 unibyte, except when a Lisp program specifically creates a multibyte
9422 buffer. Setting the environment variable EMACS_UNIBYTE has the same
9423 effect. The --no-unibyte option overrides EMACS_UNIBYTE and directs
9424 Emacs to run normally in multibyte mode.
9425
9426 The option --unibyte does not affect the reading of Emacs Lisp files,
9427 though. If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode, use
9428 -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line. That will force Emacs to
9429 load that file in unibyte mode, regardless of how Emacs was started.
9430
9431 ** toggle-enable-multibyte-characters no longer has a key binding and
9432 no longer appears in the menu bar. We've realized that changing the
9433 enable-multibyte-characters variable in an existing buffer is
9434 something that most users not do.
9435
9436 ** You can specify a coding system to use for the next cut or paste
9437 operations through the window system with the command C-x RET X.
9438 The coding system can make a difference for communication with other
9439 applications.
9440
9441 C-x RET x specifies a coding system for all subsequent cutting and
9442 pasting operations.
9443
9444 ** You can specify the printer to use for commands that do printing by
9445 setting the variable `printer-name'. Just what a printer name looks
9446 like depends on your operating system. You can specify a different
9447 printer for the Postscript printing commands by setting
9448 `ps-printer-name'.
9449
9450 ** Emacs now supports on-the-fly spell checking by the means of a
9451 minor mode. It is called M-x flyspell-mode. You don't have to remember
9452 any other special commands to use it, and you will hardly notice it
9453 except when you make a spelling error. Flyspell works by highlighting
9454 incorrect words as soon as they are completed or as soon as the cursor
9455 hits a new word.
9456
9457 Flyspell mode works with whichever dictionary you have selected for
9458 Ispell in Emacs. In TeX mode, it understands TeX syntax so as not
9459 to be confused by TeX commands.
9460
9461 You can correct a misspelled word by editing it into something
9462 correct. You can also correct it, or accept it as correct, by
9463 clicking on the word with Mouse-2; that gives you a pop-up menu
9464 of various alternative replacements and actions.
9465
9466 Flyspell mode also proposes "automatic" corrections. M-TAB replaces
9467 the current misspelled word with a possible correction. If several
9468 corrections are made possible, M-TAB cycles through them in
9469 alphabetical order, or in order of decreasing likelihood if
9470 flyspell-sort-corrections is nil.
9471
9472 Flyspell mode also flags an error when a word is repeated, if
9473 flyspell-mark-duplications-flag is non-nil.
9474
9475 ** Changes in input method usage.
9476
9477 Now you can use arrow keys (right, left, down, up) for selecting among
9478 the alternatives just the same way as you do by C-f, C-b, C-n, and C-p
9479 respectively.
9480
9481 You can use the ENTER key to accept the current conversion.
9482
9483 If you type TAB to display a list of alternatives, you can select one
9484 of the alternatives with Mouse-2.
9485
9486 The meaning of the variable `input-method-verbose-flag' is changed so
9487 that you can set it to t, nil, `default', or `complex-only'.
9488
9489 If the value is nil, extra guidance is never given.
9490
9491 If the value is t, extra guidance is always given.
9492
9493 If the value is `complex-only', extra guidance is always given only
9494 when you are using complex input methods such as chinese-py.
9495
9496 If the value is `default' (this is the default), extra guidance is
9497 given in the following case:
9498 o When you are using a complex input method.
9499 o When you are using a simple input method but not in the minibuffer.
9500
9501 If you are using Emacs through a very slow line, setting
9502 input-method-verbose-flag to nil or to complex-only is a good choice,
9503 and if you are using an input method you are not familiar with,
9504 setting it to t is helpful.
9505
9506 The old command select-input-method is now called set-input-method.
9507
9508 In the language environment "Korean", you can use the following
9509 keys:
9510 Shift-SPC toggle-korean-input-method
9511 C-F9 quail-hangul-switch-symbol-ksc
9512 F9 quail-hangul-switch-hanja
9513 These key bindings are canceled when you switch to another language
9514 environment.
9515
9516 ** The minibuffer history of file names now records the specified file
9517 names, not the entire minibuffer input. For example, if the
9518 minibuffer starts out with /usr/foo/, you might type in /etc/passwd to
9519 get
9520
9521 /usr/foo//etc/passwd
9522
9523 which stands for the file /etc/passwd.
9524
9525 Formerly, this used to put /usr/foo//etc/passwd in the history list.
9526 Now this puts just /etc/passwd in the history list.
9527
9528 ** If you are root, Emacs sets backup-by-copying-when-mismatch to t
9529 at startup, so that saving a file will be sure to preserve
9530 its owner and group.
9531
9532 ** find-func.el can now also find the place of definition of Emacs
9533 Lisp variables in user-loaded libraries.
9534
9535 ** C-x r t (string-rectangle) now deletes the existing rectangle
9536 contents before inserting the specified string on each line.
9537
9538 ** There is a new command delete-whitespace-rectangle
9539 which deletes whitespace starting from a particular column
9540 in all the lines on a rectangle. The column is specified
9541 by the left edge of the rectangle.
9542
9543 ** You can now store a number into a register with C-u NUMBER C-x r n REG,
9544 increment it by INC with C-u INC C-x r + REG (to increment by one, omit
9545 C-u INC), and insert it in the buffer with C-x r g REG. This is useful
9546 for writing keyboard macros.
9547
9548 ** The new command M-x speedbar displays a frame in which directories,
9549 files, and tags can be displayed, manipulated, and jumped to. The
9550 frame defaults to 20 characters in width, and is the same height as
9551 the frame that it was started from. Some major modes define
9552 additional commands for the speedbar, including Rmail, GUD/GDB, and
9553 info.
9554
9555 ** query-replace-regexp is now bound to C-M-%.
9556
9557 ** In Transient Mark mode, when the region is active, M-x
9558 query-replace and the other replace commands now operate on the region
9559 contents only.
9560
9561 ** M-x write-region, when used interactively, now asks for
9562 confirmation before overwriting an existing file. When you call
9563 the function from a Lisp program, a new optional argument CONFIRM
9564 says whether to ask for confirmation in this case.
9565
9566 ** If you use find-file-literally and the file is already visited
9567 non-literally, the command asks you whether to revisit the file
9568 literally. If you say no, it signals an error.
9569
9570 ** Major modes defined with the "derived mode" feature
9571 now use the proper name for the mode hook: WHATEVER-mode-hook.
9572 Formerly they used the name WHATEVER-mode-hooks, but that is
9573 inconsistent with Emacs conventions.
9574
9575 ** shell-command-on-region (and shell-command) reports success or
9576 failure if the command produces no output.
9577
9578 ** Set focus-follows-mouse to nil if your window system or window
9579 manager does not transfer focus to another window when you just move
9580 the mouse.
9581
9582 ** mouse-menu-buffer-maxlen has been renamed to
9583 mouse-buffer-menu-maxlen to be consistent with the other related
9584 function and variable names.
9585
9586 ** The new variable auto-coding-alist specifies coding systems for
9587 reading specific files. This has higher priority than
9588 file-coding-system-alist.
9589
9590 ** If you set the variable unibyte-display-via-language-environment to
9591 t, then Emacs displays non-ASCII characters are displayed by
9592 converting them to the equivalent multibyte characters according to
9593 the current language environment. As a result, they are displayed
9594 according to the current fontset.
9595
9596 ** C-q's handling of codes in the range 0200 through 0377 is changed.
9597
9598 The codes in the range 0200 through 0237 are inserted as one byte of
9599 that code regardless of the values of nonascii-translation-table and
9600 nonascii-insert-offset.
9601
9602 For the codes in the range 0240 through 0377, if
9603 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil and nonascii-translation-table
9604 nor nonascii-insert-offset can't convert them to valid multibyte
9605 characters, they are converted to Latin-1 characters.
9606
9607 ** If you try to find a file that is not read-accessible, you now get
9608 an error, rather than an empty buffer and a warning.
9609
9610 ** In the minibuffer history commands M-r and M-s, an upper case
9611 letter in the regular expression forces case-sensitive search.
9612
9613 ** In the *Help* buffer, cross-references to commands and variables
9614 are inferred and hyperlinked. Use C-h m in Help mode for the relevant
9615 command keys.
9616
9617 ** M-x apropos-command, with a prefix argument, no longer looks for
9618 user option variables--instead it looks for noninteractive functions.
9619
9620 Meanwhile, the command apropos-variable normally searches for
9621 user option variables; with a prefix argument, it looks at
9622 all variables that have documentation.
9623
9624 ** When you type a long line in the minibuffer, and the minibuffer
9625 shows just one line, automatically scrolling works in a special way
9626 that shows you overlap with the previous line of text. The variable
9627 minibuffer-scroll-overlap controls how many characters of overlap
9628 it should show; the default is 20.
9629
9630 Meanwhile, Resize Minibuffer mode is still available; in that mode,
9631 the minibuffer grows taller (up to a point) as needed to show the whole
9632 of your input.
9633
9634 ** The new command M-x customize-changed-options lets you customize
9635 all the options whose meanings or default values have changed in
9636 recent Emacs versions. You specify a previous Emacs version number as
9637 argument, and the command creates a customization buffer showing all
9638 the customizable options which were changed since that version.
9639 Newly added options are included as well.
9640
9641 If you don't specify a particular version number argument,
9642 then the customization buffer shows all the customizable options
9643 for which Emacs versions of changes are recorded.
9644
9645 This function is also bound to the Changed Options entry in the
9646 Customize menu.
9647
9648 ** When you run M-x grep with a prefix argument, it figures out
9649 the tag around point and puts that into the default grep command.
9650
9651 ** The new command M-* (pop-tag-mark) pops back through a history of
9652 buffer positions from which M-. or other tag-finding commands were
9653 invoked.
9654
9655 ** The new variable comment-padding specifies the number of spaces
9656 that `comment-region' will insert before the actual text of the comment.
9657 The default is 1.
9658
9659 ** In Fortran mode the characters `.', `_' and `$' now have symbol
9660 syntax, not word syntax. Fortran mode now supports `imenu' and has
9661 new commands fortran-join-line (M-^) and fortran-narrow-to-subprogram
9662 (C-x n d). M-q can be used to fill a statement or comment block
9663 sensibly.
9664
9665 ** GUD now supports jdb, the Java debugger, and pdb, the Python debugger.
9666
9667 ** If you set the variable add-log-keep-changes-together to a non-nil
9668 value, the command `C-x 4 a' will automatically notice when you make
9669 two entries in one day for one file, and combine them.
9670
9671 ** You can use the command M-x diary-mail-entries to mail yourself a
9672 reminder about upcoming diary entries. See the documentation string
9673 for a sample shell script for calling this function automatically
9674 every night.
9675
9676 ** Desktop changes
9677
9678 *** All you need to do to enable use of the Desktop package, is to set
9679 the variable desktop-enable to t with Custom.
9680
9681 *** Minor modes are now restored. Which minor modes are restored
9682 and how modes are restored is controlled by `desktop-minor-mode-table'.
9683
9684 ** There is no need to do anything special, now, to enable Gnus to
9685 read and post multi-lingual articles.
9686
9687 ** Outline mode has now support for showing hidden outlines when
9688 doing an isearch. In order for this to happen search-invisible should
9689 be set to open (the default). If an isearch match is inside a hidden
9690 outline the outline is made visible. If you continue pressing C-s and
9691 the match moves outside the formerly invisible outline, the outline is
9692 made invisible again.
9693
9694 ** Mail reading and sending changes
9695
9696 *** The Rmail e command now switches to displaying the whole header of
9697 the message before it lets you edit the message. This is so that any
9698 changes you make in the header will not be lost if you subsequently
9699 toggle.
9700
9701 *** The w command in Rmail, which writes the message body into a file,
9702 now works in the summary buffer as well. (The command to delete the
9703 summary buffer is now Q.) The default file name for the w command, if
9704 the message has no subject, is stored in the variable
9705 rmail-default-body-file.
9706
9707 *** Most of the commands and modes that operate on mail and netnews no
9708 longer depend on the value of mail-header-separator. Instead, they
9709 handle whatever separator the buffer happens to use.
9710
9711 *** If you set mail-signature to a value which is not t, nil, or a string,
9712 it should be an expression. When you send a message, this expression
9713 is evaluated to insert the signature.
9714
9715 *** The new Lisp library feedmail.el (version 8) enhances processing of
9716 outbound email messages. It works in coordination with other email
9717 handling packages (e.g., rmail, VM, gnus) and is responsible for
9718 putting final touches on messages and actually submitting them for
9719 transmission. Users of the emacs program "fakemail" might be
9720 especially interested in trying feedmail.
9721
9722 feedmail is not enabled by default. See comments at the top of
9723 feedmail.el for set-up instructions. Among the bigger features
9724 provided by feedmail are:
9725
9726 **** you can park outgoing messages into a disk-based queue and
9727 stimulate sending some or all of them later (handy for laptop users);
9728 there is also a queue for draft messages
9729
9730 **** you can get one last look at the prepped outbound message and
9731 be prompted for confirmation
9732
9733 **** does smart filling of address headers
9734
9735 **** can generate a MESSAGE-ID: line and a DATE: line; the date can be
9736 the time the message was written or the time it is being sent; this
9737 can make FCC copies more closely resemble copies that recipients get
9738
9739 **** you can specify an arbitrary function for actually transmitting
9740 the message; included in feedmail are interfaces for /bin/[r]mail,
9741 /usr/lib/sendmail, and elisp smtpmail; it's easy to write a new
9742 function for something else (10-20 lines of elisp)
9743
9744 ** Dired changes
9745
9746 *** The Dired function dired-do-toggle, which toggles marked and unmarked
9747 files, is now bound to "t" instead of "T".
9748
9749 *** dired-at-point has been added to ffap.el. It allows one to easily
9750 run Dired on the directory name at point.
9751
9752 *** Dired has a new command: %g. It searches the contents of
9753 files in the directory and marks each file that contains a match
9754 for a specified regexp.
9755
9756 ** VC Changes
9757
9758 *** New option vc-ignore-vc-files lets you turn off version control
9759 conveniently.
9760
9761 *** VC Dired has been completely rewritten. It is now much
9762 faster, especially for CVS, and works very similar to ordinary
9763 Dired.
9764
9765 VC Dired is invoked by typing C-x v d and entering the name of the
9766 directory to display. By default, VC Dired gives you a recursive
9767 listing of all files at or below the given directory which are
9768 currently locked (for CVS, all files not up-to-date are shown).
9769
9770 You can change the listing format by setting vc-dired-recurse to nil,
9771 then it shows only the given directory, and you may also set
9772 vc-dired-terse-display to nil, then it shows all files under version
9773 control plus the names of any subdirectories, so that you can type `i'
9774 on such lines to insert them manually, as in ordinary Dired.
9775
9776 All Dired commands operate normally in VC Dired, except for `v', which
9777 is redefined as the version control prefix. That means you may type
9778 `v l', `v =' etc. to invoke `vc-print-log', `vc-diff' and the like on
9779 the file named in the current Dired buffer line. `v v' invokes
9780 `vc-next-action' on this file, or on all files currently marked.
9781
9782 The new command `v t' (vc-dired-toggle-terse-mode) allows you to
9783 toggle between terse display (only locked files) and full display (all
9784 VC files plus subdirectories). There is also a special command,
9785 `* l', to mark all files currently locked.
9786
9787 Giving a prefix argument to C-x v d now does the same thing as in
9788 ordinary Dired: it allows you to supply additional options for the ls
9789 command in the minibuffer, to fine-tune VC Dired's output.
9790
9791 *** Under CVS, if you merge changes from the repository into a working
9792 file, and CVS detects conflicts, VC now offers to start an ediff
9793 session to resolve them.
9794
9795 Alternatively, you can use the new command `vc-resolve-conflicts' to
9796 resolve conflicts in a file at any time. It works in any buffer that
9797 contains conflict markers as generated by rcsmerge (which is what CVS
9798 uses as well).
9799
9800 *** You can now transfer changes between branches, using the new
9801 command vc-merge (C-x v m). It is implemented for RCS and CVS. When
9802 you invoke it in a buffer under version-control, you can specify
9803 either an entire branch or a pair of versions, and the changes on that
9804 branch or between the two versions are merged into the working file.
9805 If this results in any conflicts, they may be resolved interactively,
9806 using ediff.
9807
9808 ** Changes in Font Lock
9809
9810 *** The face and variable previously known as font-lock-reference-face
9811 are now called font-lock-constant-face to better reflect their typical
9812 use for highlighting constants and labels. (Its face properties are
9813 unchanged.) The variable font-lock-reference-face remains for now for
9814 compatibility reasons, but its value is font-lock-constant-face.
9815
9816 ** Frame name display changes
9817
9818 *** The command set-frame-name lets you set the name of the current
9819 frame. You can use the new command select-frame-by-name to select and
9820 raise a frame; this is mostly useful on character-only terminals, or
9821 when many frames are invisible or iconified.
9822
9823 *** On character-only terminal (not a window system), changing the
9824 frame name is now reflected on the mode line and in the Buffers/Frames
9825 menu.
9826
9827 ** Comint (subshell) changes
9828
9829 *** In Comint modes, the commands to kill, stop or interrupt a
9830 subjob now also kill pending input. This is for compatibility
9831 with ordinary shells, where the signal characters do this.
9832
9833 *** There are new commands in Comint mode.
9834
9835 C-c C-x fetches the "next" line from the input history;
9836 that is, the line after the last line you got.
9837 You can use this command to fetch successive lines, one by one.
9838
9839 C-c SPC accumulates lines of input. More precisely, it arranges to
9840 send the current line together with the following line, when you send
9841 the following line.
9842
9843 C-c C-a if repeated twice consecutively now moves to the process mark,
9844 which separates the pending input from the subprocess output and the
9845 previously sent input.
9846
9847 C-c M-r now runs comint-previous-matching-input-from-input;
9848 it searches for a previous command, using the current pending input
9849 as the search string.
9850
9851 *** New option compilation-scroll-output can be set to scroll
9852 automatically in compilation-mode windows.
9853
9854 ** C mode changes
9855
9856 *** Multiline macros are now handled, both as they affect indentation,
9857 and as recognized syntax. New syntactic symbol cpp-macro-cont is
9858 assigned to second and subsequent lines of a multiline macro
9859 definition.
9860
9861 *** A new style "user" which captures all non-hook-ified
9862 (i.e. top-level) .emacs file variable settings and customizations.
9863 Style "cc-mode" is an alias for "user" and is deprecated. "gnu"
9864 style is still the default however.
9865
9866 *** "java" style now conforms to Sun's JDK coding style.
9867
9868 *** There are new commands c-beginning-of-defun, c-end-of-defun which
9869 are alternatives which you could bind to C-M-a and C-M-e if you prefer
9870 them. They do not have key bindings by default.
9871
9872 *** New and improved implementations of M-a (c-beginning-of-statement)
9873 and M-e (c-end-of-statement).
9874
9875 *** C++ namespace blocks are supported, with new syntactic symbols
9876 namespace-open, namespace-close, and innamespace.
9877
9878 *** File local variable settings of c-file-style and c-file-offsets
9879 makes the style variables local to that buffer only.
9880
9881 *** New indentation functions c-lineup-close-paren,
9882 c-indent-one-line-block, c-lineup-dont-change.
9883
9884 *** Improvements (hopefully!) to the way CC Mode is loaded. You
9885 should now be able to do a (require 'cc-mode) to get the entire
9886 package loaded properly for customization in your .emacs file. A new
9887 variable c-initialize-on-load controls this and is t by default.
9888
9889 ** Changes to hippie-expand.
9890
9891 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-skip-space'. If
9892 non-nil, trailing spaces may be included in the abbreviation to search for,
9893 which then gives the same behavior as the original `dabbrev-expand'.
9894
9895 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-as-symbol'. If
9896 non-nil, characters of syntax '_' is considered part of the word when
9897 expanding dynamically.
9898
9899 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-no-restriction'. If
9900 non-nil, narrowed buffers are widened before they are searched.
9901
9902 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-only-buffers'. If
9903 non-empty, buffers searched are restricted to the types specified in
9904 this list. Useful for example when constructing new special-purpose
9905 expansion functions with `make-hippie-expand-function'.
9906
9907 *** Text properties of the expansion are no longer copied.
9908
9909 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
9910
9911 *** Any titleword matching a regexp in the new variable
9912 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore (case sensitive) is ignored during
9913 automatic key generation. This replaces variable
9914 bibtex-autokey-titleword-first-ignore, which only checked for matches
9915 against the first word in the title.
9916
9917 *** Autokey generation now uses all words from the title, not just
9918 capitalized words. To avoid conflicts with existing customizations,
9919 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore is set up such that words starting with
9920 lowerkey characters will still be ignored. Thus, if you want to use
9921 lowercase words from the title, you will have to overwrite the
9922 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore standard setting.
9923
9924 *** Case conversion of names and title words for automatic key
9925 generation is more flexible. Variable bibtex-autokey-preserve-case is
9926 replaced by bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert and
9927 bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert.
9928
9929 ** Changes in vcursor.el.
9930
9931 *** Support for character terminals is available: there is a new keymap
9932 and the vcursor will appear as an arrow between buffer text. A
9933 variable `vcursor-interpret-input' allows input from the vcursor to be
9934 entered exactly as if typed. Numerous functions, including
9935 `vcursor-compare-windows', have been rewritten to improve consistency
9936 in the selection of windows and corresponding keymaps.
9937
9938 *** vcursor options can now be altered with M-x customize under the
9939 Editing group once the package is loaded.
9940
9941 *** Loading vcursor now does not define keys by default, as this is
9942 generally a bad side effect. Use M-x customize to set
9943 vcursor-key-bindings to t to restore the old behavior.
9944
9945 *** vcursor-auto-disable can be `copy', which turns off copying from the
9946 vcursor, but doesn't disable it, after any non-vcursor command.
9947
9948 ** Ispell changes.
9949
9950 *** You can now spell check comments and strings in the current
9951 buffer with M-x ispell-comments-and-strings. Comments and strings
9952 are identified by syntax tables in effect.
9953
9954 *** Generic region skipping implemented.
9955 A single buffer can be broken into a number of regions where text will
9956 and will not be checked. The definitions of the regions can be user
9957 defined. New applications and improvements made available by this
9958 include:
9959
9960 o URLs are automatically skipped
9961 o EMail message checking is vastly improved.
9962
9963 *** Ispell can highlight the erroneous word even on non-window terminals.
9964
9965 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
9966
9967 RefTeX has been updated in order to make it more usable with very
9968 large projects (like a several volume math book). The parser has been
9969 re-written from scratch. To get maximum speed from RefTeX, check the
9970 section `Optimizations' in the manual.
9971
9972 *** New recursive parser.
9973
9974 The old version of RefTeX created a single large buffer containing the
9975 entire multifile document in order to parse the document. The new
9976 recursive parser scans the individual files.
9977
9978 *** Parsing only part of a document.
9979
9980 Reparsing of changed document parts can now be made faster by enabling
9981 partial scans. To use this feature, read the documentation string of
9982 the variable `reftex-enable-partial-scans' and set the variable to t.
9983
9984 (setq reftex-enable-partial-scans t)
9985
9986 *** Storing parsing information in a file.
9987
9988 This can improve startup times considerably. To turn it on, use
9989
9990 (setq reftex-save-parse-info t)
9991
9992 *** Using multiple selection buffers
9993
9994 If the creation of label selection buffers is too slow (this happens
9995 for large documents), you can reuse these buffers by setting
9996
9997 (setq reftex-use-multiple-selection-buffers t)
9998
9999 *** References to external documents.
10000
10001 The LaTeX package `xr' allows to cross-reference labels in external
10002 documents. RefTeX can provide information about the external
10003 documents as well. To use this feature, set up the \externaldocument
10004 macros required by the `xr' package and rescan the document with
10005 RefTeX. The external labels can then be accessed with the `x' key in
10006 the selection buffer provided by `reftex-reference' (bound to `C-c )').
10007 The `x' key also works in the table of contents buffer.
10008
10009 *** Many more labeled LaTeX environments are recognized by default.
10010
10011 The built-in command list now covers all the standard LaTeX commands,
10012 and all of the major packages included in the LaTeX distribution.
10013
10014 Also, RefTeX now understands the \appendix macro and changes
10015 the enumeration of sections in the *toc* buffer accordingly.
10016
10017 *** Mouse support for selection and *toc* buffers
10018
10019 The mouse can now be used to select items in the selection and *toc*
10020 buffers. See also the new option `reftex-highlight-selection'.
10021
10022 *** New keymaps for selection and table of contents modes.
10023
10024 The selection processes for labels and citation keys, and the table of
10025 contents buffer now have their own keymaps: `reftex-select-label-map',
10026 `reftex-select-bib-map', `reftex-toc-map'. The selection processes
10027 have a number of new keys predefined. In particular, TAB lets you
10028 enter a label with completion. Check the on-the-fly help (press `?'
10029 at the selection prompt) or read the Info documentation to find out
10030 more.
10031
10032 *** Support for the varioref package
10033
10034 The `v' key in the label selection buffer toggles \ref versus \vref.
10035
10036 *** New hooks
10037
10038 Three new hooks can be used to redefine the way labels, references,
10039 and citations are created. These hooks are
10040 `reftex-format-label-function', `reftex-format-ref-function',
10041 `reftex-format-cite-function'.
10042
10043 *** Citations outside LaTeX
10044
10045 The command `reftex-citation' may also be used outside LaTeX (e.g. in
10046 a mail buffer). See the Info documentation for details.
10047
10048 *** Short context is no longer fontified.
10049
10050 The short context in the label menu no longer copies the
10051 fontification from the text in the buffer. If you prefer it to be
10052 fontified, use
10053
10054 (setq reftex-refontify-context t)
10055
10056 ** file-cache-minibuffer-complete now accepts a prefix argument.
10057 With a prefix argument, it does not try to do completion of
10058 the file name within its directory; it only checks for other
10059 directories that contain the same file name.
10060
10061 Thus, given the file name Makefile, and assuming that a file
10062 Makefile.in exists in the same directory, ordinary
10063 file-cache-minibuffer-complete will try to complete Makefile to
10064 Makefile.in and will therefore never look for other directories that
10065 have Makefile. A prefix argument tells it not to look for longer
10066 names such as Makefile.in, so that instead it will look for other
10067 directories--just as if the name were already complete in its present
10068 directory.
10069
10070 ** New modes and packages
10071
10072 *** There is a new alternative major mode for Perl, Cperl mode.
10073 It has many more features than Perl mode, and some people prefer
10074 it, but some do not.
10075
10076 *** There is a new major mode, M-x vhdl-mode, for editing files of VHDL
10077 code.
10078
10079 *** M-x which-function-mode enables a minor mode that displays the
10080 current function name continuously in the mode line, as you move
10081 around in a buffer.
10082
10083 Which Function mode is effective in major modes which support Imenu.
10084
10085 *** Gametree is a major mode for editing game analysis trees. The author
10086 uses it for keeping notes about his postal Chess games, but it should
10087 be helpful for other two-player games as well, as long as they have an
10088 established system of notation similar to Chess.
10089
10090 *** The new minor mode checkdoc-minor-mode provides Emacs Lisp
10091 documentation string checking for style and spelling. The style
10092 guidelines are found in the Emacs Lisp programming manual.
10093
10094 *** The net-utils package makes some common networking features
10095 available in Emacs. Some of these functions are wrappers around
10096 system utilities (ping, nslookup, etc); others are implementations of
10097 simple protocols (finger, whois) in Emacs Lisp. There are also
10098 functions to make simple connections to TCP/IP ports for debugging and
10099 the like.
10100
10101 *** highlight-changes-mode is a minor mode that uses colors to
10102 identify recently changed parts of the buffer text.
10103
10104 *** The new package `midnight' lets you specify things to be done
10105 within Emacs at midnight--by default, kill buffers that you have not
10106 used in a considerable time. To use this feature, customize
10107 the user option `midnight-mode' to t.
10108
10109 *** The file generic-x.el defines a number of simple major modes.
10110
10111 apache-generic-mode: For Apache and NCSA httpd configuration files
10112 samba-generic-mode: Samba configuration files
10113 fvwm-generic-mode: For fvwm initialization files
10114 x-resource-generic-mode: For X resource files
10115 hosts-generic-mode: For hosts files (.rhosts, /etc/hosts, etc)
10116 mailagent-rules-generic-mode: For mailagent .rules files
10117 javascript-generic-mode: For JavaScript files
10118 vrml-generic-mode: For VRML files
10119 java-manifest-generic-mode: For Java MANIFEST files
10120 java-properties-generic-mode: For Java property files
10121 mailrc-generic-mode: For .mailrc files
10122
10123 Platform-specific modes:
10124
10125 prototype-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V prototype files
10126 pkginfo-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V pkginfo files
10127 alias-generic-mode: For C shell alias files
10128 inf-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INF files
10129 ini-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INI files
10130 reg-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Registry files
10131 bat-generic-mode: For MS-Windows BAT scripts
10132 rc-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Resource files
10133 rul-generic-mode: For InstallShield scripts
10134 \f
10135 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 since the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
10136
10137 ** If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode,
10138 use -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line.
10139 That will force Emacs to read that file in unibyte mode.
10140 Otherwise, the file will be loaded and byte-compiled in multibyte mode.
10141
10142 Thus, each lisp file is read in a consistent way regardless of whether
10143 you started Emacs with --unibyte, so that a Lisp program gives
10144 consistent results regardless of how Emacs was started.
10145
10146 ** The new function assoc-default is useful for searching an alist,
10147 and using a default value if the key is not found there. You can
10148 specify a comparison predicate, so this function is useful for
10149 searching comparing a string against an alist of regular expressions.
10150
10151 ** The functions unibyte-char-to-multibyte and
10152 multibyte-char-to-unibyte convert between unibyte and multibyte
10153 character codes, in a way that is appropriate for the current language
10154 environment.
10155
10156 ** The functions read-event, read-char and read-char-exclusive now
10157 take two optional arguments. PROMPT, if non-nil, specifies a prompt
10158 string. SUPPRESS-INPUT-METHOD, if non-nil, says to disable the
10159 current input method for reading this one event.
10160
10161 ** Two new variables print-escape-nonascii and print-escape-multibyte
10162 now control whether to output certain characters as
10163 backslash-sequences. print-escape-nonascii applies to single-byte
10164 non-ASCII characters; print-escape-multibyte applies to multibyte
10165 characters. Both of these variables are used only when printing
10166 in readable fashion (prin1 uses them, princ does not).
10167 \f
10168 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 before the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
10169
10170 ** Compiled Emacs Lisp files made with the modified "MBSK" version
10171 of Emacs 20.2 do not work in Emacs 20.3.
10172
10173 ** Buffer positions are now measured in characters, as they were
10174 in Emacs 19 and before. This means that (forward-char 1)
10175 always increases point by 1.
10176
10177 The function chars-in-region now just subtracts its arguments. It is
10178 considered obsolete. The function char-boundary-p has been deleted.
10179
10180 See below for additional changes relating to multibyte characters.
10181
10182 ** defcustom, defface and defgroup now accept the keyword `:version'.
10183 Use this to specify in which version of Emacs a certain variable's
10184 default value changed. For example,
10185
10186 (defcustom foo-max 34 "*Maximum number of foo's allowed."
10187 :type 'integer
10188 :group 'foo
10189 :version "20.3")
10190
10191 (defgroup foo-group nil "The foo group."
10192 :version "20.3")
10193
10194 If an entire new group is added or the variables in it have the
10195 default values changed, then just add a `:version' to that group. It
10196 is recommended that new packages added to the distribution contain a
10197 `:version' in the top level group.
10198
10199 This information is used to control the customize-changed-options command.
10200
10201 ** It is now an error to change the value of a symbol whose name
10202 starts with a colon--if it is interned in the standard obarray.
10203
10204 However, setting such a symbol to its proper value, which is that
10205 symbol itself, is not an error. This is for the sake of programs that
10206 support previous Emacs versions by explicitly setting these variables
10207 to themselves.
10208
10209 If you set the variable keyword-symbols-constant-flag to nil,
10210 this error is suppressed, and you can set these symbols to any
10211 values whatever.
10212
10213 ** There is a new debugger command, R.
10214 It evaluates an expression like e, but saves the result
10215 in the buffer *Debugger-record*.
10216
10217 ** Frame-local variables.
10218
10219 You can now make a variable local to various frames. To do this, call
10220 the function make-variable-frame-local; this enables frames to have
10221 local bindings for that variable.
10222
10223 These frame-local bindings are actually frame parameters: you create a
10224 frame-local binding in a specific frame by calling
10225 modify-frame-parameters and specifying the variable name as the
10226 parameter name.
10227
10228 Buffer-local bindings take precedence over frame-local bindings.
10229 Thus, if the current buffer has a buffer-local binding, that binding is
10230 active; otherwise, if the selected frame has a frame-local binding,
10231 that binding is active; otherwise, the default binding is active.
10232
10233 It would not be hard to implement window-local bindings, but it is not
10234 clear that this would be very useful; windows tend to come and go in a
10235 very transitory fashion, so that trying to produce any specific effect
10236 through a window-local binding would not be very robust.
10237
10238 ** `sregexq' and `sregex' are two new functions for constructing
10239 "symbolic regular expressions." These are Lisp expressions that, when
10240 evaluated, yield conventional string-based regexps. The symbolic form
10241 makes it easier to construct, read, and maintain complex patterns.
10242 See the documentation in sregex.el.
10243
10244 ** parse-partial-sexp's return value has an additional element which
10245 is used to pass information along if you pass it to another call to
10246 parse-partial-sexp, starting its scan where the first call ended.
10247 The contents of this field are not yet finalized.
10248
10249 ** eval-region now accepts a fourth optional argument READ-FUNCTION.
10250 If it is non-nil, that function is used instead of `read'.
10251
10252 ** unload-feature by default removes the feature's functions from
10253 known hooks to avoid trouble, but a package providing FEATURE can
10254 define a hook FEATURE-unload-hook to be run by unload-feature instead.
10255
10256 ** read-from-minibuffer no longer returns the argument DEFAULT-VALUE
10257 when the user enters empty input. It now returns the null string, as
10258 it did in Emacs 19. The default value is made available in the
10259 history via M-n, but it is not applied here as a default.
10260
10261 The other, more specialized minibuffer-reading functions continue to
10262 return the default value (not the null string) when the user enters
10263 empty input.
10264
10265 ** The new variable read-buffer-function controls which routine to use
10266 for selecting buffers. For example, if you set this variable to
10267 `iswitchb-read-buffer', iswitchb will be used to read buffer names.
10268 Other functions can also be used if they accept the same arguments as
10269 `read-buffer' and return the selected buffer name as a string.
10270
10271 ** The new function read-passwd reads a password from the terminal,
10272 echoing a period for each character typed. It takes three arguments:
10273 a prompt string, a flag which says "read it twice to make sure", and a
10274 default password to use if the user enters nothing.
10275
10276 ** The variable fill-nobreak-predicate gives major modes a way to
10277 specify not to break a line at certain places. Its value is a
10278 function which is called with no arguments, with point located at the
10279 place where a break is being considered. If the function returns
10280 non-nil, then the line won't be broken there.
10281
10282 ** window-end now takes an optional second argument, UPDATE.
10283 If this is non-nil, then the function always returns an accurate
10284 up-to-date value for the buffer position corresponding to the
10285 end of the window, even if this requires computation.
10286
10287 ** other-buffer now takes an optional argument FRAME
10288 which specifies which frame's buffer list to use.
10289 If it is nil, that means use the selected frame's buffer list.
10290
10291 ** The new variable buffer-display-time, always local in every buffer,
10292 holds the value of (current-time) as of the last time that a window
10293 was directed to display this buffer.
10294
10295 ** It is now meaningful to compare two window-configuration objects
10296 with `equal'. Two window-configuration objects are equal if they
10297 describe equivalent arrangements of windows, in the same frame--in
10298 other words, if they would give the same results if passed to
10299 set-window-configuration.
10300
10301 ** compare-window-configurations is a new function that compares two
10302 window configurations loosely. It ignores differences in saved buffer
10303 positions and scrolling, and considers only the structure and sizes of
10304 windows and the choice of buffers to display.
10305
10306 ** The variable minor-mode-overriding-map-alist allows major modes to
10307 override the key bindings of a minor mode. The elements of this alist
10308 look like the elements of minor-mode-map-alist: (VARIABLE . KEYMAP).
10309
10310 If the VARIABLE in an element of minor-mode-overriding-map-alist has a
10311 non-nil value, the paired KEYMAP is active, and totally overrides the
10312 map (if any) specified for the same variable in minor-mode-map-alist.
10313
10314 minor-mode-overriding-map-alist is automatically local in all buffers,
10315 and it is meant to be set by major modes.
10316
10317 ** The function match-string-no-properties is like match-string
10318 except that it discards all text properties from the result.
10319
10320 ** The function load-average now accepts an optional argument
10321 USE-FLOATS. If it is non-nil, the load average values are returned as
10322 floating point numbers, rather than as integers to be divided by 100.
10323
10324 ** The new variable temporary-file-directory specifies the directory
10325 to use for creating temporary files. The default value is determined
10326 in a reasonable way for your operating system; on GNU and Unix systems
10327 it is based on the TMP and TMPDIR environment variables.
10328
10329 ** Menu changes
10330
10331 *** easymenu.el now uses the new menu item format and supports the
10332 keywords :visible and :filter. The existing keyword :keys is now
10333 better supported.
10334
10335 The variable `easy-menu-precalculate-equivalent-keybindings' controls
10336 a new feature which calculates keyboard equivalents for the menu when
10337 you define the menu. The default is t. If you rarely use menus, you
10338 can set the variable to nil to disable this precalculation feature;
10339 then the calculation is done only if you use the menu bar.
10340
10341 *** A new format for menu items is supported.
10342
10343 In a keymap, a key binding that has the format
10344 (STRING . REAL-BINDING) or (STRING HELP-STRING . REAL-BINDING)
10345 defines a menu item. Now a menu item definition may also be a list that
10346 starts with the symbol `menu-item'.
10347
10348 The format is:
10349 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) or
10350 (menu-item ITEM-NAME REAL-BINDING . ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST)
10351 where ITEM-NAME is an expression which evaluates to the menu item
10352 string, and ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST has the form of a property list.
10353 The supported properties include
10354
10355 :enable FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
10356 item is enabled.
10357 :visible FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
10358 item should appear in the menu.
10359 :filter FILTER-FN
10360 FILTER-FN is a function of one argument,
10361 which will be REAL-BINDING.
10362 It should return a binding to use instead.
10363 :keys DESCRIPTION
10364 DESCRIPTION is a string that describes an equivalent keyboard
10365 binding for REAL-BINDING. DESCRIPTION is expanded with
10366 `substitute-command-keys' before it is used.
10367 :key-sequence KEY-SEQUENCE
10368 KEY-SEQUENCE is a key-sequence for an equivalent
10369 keyboard binding.
10370 :key-sequence nil
10371 This means that the command normally has no
10372 keyboard equivalent.
10373 :help HELP HELP is the extra help string (not currently used).
10374 :button (TYPE . SELECTED)
10375 TYPE is :toggle or :radio.
10376 SELECTED is a form, to be evaluated, and its
10377 value says whether this button is currently selected.
10378
10379 Buttons are at the moment only simulated by prefixes in the menu.
10380 Eventually ordinary X-buttons may be supported.
10381
10382 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) defines unselectable item.
10383
10384 ** New event types
10385
10386 *** The new event type `mouse-wheel' is generated by a wheel on a
10387 mouse (such as the MS Intellimouse). The event contains a delta that
10388 corresponds to the amount and direction that the wheel is rotated,
10389 which is typically used to implement a scroll or zoom. The format is:
10390
10391 (mouse-wheel POSITION DELTA)
10392
10393 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
10394 same format as a mouse-click event, and DELTA is a signed number
10395 indicating the number of increments by which the wheel was rotated. A
10396 negative DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated backwards, towards
10397 the user, and a positive DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated
10398 forward, away from the user.
10399
10400 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
10401
10402 *** The new event type `drag-n-drop' is generated when a group of
10403 files is selected in an application outside of Emacs, and then dragged
10404 and dropped onto an Emacs frame. The event contains a list of
10405 filenames that were dragged and dropped, which are then typically
10406 loaded into Emacs. The format is:
10407
10408 (drag-n-drop POSITION FILES)
10409
10410 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
10411 same format as a mouse-click event, and FILES is the list of filenames
10412 that were dragged and dropped.
10413
10414 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
10415
10416 ** Changes relating to multibyte characters.
10417
10418 *** The variable enable-multibyte-characters is now read-only;
10419 any attempt to set it directly signals an error. The only way
10420 to change this value in an existing buffer is with set-buffer-multibyte.
10421
10422 *** In a string constant, `\ ' now stands for "nothing at all". You
10423 can use it to terminate a hex escape which is followed by a character
10424 that could otherwise be read as part of the hex escape.
10425
10426 *** String indices are now measured in characters, as they were
10427 in Emacs 19 and before.
10428
10429 The function chars-in-string has been deleted.
10430 The function concat-chars has been renamed to `string'.
10431
10432 *** The function set-buffer-multibyte sets the flag in the current
10433 buffer that says whether the buffer uses multibyte representation or
10434 unibyte representation. If the argument is nil, it selects unibyte
10435 representation. Otherwise it selects multibyte representation.
10436
10437 This function does not change the contents of the buffer, viewed
10438 as a sequence of bytes. However, it does change the contents
10439 viewed as characters; a sequence of two bytes which is treated as
10440 one character when the buffer uses multibyte representation
10441 will count as two characters using unibyte representation.
10442
10443 This function sets enable-multibyte-characters to record which
10444 representation is in use. It also adjusts various data in the buffer
10445 (including its markers, overlays and text properties) so that they are
10446 consistent with the new representation.
10447
10448 *** string-make-multibyte takes a string and converts it to multibyte
10449 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care
10450 about the representation, because Emacs converts when necessary;
10451 however, it makes a difference when you compare strings.
10452
10453 The conversion of non-ASCII characters works by adding the value of
10454 nonascii-insert-offset to each character, or by translating them
10455 using the table nonascii-translation-table.
10456
10457 *** string-make-unibyte takes a string and converts it to unibyte
10458 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care about the
10459 representation, but it makes a difference when you compare strings.
10460
10461 The conversion from multibyte to unibyte representation
10462 loses information; the only time Emacs performs it automatically
10463 is when inserting a multibyte string into a unibyte buffer.
10464
10465 *** string-as-multibyte takes a string, and returns another string
10466 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as multibyte.
10467
10468 *** string-as-unibyte takes a string, and returns another string
10469 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as unibyte.
10470
10471 *** The new function compare-strings lets you compare
10472 portions of two strings. Unibyte strings are converted to multibyte,
10473 so that a unibyte string can match a multibyte string.
10474 You can specify whether to ignore case or not.
10475
10476 *** assoc-ignore-case now uses compare-strings so that
10477 it can treat unibyte and multibyte strings as equal.
10478
10479 *** Regular expression operations and buffer string searches now
10480 convert the search pattern to multibyte or unibyte to accord with the
10481 buffer or string being searched.
10482
10483 One consequence is that you cannot always use \200-\377 inside of
10484 [...] to match all non-ASCII characters. This does still work when
10485 searching or matching a unibyte buffer or string, but not when
10486 searching or matching a multibyte string. Unfortunately, there is no
10487 obvious choice of syntax to use within [...] for that job. But, what
10488 you want is just to match all non-ASCII characters, the regular
10489 expression [^\0-\177] works for it.
10490
10491 *** Structure of coding system changed.
10492
10493 All coding systems (including aliases and subsidiaries) are named
10494 by symbols; the symbol's `coding-system' property is a vector
10495 which defines the coding system. Aliases share the same vector
10496 as the principal name, so that altering the contents of this
10497 vector affects the principal name and its aliases. You can define
10498 your own alias name of a coding system by the function
10499 define-coding-system-alias.
10500
10501 The coding system definition includes a property list of its own. Use
10502 the new functions `coding-system-get' and `coding-system-put' to
10503 access such coding system properties as post-read-conversion,
10504 pre-write-conversion, character-translation-table-for-decode,
10505 character-translation-table-for-encode, mime-charset, and
10506 safe-charsets. For instance, (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1
10507 'mime-charset) gives the corresponding MIME-charset parameter
10508 `iso-8859-1'.
10509
10510 Among the coding system properties listed above, safe-charsets is new.
10511 The value of this property is a list of character sets which this
10512 coding system can correctly encode and decode. For instance:
10513 (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1 'safe-charsets) => (ascii latin-iso8859-1)
10514
10515 Here, "correctly encode" means that the encoded character sets can
10516 also be handled safely by systems other than Emacs as far as they
10517 are capable of that coding system. Though, Emacs itself can encode
10518 the other character sets and read it back correctly.
10519
10520 *** The new function select-safe-coding-system can be used to find a
10521 proper coding system for encoding the specified region or string.
10522 This function requires a user interaction.
10523
10524 *** The new functions find-coding-systems-region and
10525 find-coding-systems-string are helper functions used by
10526 select-safe-coding-system. They return a list of all proper coding
10527 systems to encode a text in some region or string. If you don't want
10528 a user interaction, use one of these functions instead of
10529 select-safe-coding-system.
10530
10531 *** The explicit encoding and decoding functions, such as
10532 decode-coding-region and encode-coding-string, now set
10533 last-coding-system-used to reflect the actual way encoding or decoding
10534 was done.
10535
10536 *** The new function detect-coding-with-language-environment can be
10537 used to detect a coding system of text according to priorities of
10538 coding systems used by some specific language environment.
10539
10540 *** The functions detect-coding-region and detect-coding-string always
10541 return a list if the arg HIGHEST is nil. Thus, if only ASCII
10542 characters are found, they now return a list of single element
10543 `undecided' or its subsidiaries.
10544
10545 *** The new functions coding-system-change-eol-conversion and
10546 coding-system-change-text-conversion can be used to get a different
10547 coding system than what specified only in how end-of-line or text is
10548 converted.
10549
10550 *** The new function set-selection-coding-system can be used to set a
10551 coding system for communicating with other X clients.
10552
10553 *** The function `map-char-table' now passes as argument only valid
10554 character codes, plus generic characters that stand for entire
10555 character sets or entire subrows of a character set. In other words,
10556 each time `map-char-table' calls its FUNCTION argument, the key value
10557 either will be a valid individual character code, or will stand for a
10558 range of characters.
10559
10560 *** The new function `char-valid-p' can be used for checking whether a
10561 Lisp object is a valid character code or not.
10562
10563 *** The new function `charset-after' returns a charset of a character
10564 in the current buffer at position POS.
10565
10566 *** Input methods are now implemented using the variable
10567 input-method-function. If this is non-nil, its value should be a
10568 function; then, whenever Emacs reads an input event that is a printing
10569 character with no modifier bits, it calls that function, passing the
10570 event as an argument. Often this function will read more input, first
10571 binding input-method-function to nil.
10572
10573 The return value should be a list of the events resulting from input
10574 method processing. These events will be processed sequentially as
10575 input, before resorting to unread-command-events. Events returned by
10576 the input method function are not passed to the input method function,
10577 not even if they are printing characters with no modifier bits.
10578
10579 The input method function is not called when reading the second and
10580 subsequent events of a key sequence.
10581
10582 *** You can customize any language environment by using
10583 set-language-environment-hook and exit-language-environment-hook.
10584
10585 The hook `exit-language-environment-hook' should be used to undo
10586 customizations that you made with set-language-environment-hook. For
10587 instance, if you set up a special key binding for a specific language
10588 environment by set-language-environment-hook, you should set up
10589 exit-language-environment-hook to restore the normal key binding.
10590 \f
10591 * Changes in Emacs 20.1
10592
10593 ** Emacs has a new facility for customization of its many user
10594 options. It is called M-x customize. With this facility you can look
10595 at the many user options in an organized way; they are grouped into a
10596 tree structure.
10597
10598 M-x customize also knows what sorts of values are legitimate for each
10599 user option and ensures that you don't use invalid values.
10600
10601 With M-x customize, you can set options either for the present Emacs
10602 session or permanently. (Permanent settings are stored automatically
10603 in your .emacs file.)
10604
10605 ** Scroll bars are now on the left side of the window.
10606 You can change this with M-x customize-option scroll-bar-mode.
10607
10608 ** The mode line no longer includes the string `Emacs'.
10609 This makes more space in the mode line for other information.
10610
10611 ** When you select a region with the mouse, it is highlighted
10612 immediately afterward. At that time, if you type the DELETE key, it
10613 kills the region.
10614
10615 The BACKSPACE key, and the ASCII character DEL, do not do this; they
10616 delete the character before point, as usual.
10617
10618 ** In an incremental search the whole current match is highlighted
10619 on terminals which support this. (You can disable this feature
10620 by setting search-highlight to nil.)
10621
10622 ** In the minibuffer, in some cases, you can now use M-n to
10623 insert the default value into the minibuffer as text. In effect,
10624 the default value (if the minibuffer routines know it) is tacked
10625 onto the history "in the future". (The more normal use of the
10626 history list is to use M-p to insert minibuffer input used in the
10627 past.)
10628
10629 ** In Text mode, now only blank lines separate paragraphs.
10630 This makes it possible to get the full benefit of Adaptive Fill mode
10631 in Text mode, and other modes derived from it (such as Mail mode).
10632 TAB in Text mode now runs the command indent-relative; this
10633 makes a practical difference only when you use indented paragraphs.
10634
10635 As a result, the old Indented Text mode is now identical to Text mode,
10636 and is an alias for it.
10637
10638 If you want spaces at the beginning of a line to start a paragraph,
10639 use the new mode, Paragraph Indent Text mode.
10640
10641 ** Scrolling changes
10642
10643 *** Scroll commands to scroll a whole screen now preserve the screen
10644 position of the cursor, if scroll-preserve-screen-position is non-nil.
10645
10646 In this mode, if you scroll several screens back and forth, finishing
10647 on the same screen where you started, the cursor goes back to the line
10648 where it started.
10649
10650 *** If you set scroll-conservatively to a small number, then when you
10651 move point a short distance off the screen, Emacs will scroll the
10652 screen just far enough to bring point back on screen, provided that
10653 does not exceed `scroll-conservatively' lines.
10654
10655 *** The new variable scroll-margin says how close point can come to the
10656 top or bottom of a window. It is a number of screen lines; if point
10657 comes within that many lines of the top or bottom of the window, Emacs
10658 recenters the window.
10659
10660 ** International character set support (MULE)
10661
10662 Emacs now supports a wide variety of international character sets,
10663 including European variants of the Latin alphabet, as well as Chinese,
10664 Devanagari (Hindi and Marathi), Ethiopian, Greek, IPA, Japanese,
10665 Korean, Lao, Russian, Thai, Tibetan, and Vietnamese scripts. These
10666 features have been merged from the modified version of Emacs known as
10667 MULE (for "MULti-lingual Enhancement to GNU Emacs")
10668
10669 Users of these scripts have established many more-or-less standard
10670 coding systems for storing files. Emacs uses a single multibyte
10671 character encoding within Emacs buffers; it can translate from a wide
10672 variety of coding systems when reading a file and can translate back
10673 into any of these coding systems when saving a file.
10674
10675 Keyboards, even in the countries where these character sets are used,
10676 generally don't have keys for all the characters in them. So Emacs
10677 supports various "input methods", typically one for each script or
10678 language, to make it possible to type them.
10679
10680 The Emacs internal multibyte encoding represents a non-ASCII
10681 character as a sequence of bytes in the range 0200 through 0377.
10682
10683 The new prefix key C-x RET is used for commands that pertain
10684 to multibyte characters, coding systems, and input methods.
10685
10686 You can disable multibyte character support as follows:
10687
10688 (setq-default enable-multibyte-characters nil)
10689
10690 Calling the function standard-display-european turns off multibyte
10691 characters, unless you specify a non-nil value for the second
10692 argument, AUTO. This provides compatibility for people who are
10693 already using standard-display-european to continue using unibyte
10694 characters for their work until they want to change.
10695
10696 *** Input methods
10697
10698 An input method is a kind of character conversion which is designed
10699 specifically for interactive input. In Emacs, typically each language
10700 has its own input method (though sometimes several languages which use
10701 the same characters can share one input method). Some languages
10702 support several input methods.
10703
10704 The simplest kind of input method works by mapping ASCII letters into
10705 another alphabet. This is how the Greek and Russian input methods
10706 work.
10707
10708 A more powerful technique is composition: converting sequences of
10709 characters into one letter. Many European input methods use
10710 composition to produce a single non-ASCII letter from a sequence which
10711 consists of a letter followed by diacritics. For example, a' is one
10712 sequence of two characters that might be converted into a single
10713 letter.
10714
10715 The input methods for syllabic scripts typically use mapping followed
10716 by conversion. The input methods for Thai and Korean work this way.
10717 First, letters are mapped into symbols for particular sounds or tone
10718 marks; then, sequences of these which make up a whole syllable are
10719 mapped into one syllable sign--most often a "composite character".
10720
10721 None of these methods works very well for Chinese and Japanese, so
10722 they are handled specially. First you input a whole word using
10723 phonetic spelling; then, after the word is in the buffer, Emacs
10724 converts it into one or more characters using a large dictionary.
10725
10726 Since there is more than one way to represent a phonetically spelled
10727 word using Chinese characters, Emacs can only guess which one to use;
10728 typically these input methods give you a way to say "guess again" if
10729 the first guess is wrong.
10730
10731 *** The command C-x RET m (toggle-enable-multibyte-characters)
10732 turns multibyte character support on or off for the current buffer.
10733
10734 If multibyte character support is turned off in a buffer, then each
10735 byte is a single character, even codes 0200 through 0377--exactly as
10736 they did in Emacs 19.34. This includes the features for support for
10737 the European characters, ISO Latin-1 and ISO Latin-2.
10738
10739 However, there is no need to turn off multibyte character support to
10740 use ISO Latin-1 or ISO Latin-2; the Emacs multibyte character set
10741 includes all the characters in these character sets, and Emacs can
10742 translate automatically to and from either one.
10743
10744 *** Visiting a file in unibyte mode.
10745
10746 Turning off multibyte character support in the buffer after visiting a
10747 file with multibyte code conversion will display the multibyte
10748 sequences already in the buffer, byte by byte. This is probably not
10749 what you want.
10750
10751 If you want to edit a file of unibyte characters (Latin-1, for
10752 example), you can do it by specifying `no-conversion' as the coding
10753 system when reading the file. This coding system also turns off
10754 multibyte characters in that buffer.
10755
10756 If you turn off multibyte character support entirely, this turns off
10757 character conversion as well.
10758
10759 *** Displaying international characters on X Windows.
10760
10761 A font for X typically displays just one alphabet or script.
10762 Therefore, displaying the entire range of characters Emacs supports
10763 requires using many fonts.
10764
10765 Therefore, Emacs now supports "fontsets". Each fontset is a
10766 collection of fonts, each assigned to a range of character codes.
10767
10768 A fontset has a name, like a font. Individual fonts are defined by
10769 the X server; fontsets are defined within Emacs itself. But once you
10770 have defined a fontset, you can use it in a face or a frame just as
10771 you would use a font.
10772
10773 If a fontset specifies no font for a certain character, or if it
10774 specifies a font that does not exist on your system, then it cannot
10775 display that character. It will display an empty box instead.
10776
10777 The fontset height and width are determined by the ASCII characters
10778 (that is, by the font in the fontset which is used for ASCII
10779 characters).
10780
10781 *** Defining fontsets.
10782
10783 Emacs does not use any fontset by default. Its default font is still
10784 chosen as in previous versions. You can tell Emacs to use a fontset
10785 with the `-fn' option or the `Font' X resource.
10786
10787 Emacs creates a standard fontset automatically according to the value
10788 of standard-fontset-spec. This fontset's short name is
10789 `fontset-standard'. Bold, italic, and bold-italic variants of the
10790 standard fontset are created automatically.
10791
10792 If you specify a default ASCII font with the `Font' resource or `-fn'
10793 argument, a fontset is generated from it. This works by replacing the
10794 FOUNDARY, FAMILY, ADD_STYLE, and AVERAGE_WIDTH fields of the font name
10795 with `*' then using this to specify a fontset. This fontset's short
10796 name is `fontset-startup'.
10797
10798 Emacs checks resources of the form Fontset-N where N is 0, 1, 2...
10799 The resource value should have this form:
10800 FONTSET-NAME, [CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME]...
10801 FONTSET-NAME should have the form of a standard X font name, except:
10802 * most fields should be just the wild card "*".
10803 * the CHARSET_REGISTRY field should be "fontset"
10804 * the CHARSET_ENCODING field can be any nickname of the fontset.
10805 The construct CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME can be repeated any number
10806 of times; each time specifies the font for one character set.
10807 CHARSET-NAME should be the name of a character set, and FONT-NAME
10808 should specify an actual font to use for that character set.
10809
10810 Each of these fontsets has an alias which is made from the
10811 last two font name fields, CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING.
10812 You can refer to the fontset by that alias or by its full name.
10813
10814 For any character sets that you don't mention, Emacs tries to choose a
10815 font by substituting into FONTSET-NAME. For instance, with the
10816 following resource,
10817 Emacs*Fontset-0: -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-*-*-*-*-fontset-24
10818 the font for ASCII is generated as below:
10819 -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-ISO8859-1
10820 Here is the substitution rule:
10821 Change CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING to that of the charset
10822 defined in the variable x-charset-registries. For instance, ASCII has
10823 the entry (ascii . "ISO8859-1") in this variable. Then, reduce
10824 sequences of wild cards -*-...-*- with a single wildcard -*-.
10825 (This is to prevent use of auto-scaled fonts.)
10826
10827 The function which processes the fontset resource value to create the
10828 fontset is called create-fontset-from-fontset-spec. You can also call
10829 that function explicitly to create a fontset.
10830
10831 With the X resource Emacs.Font, you can specify a fontset name just
10832 like an actual font name. But be careful not to specify a fontset
10833 name in a wildcard resource like Emacs*Font--that tries to specify the
10834 fontset for other purposes including menus, and they cannot handle
10835 fontsets.
10836
10837 *** The command M-x set-language-environment sets certain global Emacs
10838 defaults for a particular choice of language.
10839
10840 Selecting a language environment typically specifies a default input
10841 method and which coding systems to recognize automatically when
10842 visiting files. However, it does not try to reread files you have
10843 already visited; the text in those buffers is not affected. The
10844 language environment may also specify a default choice of coding
10845 system for new files that you create.
10846
10847 It makes no difference which buffer is current when you use
10848 set-language-environment, because these defaults apply globally to the
10849 whole Emacs session.
10850
10851 For example, M-x set-language-environment RET Latin-1 RET
10852 chooses the Latin-1 character set. In the .emacs file, you can do this
10853 with (set-language-environment "Latin-1").
10854
10855 *** The command C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system)
10856 specifies the file coding system for the current buffer. This
10857 specifies what sort of character code translation to do when saving
10858 the file. As an argument, you must specify the name of one of the
10859 coding systems that Emacs supports.
10860
10861 *** The command C-x RET c (universal-coding-system-argument)
10862 lets you specify a coding system when you read or write a file.
10863 This command uses the minibuffer to read a coding system name.
10864 After you exit the minibuffer, the specified coding system
10865 is used for *the immediately following command*.
10866
10867 So if the immediately following command is a command to read or
10868 write a file, it uses the specified coding system for that file.
10869
10870 If the immediately following command does not use the coding system,
10871 then C-x RET c ultimately has no effect.
10872
10873 For example, C-x RET c iso-8859-1 RET C-x C-f temp RET
10874 visits the file `temp' treating it as ISO Latin-1.
10875
10876 *** You can specify the coding system for a file using the -*-
10877 construct. Include `coding: CODINGSYSTEM;' inside the -*-...-*-
10878 to specify use of coding system CODINGSYSTEM. You can also
10879 specify the coding system in a local variable list at the end
10880 of the file.
10881
10882 *** The command C-x RET t (set-terminal-coding-system) specifies
10883 the coding system for terminal output. If you specify a character
10884 code for terminal output, all characters output to the terminal are
10885 translated into that character code.
10886
10887 This feature is useful for certain character-only terminals built in
10888 various countries to support the languages of those countries.
10889
10890 By default, output to the terminal is not translated at all.
10891
10892 *** The command C-x RET k (set-keyboard-coding-system) specifies
10893 the coding system for keyboard input.
10894
10895 Character code translation of keyboard input is useful for terminals
10896 with keys that send non-ASCII graphic characters--for example,
10897 some terminals designed for ISO Latin-1 or subsets of it.
10898
10899 By default, keyboard input is not translated at all.
10900
10901 Character code translation of keyboard input is similar to using an
10902 input method, in that both define sequences of keyboard input that
10903 translate into single characters. However, input methods are designed
10904 to be convenient for interactive use, while the code translations are
10905 designed to work with terminals.
10906
10907 *** The command C-x RET p (set-buffer-process-coding-system)
10908 specifies the coding system for input and output to a subprocess.
10909 This command applies to the current buffer; normally, each subprocess
10910 has its own buffer, and thus you can use this command to specify
10911 translation to and from a particular subprocess by giving the command
10912 in the corresponding buffer.
10913
10914 By default, process input and output are not translated at all.
10915
10916 *** The variable file-name-coding-system specifies the coding system
10917 to use for encoding file names before operating on them.
10918 It is also used for decoding file names obtained from the system.
10919
10920 *** The command C-\ (toggle-input-method) activates or deactivates
10921 an input method. If no input method has been selected before, the
10922 command prompts for you to specify the language and input method you
10923 want to use.
10924
10925 C-u C-\ (select-input-method) lets you switch to a different input
10926 method. C-h C-\ (or C-h I) describes the current input method.
10927
10928 *** Some input methods remap the keyboard to emulate various keyboard
10929 layouts commonly used for particular scripts. How to do this
10930 remapping properly depends on your actual keyboard layout. To specify
10931 which layout your keyboard has, use M-x quail-set-keyboard-layout.
10932
10933 *** The command C-h C (describe-coding-system) displays
10934 the coding systems currently selected for various purposes, plus
10935 related information.
10936
10937 *** The command C-h h (view-hello-file) displays a file called
10938 HELLO, which has examples of text in many languages, using various
10939 scripts.
10940
10941 *** The command C-h L (describe-language-support) displays
10942 information about the support for a particular language.
10943 You specify the language as an argument.
10944
10945 *** The mode line now contains a letter or character that identifies
10946 the coding system used in the visited file. It normally follows the
10947 first dash.
10948
10949 A dash indicates the default state of affairs: no code conversion
10950 (except CRLF => newline if appropriate). `=' means no conversion
10951 whatsoever. The ISO 8859 coding systems are represented by digits
10952 1 through 9. Other coding systems are represented by letters:
10953
10954 A alternativnyj (Russian)
10955 B big5 (Chinese)
10956 C cn-gb-2312 (Chinese)
10957 C iso-2022-cn (Chinese)
10958 D in-is13194-devanagari (Indian languages)
10959 E euc-japan (Japanese)
10960 I iso-2022-cjk or iso-2022-ss2 (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
10961 J junet (iso-2022-7) or old-jis (iso-2022-jp-1978-irv) (Japanese)
10962 K euc-korea (Korean)
10963 R koi8 (Russian)
10964 Q tibetan
10965 S shift_jis (Japanese)
10966 T lao
10967 T tis620 (Thai)
10968 V viscii or vscii (Vietnamese)
10969 i iso-2022-lock (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
10970 k iso-2022-kr (Korean)
10971 v viqr (Vietnamese)
10972 z hz (Chinese)
10973
10974 When you are using a character-only terminal (not a window system),
10975 two additional characters appear in between the dash and the file
10976 coding system. These two characters describe the coding system for
10977 keyboard input, and the coding system for terminal output.
10978
10979 *** The new variable rmail-file-coding-system specifies the code
10980 conversion to use for RMAIL files. The default value is nil.
10981
10982 When you read mail with Rmail, each message is decoded automatically
10983 into Emacs' internal format. This has nothing to do with
10984 rmail-file-coding-system. That variable controls reading and writing
10985 Rmail files themselves.
10986
10987 *** The new variable sendmail-coding-system specifies the code
10988 conversion for outgoing mail. The default value is nil.
10989
10990 Actually, there are three different ways of specifying the coding system
10991 for sending mail:
10992
10993 - If you use C-x RET f in the mail buffer, that takes priority.
10994 - Otherwise, if you set sendmail-coding-system non-nil, that specifies it.
10995 - Otherwise, the default coding system for new files is used,
10996 if that is non-nil. That comes from your language environment.
10997 - Otherwise, Latin-1 is used.
10998
10999 *** The command C-h t (help-with-tutorial) accepts a prefix argument
11000 to specify the language for the tutorial file. Currently, English,
11001 Japanese, Korean and Thai are supported. We welcome additional
11002 translations.
11003
11004 ** An easy new way to visit a file with no code or format conversion
11005 of any kind: Use M-x find-file-literally. There is also a command
11006 insert-file-literally which inserts a file into the current buffer
11007 without any conversion.
11008
11009 ** C-q's handling of octal character codes is changed.
11010 You can now specify any number of octal digits.
11011 RET terminates the digits and is discarded;
11012 any other non-digit terminates the digits and is then used as input.
11013
11014 ** There are new commands for looking up Info documentation for
11015 functions, variables and file names used in your programs.
11016
11017 Type M-x info-lookup-symbol to look up a symbol in the buffer at point.
11018 Type M-x info-lookup-file to look up a file in the buffer at point.
11019
11020 Precisely which Info files are used to look it up depends on the major
11021 mode. For example, in C mode, the GNU libc manual is used.
11022
11023 ** M-TAB in most programming language modes now runs the command
11024 complete-symbol. This command performs completion on the symbol name
11025 in the buffer before point.
11026
11027 With a numeric argument, it performs completion based on the set of
11028 symbols documented in the Info files for the programming language that
11029 you are using.
11030
11031 With no argument, it does completion based on the current tags tables,
11032 just like the old binding of M-TAB (complete-tag).
11033
11034 ** File locking works with NFS now.
11035
11036 The lock file for FILENAME is now a symbolic link named .#FILENAME,
11037 in the same directory as FILENAME.
11038
11039 This means that collision detection between two different machines now
11040 works reasonably well; it also means that no file server or directory
11041 can become a bottleneck.
11042
11043 The new method does have drawbacks. It means that collision detection
11044 does not operate when you edit a file in a directory where you cannot
11045 create new files. Collision detection also doesn't operate when the
11046 file server does not support symbolic links. But these conditions are
11047 rare, and the ability to have collision detection while using NFS is
11048 so useful that the change is worth while.
11049
11050 When Emacs or a system crashes, this may leave behind lock files which
11051 are stale. So you may occasionally get warnings about spurious
11052 collisions. When you determine that the collision is spurious, just
11053 tell Emacs to go ahead anyway.
11054
11055 ** If you wish to use Show Paren mode to display matching parentheses,
11056 it is no longer sufficient to load paren.el. Instead you must call
11057 show-paren-mode.
11058
11059 ** If you wish to use Delete Selection mode to replace a highlighted
11060 selection when you insert new text, it is no longer sufficient to load
11061 delsel.el. Instead you must call the function delete-selection-mode.
11062
11063 ** If you wish to use Partial Completion mode to complete partial words
11064 within symbols or filenames, it is no longer sufficient to load
11065 complete.el. Instead you must call the function partial-completion-mode.
11066
11067 ** If you wish to use uniquify to rename buffers for you,
11068 it is no longer sufficient to load uniquify.el. You must also
11069 set uniquify-buffer-name-style to one of the non-nil legitimate values.
11070
11071 ** Changes in View mode.
11072
11073 *** Several new commands are available in View mode.
11074 Do H in view mode for a list of commands.
11075
11076 *** There are two new commands for entering View mode:
11077 view-file-other-frame and view-buffer-other-frame.
11078
11079 *** Exiting View mode does a better job of restoring windows to their
11080 previous state.
11081
11082 *** New customization variable view-scroll-auto-exit. If non-nil,
11083 scrolling past end of buffer makes view mode exit.
11084
11085 *** New customization variable view-exits-all-viewing-windows. If
11086 non-nil, view-mode will at exit restore all windows viewing buffer,
11087 not just the selected window.
11088
11089 *** New customization variable view-read-only. If non-nil, visiting a
11090 read-only file automatically enters View mode, and toggle-read-only
11091 turns View mode on or off.
11092
11093 *** New customization variable view-remove-frame-by-deleting controls
11094 how to remove a not needed frame at view mode exit. If non-nil,
11095 delete the frame, if nil make an icon of it.
11096
11097 ** C-x v l, the command to print a file's version control log,
11098 now positions point at the entry for the file's current branch version.
11099
11100 ** C-x v =, the command to compare a file with the last checked-in version,
11101 has a new feature. If the file is currently not locked, so that it is
11102 presumably identical to the last checked-in version, the command now asks
11103 which version to compare with.
11104
11105 ** When using hideshow.el, incremental search can temporarily show hidden
11106 blocks if a match is inside the block.
11107
11108 The block is hidden again if the search is continued and the next match
11109 is outside the block. By customizing the variable
11110 isearch-hide-immediately you can choose to hide all the temporarily
11111 shown blocks only when exiting from incremental search.
11112
11113 By customizing the variable hs-isearch-open you can choose what kind
11114 of blocks to temporarily show during isearch: comment blocks, code
11115 blocks, all of them or none.
11116
11117 ** The new command C-x 4 0 (kill-buffer-and-window) kills the
11118 current buffer and deletes the selected window. It asks for
11119 confirmation first.
11120
11121 ** C-x C-w, which saves the buffer into a specified file name,
11122 now changes the major mode according to that file name.
11123 However, the mode will not be changed if
11124 (1) a local variables list or the `-*-' line specifies a major mode, or
11125 (2) the current major mode is a "special" mode,
11126 not suitable for ordinary files, or
11127 (3) the new file name does not particularly specify any mode.
11128
11129 This applies to M-x set-visited-file-name as well.
11130
11131 However, if you set change-major-mode-with-file-name to nil, then
11132 these commands do not change the major mode.
11133
11134 ** M-x occur changes.
11135
11136 *** If the argument to M-x occur contains upper case letters,
11137 it performs a case-sensitive search.
11138
11139 *** In the *Occur* buffer made by M-x occur,
11140 if you type g or M-x revert-buffer, this repeats the search
11141 using the same regular expression and the same buffer as before.
11142
11143 ** In Transient Mark mode, the region in any one buffer is highlighted
11144 in just one window at a time. At first, it is highlighted in the
11145 window where you set the mark. The buffer's highlighting remains in
11146 that window unless you select to another window which shows the same
11147 buffer--then the highlighting moves to that window.
11148
11149 ** The feature to suggest key bindings when you use M-x now operates
11150 after the command finishes. The message suggesting key bindings
11151 appears temporarily in the echo area. The previous echo area contents
11152 come back after a few seconds, in case they contain useful information.
11153
11154 ** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
11155 selected buffers, so that the default for C-x b is now based on the
11156 buffers recently selected in the selected frame.
11157
11158 ** Outline mode changes.
11159
11160 *** Outline mode now uses overlays (this is the former noutline.el).
11161
11162 *** Incremental searches skip over invisible text in Outline mode.
11163
11164 ** When a minibuffer window is active but not the selected window, if
11165 you try to use the minibuffer, you used to get a nested minibuffer.
11166 Now, this not only gives an error, it also cancels the minibuffer that
11167 was already active.
11168
11169 The motive for this change is so that beginning users do not
11170 unknowingly move away from minibuffers, leaving them active, and then
11171 get confused by it.
11172
11173 If you want to be able to have recursive minibuffers, you must
11174 set enable-recursive-minibuffers to non-nil.
11175
11176 ** Changes in dynamic abbrevs.
11177
11178 *** Expanding dynamic abbrevs with M-/ is now smarter about case
11179 conversion. If the expansion has mixed case not counting the first
11180 character, and the abbreviation matches the beginning of the expansion
11181 including case, then the expansion is copied verbatim.
11182
11183 The expansion is also copied verbatim if the abbreviation itself has
11184 mixed case. And using SPC M-/ to copy an additional word always
11185 copies it verbatim except when the previous copied word is all caps.
11186
11187 *** The values of `dabbrev-case-replace' and `dabbrev-case-fold-search'
11188 are no longer Lisp expressions. They have simply three possible
11189 values.
11190
11191 `dabbrev-case-replace' has these three values: nil (don't preserve
11192 case), t (do), or `case-replace' (do like M-x query-replace).
11193 `dabbrev-case-fold-search' has these three values: nil (don't ignore
11194 case), t (do), or `case-fold-search' (do like search).
11195
11196 ** Minibuffer history lists are truncated automatically now to a
11197 certain length. The variable history-length specifies how long they
11198 can be. The default value is 30.
11199
11200 ** Changes in Mail mode.
11201
11202 *** The key C-x m no longer runs the `mail' command directly.
11203 Instead, it runs the command `compose-mail', which invokes the mail
11204 composition mechanism you have selected with the variable
11205 `mail-user-agent'. The default choice of user agent is
11206 `sendmail-user-agent', which gives behavior compatible with the old
11207 behavior.
11208
11209 C-x 4 m now runs compose-mail-other-window, and C-x 5 m runs
11210 compose-mail-other-frame.
11211
11212 *** While composing a reply to a mail message, from Rmail, you can use
11213 the command C-c C-r to cite just the region from the message you are
11214 replying to. This copies the text which is the selected region in the
11215 buffer that shows the original message.
11216
11217 *** The command C-c C-i inserts a file at the end of the message,
11218 with separator lines around the contents.
11219
11220 *** The command M-x expand-mail-aliases expands all mail aliases
11221 in suitable mail headers. Emacs automatically extracts mail alias
11222 definitions from your mail alias file (e.g., ~/.mailrc). You do not
11223 need to expand mail aliases yourself before sending mail.
11224
11225 *** New features in the mail-complete command.
11226
11227 **** The mail-complete command now inserts the user's full name,
11228 for local users or if that is known. The variable mail-complete-style
11229 controls the style to use, and whether to do this at all.
11230 Its values are like those of mail-from-style.
11231
11232 **** The variable mail-passwd-command lets you specify a shell command
11233 to run to fetch a set of password-entries that add to the ones in
11234 /etc/passwd.
11235
11236 **** The variable mail-passwd-file now specifies a list of files to read
11237 to get the list of user ids. By default, one file is used:
11238 /etc/passwd.
11239
11240 ** You can "quote" a file name to inhibit special significance of
11241 special syntax, by adding `/:' to the beginning. Thus, if you have a
11242 directory named `/foo:', you can prevent it from being treated as a
11243 reference to a remote host named `foo' by writing it as `/:/foo:'.
11244
11245 Emacs uses this new construct automatically when necessary, such as
11246 when you start it with a working directory whose name might otherwise
11247 be taken to be magic.
11248
11249 ** There is a new command M-x grep-find which uses find to select
11250 files to search through, and grep to scan them. The output is
11251 available in a Compile mode buffer, as with M-x grep.
11252
11253 M-x grep now uses the -e option if the grep program supports that.
11254 (-e prevents problems if the search pattern starts with a dash.)
11255
11256 ** In Dired, the & command now flags for deletion the files whose names
11257 suggest they are probably not needed in the long run.
11258
11259 In Dired, * is now a prefix key for mark-related commands.
11260
11261 new key dired.el binding old key
11262 ------- ---------------- -------
11263 * c dired-change-marks c
11264 * m dired-mark m
11265 * * dired-mark-executables * (binding deleted)
11266 * / dired-mark-directories / (binding deleted)
11267 * @ dired-mark-symlinks @ (binding deleted)
11268 * u dired-unmark u
11269 * DEL dired-unmark-backward DEL
11270 * ? dired-unmark-all-files C-M-?
11271 * ! dired-unmark-all-marks
11272 * % dired-mark-files-regexp % m
11273 * C-n dired-next-marked-file M-}
11274 * C-p dired-prev-marked-file M-{
11275
11276 ** Rmail changes.
11277
11278 *** When Rmail cannot convert your incoming mail into Babyl format, it
11279 saves the new mail in the file RMAILOSE.n, where n is an integer
11280 chosen to make a unique name. This way, Rmail will not keep crashing
11281 each time you run it.
11282
11283 *** In Rmail, the variable rmail-summary-line-count-flag now controls
11284 whether to include the line count in the summary. Non-nil means yes.
11285
11286 *** In Rmail summary buffers, d and C-d (the commands to delete
11287 messages) now take repeat counts as arguments. A negative argument
11288 means to move in the opposite direction.
11289
11290 *** In Rmail, the t command now takes an optional argument which lets
11291 you specify whether to show the message headers in full or pruned.
11292
11293 *** In Rmail, the new command w (rmail-output-body-to-file) writes
11294 just the body of the current message into a file, without the headers.
11295 It takes the file name from the message subject, by default, but you
11296 can edit that file name in the minibuffer before it is actually used
11297 for output.
11298
11299 ** Gnus changes.
11300
11301 *** nntp.el has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
11302
11303 *** Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
11304 Gnus.
11305
11306 *** Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like
11307 `and', `or', `not', and parent redirection.
11308
11309 *** Article washing status can be displayed in the
11310 article mode line.
11311
11312 *** gnus.el has been split into many smaller files.
11313
11314 *** Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID.
11315
11316 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
11317
11318 *** New variables for specifying what score and adapt files
11319 are to be considered home score and adapt files. See
11320 `gnus-home-score-file' and `gnus-home-adapt-files'.
11321
11322 *** Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics.
11323
11324 *** Article editing has been revamped and is now usable.
11325
11326 *** Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions.
11327 See `gnus-signature-separator' and `gnus-signature-limit'.
11328
11329 *** Summary pick mode has been made to look more nn-like.
11330 Line numbers are displayed and the `.' command can be
11331 used to pick articles.
11332
11333 *** Commands for moving the .newsrc.eld from one server to
11334 another have been added.
11335
11336 `M-x gnus-change-server'
11337
11338 *** A way to specify that "uninteresting" fields be suppressed when
11339 generating lines in buffers.
11340
11341 *** Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with
11342 `C-M-_'.
11343
11344 *** Scoring can be done on words using the new score type `w'.
11345
11346 *** Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis:
11347
11348 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
11349
11350 *** Scores can be decayed.
11351
11352 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
11353
11354 *** Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The
11355 Date is normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first.
11356
11357 *** A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
11358 the native server.
11359
11360 `M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups'
11361
11362 *** A new command for reading collections of documents
11363 (nndoc with nnvirtual on top) has been added -- `C-M-d'.
11364
11365 *** Process mark sets can be pushed and popped.
11366
11367 *** A new mail-to-news backend makes it possible to post
11368 even when the NNTP server doesn't allow posting.
11369
11370 *** A new backend for reading searches from Web search engines
11371 (DejaNews, Alta Vista, InReference) has been added.
11372
11373 Use the `G w' command in the group buffer to create such
11374 a group.
11375
11376 *** Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard
11377 sorting functions, and each topic can be sorted independently.
11378
11379 See the commands under the `T S' submap.
11380
11381 *** Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently.
11382
11383 See the commands under the `G P' submap.
11384
11385 *** Cached articles can be pulled into the groups.
11386
11387 Use the `Y c' command.
11388
11389 *** Score files are now applied in a more reliable order.
11390
11391 *** Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated.
11392
11393 `M-x nnmail-split-history'
11394
11395 *** More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk
11396 from incoming mail before saving the mail.
11397
11398 See `nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook'.
11399
11400 *** The nnml mail backend now understands compressed article files.
11401
11402 *** To enable Gnus to read/post multi-lingual articles, you must execute
11403 the following code, for instance, in your .emacs.
11404
11405 (add-hook 'gnus-startup-hook 'gnus-mule-initialize)
11406
11407 Then, when you start Gnus, it will decode non-ASCII text automatically
11408 and show appropriate characters. (Note: if you are using gnus-mime
11409 from the SEMI package, formerly known as TM, you should NOT add this
11410 hook to gnus-startup-hook; gnus-mime has its own method of handling
11411 this issue.)
11412
11413 Since it is impossible to distinguish all coding systems
11414 automatically, you may need to specify a choice of coding system for a
11415 particular news group. This can be done by:
11416
11417 (gnus-mule-add-group NEWSGROUP 'CODING-SYSTEM)
11418
11419 Here NEWSGROUP should be a string which names a newsgroup or a tree
11420 of newsgroups. If NEWSGROUP is "XXX.YYY", all news groups under
11421 "XXX.YYY" (including "XXX.YYY.ZZZ") will use the specified coding
11422 system. CODING-SYSTEM specifies which coding system to use (for both
11423 for reading and posting).
11424
11425 CODING-SYSTEM can also be a cons cell of the form
11426 (READ-CODING-SYSTEM . POST-CODING-SYSTEM)
11427 Then READ-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you read messages from the
11428 newsgroups, while POST-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you post messages
11429 there.
11430
11431 Emacs knows the right coding systems for certain newsgroups by
11432 default. Here are some of these default settings:
11433
11434 (gnus-mule-add-group "fj" 'iso-2022-7)
11435 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text" 'hz-gb-2312)
11436 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.hk" 'hz-gb-2312)
11437 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text.big5" 'cn-big5)
11438 (gnus-mule-add-group "soc.culture.vietnamese" '(nil . viqr))
11439
11440 When you reply by mail to an article, these settings are ignored;
11441 the mail is encoded according to sendmail-coding-system, as usual.
11442
11443 ** CC mode changes.
11444
11445 *** If you edit primarily one style of C (or C++, Objective-C, Java)
11446 code, you may want to make the CC Mode style variables have global
11447 values so that you can set them directly in your .emacs file. To do
11448 this, set c-style-variables-are-local-p to nil in your .emacs file.
11449 Note that this only takes effect if you do it *before* cc-mode.el is
11450 loaded.
11451
11452 If you typically edit more than one style of C (or C++, Objective-C,
11453 Java) code in a single Emacs session, you may want to make the CC Mode
11454 style variables have buffer local values. By default, all buffers
11455 share the same style variable settings; to make them buffer local, set
11456 c-style-variables-are-local-p to t in your .emacs file. Note that you
11457 must do this *before* CC Mode is loaded.
11458
11459 *** The new variable c-indentation-style holds the C style name
11460 of the current buffer.
11461
11462 *** The variable c-block-comments-indent-p has been deleted, because
11463 it is no longer necessary. C mode now handles all the supported styles
11464 of block comments, with no need to say which one you will use.
11465
11466 *** There is a new indentation style "python", which specifies the C
11467 style that the Python developers like.
11468
11469 *** There is a new c-cleanup-list option: brace-elseif-brace.
11470 This says to put ...} else if (...) {... on one line,
11471 just as brace-else-brace says to put ...} else {... on one line.
11472
11473 ** VC Changes [new]
11474
11475 *** In vc-retrieve-snapshot (C-x v r), if you don't specify a snapshot
11476 name, it retrieves the *latest* versions of all files in the current
11477 directory and its subdirectories (aside from files already locked).
11478
11479 This feature is useful if your RCS directory is a link to a common
11480 master directory, and you want to pick up changes made by other
11481 developers.
11482
11483 You can do the same thing for an individual file by typing C-u C-x C-q
11484 RET in a buffer visiting that file.
11485
11486 *** VC can now handle files under CVS that are being "watched" by
11487 other developers. Such files are made read-only by CVS. To get a
11488 writable copy, type C-x C-q in a buffer visiting such a file. VC then
11489 calls "cvs edit", which notifies the other developers of it.
11490
11491 *** vc-version-diff (C-u C-x v =) now suggests reasonable defaults for
11492 version numbers, based on the current state of the file.
11493
11494 ** Calendar changes.
11495
11496 *** A new function, list-holidays, allows you list holidays or
11497 subclasses of holidays for ranges of years. Related menu items allow
11498 you do this for the year of the selected date, or the
11499 following/previous years.
11500
11501 *** There is now support for the Baha'i calendar system. Use `pb' in
11502 the *Calendar* buffer to display the current Baha'i date. The Baha'i
11503 calendar, or "Badi calendar" is a system of 19 months with 19 days
11504 each, and 4 intercalary days (5 during a Gregorian leap year). The
11505 calendar begins May 23, 1844, with each of the months named after a
11506 supposed attribute of God.
11507
11508 ** ps-print changes
11509
11510 There are some new user variables and subgroups for customizing the page
11511 layout.
11512
11513 *** Headers & Footers (subgroup)
11514
11515 Some printer systems print a header page and force the first page to
11516 be printed on the back of the header page when using duplex. If your
11517 printer system has this behavior, set variable
11518 `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' to t.
11519
11520 If variable `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' is non-nil, it prints a
11521 blank page as the very first printed page. So, it behaves as if the
11522 very first character of buffer (or region) were a form feed ^L (\014).
11523
11524 The variable `ps-spool-config' specifies who is responsible for
11525 setting duplex mode and page size. Valid values are:
11526
11527 lpr-switches duplex and page size are configured by `ps-lpr-switches'.
11528 Don't forget to set `ps-lpr-switches' to select duplex
11529 printing for your printer.
11530
11531 setpagedevice duplex and page size are configured by ps-print using the
11532 setpagedevice PostScript operator.
11533
11534 nil duplex and page size are configured by ps-print *not* using
11535 the setpagedevice PostScript operator.
11536
11537 The variable `ps-spool-tumble' specifies how the page images on
11538 opposite sides of a sheet are oriented with respect to each other. If
11539 `ps-spool-tumble' is nil, ps-print produces output suitable for
11540 bindings on the left or right. If `ps-spool-tumble' is non-nil,
11541 ps-print produces output suitable for bindings at the top or bottom.
11542 This variable takes effect only if `ps-spool-duplex' is non-nil.
11543 The default value is nil.
11544
11545 The variable `ps-header-frame-alist' specifies a header frame
11546 properties alist. Valid frame properties are:
11547
11548 fore-color Specify the foreground frame color.
11549 Value should be a float number between 0.0 (black
11550 color) and 1.0 (white color), or a string which is a
11551 color name, or a list of 3 float numbers which
11552 correspond to the Red Green Blue color scale, each
11553 float number between 0.0 (dark color) and 1.0 (bright
11554 color). The default is 0 ("black").
11555
11556 back-color Specify the background frame color (similar to fore-color).
11557 The default is 0.9 ("gray90").
11558
11559 shadow-color Specify the shadow color (similar to fore-color).
11560 The default is 0 ("black").
11561
11562 border-color Specify the border color (similar to fore-color).
11563 The default is 0 ("black").
11564
11565 border-width Specify the border width.
11566 The default is 0.4.
11567
11568 Any other property is ignored.
11569
11570 Don't change this alist directly; instead use Custom, or the
11571 `ps-value', `ps-get', `ps-put' and `ps-del' functions (see there for
11572 documentation).
11573
11574 Ps-print can also print footers. The footer variables are:
11575 `ps-print-footer', `ps-footer-offset', `ps-print-footer-frame',
11576 `ps-footer-font-family', `ps-footer-font-size', `ps-footer-line-pad',
11577 `ps-footer-lines', `ps-left-footer', `ps-right-footer' and
11578 `ps-footer-frame-alist'. These variables are similar to those
11579 controlling headers.
11580
11581 *** Color management (subgroup)
11582
11583 If `ps-print-color-p' is non-nil, the buffer's text will be printed in
11584 color.
11585
11586 *** Face Management (subgroup)
11587
11588 If you need to print without worrying about face background colors,
11589 set the variable `ps-use-face-background' which specifies if face
11590 background should be used. Valid values are:
11591
11592 t always use face background color.
11593 nil never use face background color.
11594 (face...) list of faces whose background color will be used.
11595
11596 *** N-up printing (subgroup)
11597
11598 The variable `ps-n-up-printing' specifies the number of pages per
11599 sheet of paper.
11600
11601 The variable `ps-n-up-margin' specifies the margin in points (pt)
11602 between the sheet border and the n-up printing.
11603
11604 If variable `ps-n-up-border-p' is non-nil, a border is drawn around
11605 each page.
11606
11607 The variable `ps-n-up-filling' specifies how the page matrix is filled
11608 on each sheet of paper. Following are the valid values for
11609 `ps-n-up-filling' with a filling example using a 3x4 page matrix:
11610
11611 `left-top' 1 2 3 4 `left-bottom' 9 10 11 12
11612 5 6 7 8 5 6 7 8
11613 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
11614
11615 `right-top' 4 3 2 1 `right-bottom' 12 11 10 9
11616 8 7 6 5 8 7 6 5
11617 12 11 10 9 4 3 2 1
11618
11619 `top-left' 1 4 7 10 `bottom-left' 3 6 9 12
11620 2 5 8 11 2 5 8 11
11621 3 6 9 12 1 4 7 10
11622
11623 `top-right' 10 7 4 1 `bottom-right' 12 9 6 3
11624 11 8 5 2 11 8 5 2
11625 12 9 6 3 10 7 4 1
11626
11627 Any other value is treated as `left-top'.
11628
11629 *** Zebra stripes (subgroup)
11630
11631 The variable `ps-zebra-color' controls the zebra stripes grayscale or
11632 RGB color.
11633
11634 The variable `ps-zebra-stripe-follow' specifies how zebra stripes
11635 continue on next page. Visually, valid values are (the character `+'
11636 to the right of each column indicates that a line is printed):
11637
11638 `nil' `follow' `full' `full-follow'
11639 Current Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
11640 1 XXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXX + 1 XXXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11641 2 XXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXX + 2 XXXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11642 3 XXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXX + 3 XXXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11643 4 + 4 + 4 + 4 +
11644 5 + 5 + 5 + 5 +
11645 6 + 6 + 6 + 6 +
11646 7 XXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXX + 7 XXXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11647 8 XXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXX + 8 XXXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11648 9 XXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXX + 9 XXXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11649 10 + 10 +
11650 11 + 11 +
11651 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
11652 Next Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
11653 12 XXXXX + 12 + 10 XXXXXX + 10 +
11654 13 XXXXX + 13 XXXXXXXX + 11 XXXXXX + 11 +
11655 14 XXXXX + 14 XXXXXXXX + 12 XXXXXX + 12 +
11656 15 + 15 XXXXXXXX + 13 + 13 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11657 16 + 16 + 14 + 14 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11658 17 + 17 + 15 + 15 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11659 18 XXXXX + 18 + 16 XXXXXX + 16 +
11660 19 XXXXX + 19 XXXXXXXX + 17 XXXXXX + 17 +
11661 20 XXXXX + 20 XXXXXXXX + 18 XXXXXX + 18 +
11662 21 + 21 XXXXXXXX +
11663 22 + 22 +
11664 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
11665
11666 Any other value is treated as `nil'.
11667
11668
11669 *** Printer management (subgroup)
11670
11671 The variable `ps-printer-name-option' determines the option used by
11672 some utilities to indicate the printer name; it's used only when
11673 `ps-printer-name' is a non-empty string. If you're using the lpr
11674 utility to print, for example, `ps-printer-name-option' should be set
11675 to "-P".
11676
11677 The variable `ps-manual-feed' indicates if the printer requires manual
11678 paper feeding. If it's nil, automatic feeding takes place. If it's
11679 non-nil, manual feeding takes place.
11680
11681 The variable `ps-end-with-control-d' specifies whether C-d (\x04)
11682 should be inserted at end of the generated PostScript. Non-nil means
11683 do so.
11684
11685 *** Page settings (subgroup)
11686
11687 If variable `ps-warn-paper-type' is nil, it's *not* treated as an
11688 error if the PostScript printer doesn't have a paper with the size
11689 indicated by `ps-paper-type'; the default paper size will be used
11690 instead. If `ps-warn-paper-type' is non-nil, an error is signaled if
11691 the PostScript printer doesn't support a paper with the size indicated
11692 by `ps-paper-type'. This is used when `ps-spool-config' is set to
11693 `setpagedevice'.
11694
11695 The variable `ps-print-upside-down' determines the orientation for
11696 printing pages: nil means `normal' printing, non-nil means
11697 `upside-down' printing (that is, the page is rotated by 180 degrees).
11698
11699 The variable `ps-selected-pages' specifies which pages to print. If
11700 it's nil, all pages are printed. If it's a list, list elements may be
11701 integers specifying a single page to print, or cons cells (FROM . TO)
11702 specifying to print from page FROM to TO. Invalid list elements, that
11703 is integers smaller than one, or elements whose FROM is greater than
11704 its TO, are ignored.
11705
11706 The variable `ps-even-or-odd-pages' specifies how to print even/odd
11707 pages. Valid values are:
11708
11709 nil print all pages.
11710
11711 `even-page' print only even pages.
11712
11713 `odd-page' print only odd pages.
11714
11715 `even-sheet' print only even sheets.
11716 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
11717 `even-page', but for values greater than 1, it'll
11718 print only the even sheet of paper.
11719
11720 `odd-sheet' print only odd sheets.
11721 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
11722 `odd-page'; but for values greater than 1, it'll print
11723 only the odd sheet of paper.
11724
11725 Any other value is treated as nil.
11726
11727 If you set `ps-selected-pages' (see there for documentation), pages
11728 are filtered by `ps-selected-pages', and then by
11729 `ps-even-or-odd-pages'. For example, if we have:
11730
11731 (setq ps-selected-pages '(1 4 (6 . 10) (12 . 16) 20))
11732
11733 and we combine this with `ps-even-or-odd-pages' and
11734 `ps-n-up-printing', we get:
11735
11736 `ps-n-up-printing' = 1:
11737 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
11738 nil 1, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 20
11739 even-page 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
11740 odd-page 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
11741 even-sheet 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
11742 odd-sheet 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
11743
11744 `ps-n-up-printing' = 2:
11745 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
11746 nil 1/4, 6/7, 8/9, 10/12, 13/14, 15/16, 20
11747 even-page 4/6, 8/10, 12/14, 16/20
11748 odd-page 1/7, 9/13, 15
11749 even-sheet 6/7, 10/12, 15/16
11750 odd-sheet 1/4, 8/9, 13/14, 20
11751
11752 *** Miscellany (subgroup)
11753
11754 The variable `ps-error-handler-message' specifies where error handler
11755 messages should be sent.
11756
11757 It is also possible to add a user-defined PostScript prologue code in
11758 front of all generated prologue code by setting the variable
11759 `ps-user-defined-prologue'.
11760
11761 The variable `ps-line-number-font' specifies the font for line numbers.
11762
11763 The variable `ps-line-number-font-size' specifies the font size in
11764 points for line numbers.
11765
11766 The variable `ps-line-number-color' specifies the color for line
11767 numbers. See `ps-zebra-color' for documentation.
11768
11769 The variable `ps-line-number-step' specifies the interval in which
11770 line numbers are printed. For example, if `ps-line-number-step' is set
11771 to 2, the printing will look like:
11772
11773 1 one line
11774 one line
11775 3 one line
11776 one line
11777 5 one line
11778 one line
11779 ...
11780
11781 Valid values are:
11782
11783 integer an integer specifying the interval in which line numbers are
11784 printed. If it's smaller than or equal to zero, 1
11785 is used.
11786
11787 `zebra' specifies that only the line number of the first line in a
11788 zebra stripe is to be printed.
11789
11790 Any other value is treated as `zebra'.
11791
11792 The variable `ps-line-number-start' specifies the starting point in
11793 the interval given by `ps-line-number-step'. For example, if
11794 `ps-line-number-step' is set to 3, and `ps-line-number-start' is set to
11795 3, the output will look like:
11796
11797 one line
11798 one line
11799 3 one line
11800 one line
11801 one line
11802 6 one line
11803 one line
11804 one line
11805 9 one line
11806 one line
11807 ...
11808
11809 The variable `ps-postscript-code-directory' specifies the directory
11810 where the PostScript prologue file used by ps-print is found.
11811
11812 The variable `ps-line-spacing' determines the line spacing in points,
11813 for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
11814 `ps-font-size').
11815
11816 The variable `ps-paragraph-spacing' determines the paragraph spacing,
11817 in points, for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
11818 `ps-font-size').
11819
11820 The variable `ps-paragraph-regexp' specifies the paragraph delimiter.
11821
11822 The variable `ps-begin-cut-regexp' and `ps-end-cut-regexp' specify the
11823 start and end of a region to cut out when printing.
11824
11825 ** hideshow changes.
11826
11827 *** now supports hiding of blocks of single line comments (like // for
11828 C++, ; for lisp).
11829
11830 *** Support for java-mode added.
11831
11832 *** When doing `hs-hide-all' it is now possible to also hide the comments
11833 in the file if `hs-hide-comments-when-hiding-all' is set.
11834
11835 *** The new function `hs-hide-initial-comment' hides the comments at
11836 the beginning of the files. Finally those huge RCS logs don't stay in your
11837 way! This is run by default when entering the `hs-minor-mode'.
11838
11839 *** Now uses overlays instead of `selective-display', so is more
11840 robust and a lot faster.
11841
11842 *** A block beginning can span multiple lines.
11843
11844 *** The new variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' if t, directs hideshow
11845 to show only the beginning of a block when it is hidden. See the
11846 documentation for more details.
11847
11848 ** Changes in Enriched mode.
11849
11850 *** When you visit a file in enriched-mode, Emacs will make sure it is
11851 filled to the current fill-column. This behavior is now independent
11852 of the size of the window. When you save the file, the fill-column in
11853 use is stored as well, so that the whole buffer need not be refilled
11854 the next time unless the fill-column is different.
11855
11856 *** use-hard-newlines is now a minor mode. When it is enabled, Emacs
11857 distinguishes between hard and soft newlines, and treats hard newlines
11858 as paragraph boundaries. Otherwise all newlines inserted are marked
11859 as soft, and paragraph boundaries are determined solely from the text.
11860
11861 ** Font Lock mode
11862
11863 *** Custom support
11864
11865 The variables font-lock-face-attributes, font-lock-display-type and
11866 font-lock-background-mode are now obsolete; the recommended way to specify the
11867 faces to use for Font Lock mode is with M-x customize-group on the new custom
11868 group font-lock-highlighting-faces. If you set font-lock-face-attributes in
11869 your ~/.emacs file, Font Lock mode will respect its value. However, you should
11870 consider converting from setting that variable to using M-x customize.
11871
11872 You can still use X resources to specify Font Lock face appearances.
11873
11874 *** Maximum decoration
11875
11876 Fontification now uses the maximum level of decoration supported by
11877 default. Previously, fontification used a mode-specific default level
11878 of decoration, which is typically the minimum level of decoration
11879 supported. You can set font-lock-maximum-decoration to nil
11880 to get the old behavior.
11881
11882 *** New support
11883
11884 Support is now provided for Java, Objective-C, AWK and SIMULA modes.
11885
11886 Note that Font Lock mode can be turned on without knowing exactly what modes
11887 support Font Lock mode, via the command global-font-lock-mode.
11888
11889 *** Configurable support
11890
11891 Support for C, C++, Objective-C and Java can be more easily configured for
11892 additional types and classes via the new variables c-font-lock-extra-types,
11893 c++-font-lock-extra-types, objc-font-lock-extra-types and, you guessed it,
11894 java-font-lock-extra-types. These value of each of these variables should be a
11895 list of regexps matching the extra type names. For example, the default value
11896 of c-font-lock-extra-types is ("\\sw+_t") which means fontification follows the
11897 convention that C type names end in _t. This results in slower fontification.
11898
11899 Of course, you can change the variables that specify fontification in whatever
11900 way you wish, typically by adding regexps. However, these new variables make
11901 it easier to make specific and common changes for the fontification of types.
11902
11903 *** Adding highlighting patterns to existing support
11904
11905 You can use the new function font-lock-add-keywords to add your own
11906 highlighting patterns, such as for project-local or user-specific constructs,
11907 for any mode.
11908
11909 For example, to highlight `FIXME:' words in C comments, put:
11910
11911 (font-lock-add-keywords 'c-mode '(("\\<FIXME:" 0 font-lock-warning-face t)))
11912
11913 in your ~/.emacs.
11914
11915 *** New faces
11916
11917 Font Lock now defines two new faces, font-lock-builtin-face and
11918 font-lock-warning-face. These are intended to highlight builtin keywords,
11919 distinct from a language's normal keywords, and objects that should be brought
11920 to user attention, respectively. Various modes now use these new faces.
11921
11922 *** Changes to fast-lock support mode
11923
11924 The fast-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now process
11925 cache files silently. You can use the new variable fast-lock-verbose, in the
11926 same way as font-lock-verbose, to control this feature.
11927
11928 *** Changes to lazy-lock support mode
11929
11930 The lazy-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now fontify
11931 according to the true syntactic context relative to other lines. You can use
11932 the new variable lazy-lock-defer-contextually to control this feature. If
11933 non-nil, changes to the buffer will cause subsequent lines in the buffer to be
11934 refontified after lazy-lock-defer-time seconds of idle time. If nil, then only
11935 the modified lines will be refontified; this is the same as the previous Lazy
11936 Lock mode behavior and the behavior of Font Lock mode.
11937
11938 This feature is useful in modes where strings or comments can span lines.
11939 For example, if a string or comment terminating character is deleted, then if
11940 this feature is enabled subsequent lines in the buffer will be correctly
11941 refontified to reflect their new syntactic context. Previously, only the line
11942 containing the deleted character would be refontified and you would have to use
11943 the command M-g M-g (font-lock-fontify-block) to refontify some lines.
11944
11945 As a consequence of this new feature, two other variables have changed:
11946
11947 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-driven' is renamed `lazy-lock-defer-on-scrolling'.
11948 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-time' can now only be a time, i.e., a number.
11949 Buffer modes for which on-the-fly deferral applies can be specified via the
11950 new variable `lazy-lock-defer-on-the-fly'.
11951
11952 If you set these variables in your ~/.emacs, then you may have to change those
11953 settings.
11954
11955 ** Ada mode changes.
11956
11957 *** There is now better support for using find-file.el with Ada mode.
11958 If you switch between spec and body, the cursor stays in the same
11959 procedure (modulo overloading). If a spec has no body file yet, but
11960 you try to switch to its body file, Ada mode now generates procedure
11961 stubs.
11962
11963 *** There are two new commands:
11964 - `ada-make-local' : invokes gnatmake on the current buffer
11965 - `ada-check-syntax' : check syntax of current buffer.
11966
11967 The user options `ada-compiler-make', `ada-make-options',
11968 `ada-language-version', `ada-compiler-syntax-check', and
11969 `ada-compile-options' are used within these commands.
11970
11971 *** Ada mode can now work with Outline minor mode. The outline level
11972 is calculated from the indenting, not from syntactic constructs.
11973 Outlining does not work if your code is not correctly indented.
11974
11975 *** The new function `ada-gnat-style' converts the buffer to the style of
11976 formatting used in GNAT. It places two blanks after a comment start,
11977 places one blank between a word end and an opening '(', and puts one
11978 space between a comma and the beginning of a word.
11979
11980 ** Scheme mode changes.
11981
11982 *** Scheme mode indentation now uses many of the facilities of Lisp
11983 mode; therefore, the variables to customize it are the variables used
11984 for Lisp mode which have names starting with `lisp-'. The variables
11985 with names starting with `scheme-' which used to do this no longer
11986 have any effect.
11987
11988 If you want to use different indentation for Scheme and Lisp, this is
11989 still possible, but now you must do it by adding a hook to
11990 scheme-mode-hook, which could work by setting the `lisp-' indentation
11991 variables as buffer-local variables.
11992
11993 *** DSSSL mode is a variant of Scheme mode, for editing DSSSL scripts.
11994 Use M-x dsssl-mode.
11995
11996 ** Changes to the emacsclient program
11997
11998 *** If a socket can't be found, and environment variables LOGNAME or
11999 USER are set, emacsclient now looks for a socket based on the UID
12000 associated with the name. That is an emacsclient running as root
12001 can connect to an Emacs server started by a non-root user.
12002
12003 *** The emacsclient program now accepts an option --no-wait which tells
12004 it to return immediately without waiting for you to "finish" the
12005 buffer in Emacs.
12006
12007 *** The new option --alternate-editor allows to specify an editor to
12008 use if Emacs is not running. The environment variable
12009 ALTERNATE_EDITOR can be used for the same effect; the command line
12010 option takes precedence.
12011
12012 ** M-x eldoc-mode enables a minor mode in which the echo area
12013 constantly shows the parameter list for function being called at point
12014 (in Emacs Lisp and Lisp Interaction modes only).
12015
12016 ** C-x n d now runs the new command narrow-to-defun,
12017 which narrows the accessible parts of the buffer to just
12018 the current defun.
12019
12020 ** Emacs now handles the `--' argument in the standard way; all
12021 following arguments are treated as ordinary file names.
12022
12023 ** On MSDOS and Windows, the bookmark file is now called _emacs.bmk,
12024 and the saved desktop file is now called _emacs.desktop (truncated if
12025 necessary).
12026
12027 ** When you kill a buffer that visits a file,
12028 if there are any registers that save positions in the file,
12029 these register values no longer become completely useless.
12030 If you try to go to such a register with C-x j, then you are
12031 asked whether to visit the file again. If you say yes,
12032 it visits the file and then goes to the same position.
12033
12034 ** When you visit a file that changes frequently outside Emacs--for
12035 example, a log of output from a process that continues to run--it may
12036 be useful for Emacs to revert the file without querying you whenever
12037 you visit the file afresh with C-x C-f.
12038
12039 You can request this behavior for certain files by setting the
12040 variable revert-without-query to a list of regular expressions. If a
12041 file's name matches any of these regular expressions, find-file and
12042 revert-buffer revert the buffer without asking for permission--but
12043 only if you have not edited the buffer text yourself.
12044
12045 ** set-default-font has been renamed to set-frame-font
12046 since it applies only to the current frame.
12047
12048 ** In TeX mode, you can use the variable tex-main-file to specify the
12049 file for tex-file to run TeX on. (By default, tex-main-file is nil,
12050 and tex-file runs TeX on the current visited file.)
12051
12052 This is useful when you are editing a document that consists of
12053 multiple files. In each of the included files, you can set up a local
12054 variable list which specifies the top-level file of your document for
12055 tex-main-file. Then tex-file will run TeX on the whole document
12056 instead of just the file you are editing.
12057
12058 ** RefTeX mode
12059
12060 RefTeX mode is a new minor mode with special support for \label, \ref
12061 and \cite macros in LaTeX documents. RefTeX distinguishes labels of
12062 different environments (equation, figure, ...) and has full support for
12063 multifile documents. To use it, select a buffer with a LaTeX document and
12064 turn the mode on with M-x reftex-mode. Here are the main user commands:
12065
12066 C-c ( reftex-label
12067 Creates a label semi-automatically. RefTeX is context sensitive and
12068 knows which kind of label is needed.
12069
12070 C-c ) reftex-reference
12071 Offers in a menu all labels in the document, along with context of the
12072 label definition. The selected label is referenced as \ref{LABEL}.
12073
12074 C-c [ reftex-citation
12075 Prompts for a regular expression and displays a list of matching BibTeX
12076 database entries. The selected entry is cited with a \cite{KEY} macro.
12077
12078 C-c & reftex-view-crossref
12079 Views the cross reference of a \ref or \cite command near point.
12080
12081 C-c = reftex-toc
12082 Shows a table of contents of the (multifile) document. From there you
12083 can quickly jump to every section.
12084
12085 Under X, RefTeX installs a "Ref" menu in the menu bar, with additional
12086 commands. Press `?' to get help when a prompt mentions this feature.
12087 Full documentation and customization examples are in the file
12088 reftex.el. You can use the finder to view the file documentation:
12089 C-h p --> tex --> reftex.el
12090
12091 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
12092
12093 *** Info documentation is now available.
12094
12095 *** Don't allow parentheses in string constants anymore. This confused
12096 both the BibTeX program and Emacs BibTeX mode.
12097
12098 *** Renamed variable bibtex-mode-user-optional-fields to
12099 bibtex-user-optional-fields.
12100
12101 *** Removed variable bibtex-include-OPTannote
12102 (use bibtex-user-optional-fields instead).
12103
12104 *** New interactive functions to copy and kill fields and complete
12105 entries to the BibTeX kill ring, from where they can be yanked back by
12106 appropriate functions.
12107
12108 *** New interactive functions for repositioning and marking of
12109 entries. They are bound by default to C-M-l and C-M-h.
12110
12111 *** New hook bibtex-clean-entry-hook. It is called after entry has
12112 been cleaned.
12113
12114 *** New variable bibtex-field-delimiters, which replaces variables
12115 bibtex-field-{left|right}-delimiter.
12116
12117 *** New variable bibtex-entry-delimiters to determine how entries
12118 shall be delimited.
12119
12120 *** Allow preinitialization of fields. See documentation of
12121 bibtex-user-optional-fields, bibtex-entry-field-alist, and
12122 bibtex-include-OPTkey for details.
12123
12124 *** Book and InBook entries require either an author or an editor
12125 field. This is now supported by bibtex.el. Alternative fields are
12126 prefixed with `ALT'.
12127
12128 *** New variable bibtex-entry-format, which replaces variable
12129 bibtex-clean-entry-zap-empty-opts and allows specification of many
12130 formatting options performed on cleaning an entry (see variable
12131 documentation).
12132
12133 *** Even more control on how automatic keys are generated. See
12134 documentation of bibtex-generate-autokey for details. Transcriptions
12135 for foreign languages other than German are now handled, too.
12136
12137 *** New boolean user option bibtex-comma-after-last-field to decide if
12138 comma should be inserted at end of last field.
12139
12140 *** New boolean user option bibtex-align-at-equal-sign to determine if
12141 alignment should be made at left side of field contents or at equal
12142 signs. New user options to control entry layout (e.g. indentation).
12143
12144 *** New function bibtex-fill-entry to realign entries.
12145
12146 *** New function bibtex-reformat to reformat region or buffer.
12147
12148 *** New function bibtex-convert-alien to convert a BibTeX database
12149 from alien sources.
12150
12151 *** New function bibtex-complete-key (similar to bibtex-complete-string)
12152 to complete prefix to a key defined in buffer. Mainly useful in
12153 crossref entries.
12154
12155 *** New function bibtex-count-entries to count entries in buffer or
12156 region.
12157
12158 *** Added support for imenu.
12159
12160 *** The function `bibtex-validate' now checks current region instead
12161 of buffer if mark is active. Now it shows all errors of buffer in a
12162 `compilation mode' buffer. You can use the normal commands (e.g.
12163 `next-error') for compilation modes to jump to errors.
12164
12165 *** New variable `bibtex-string-file-path' to determine where the files
12166 from `bibtex-string-files' are searched.
12167
12168 ** Iso Accents mode now supports Latin-3 as an alternative.
12169
12170 ** The command next-error now opens blocks hidden by hideshow.
12171
12172 ** The function using-unix-filesystems has been replaced by the
12173 functions add-untranslated-filesystem and remove-untranslated-filesystem.
12174 Each of these functions takes the name of a drive letter or directory
12175 as an argument.
12176
12177 When a filesystem is added as untranslated, all files on it are read
12178 and written in binary mode (no cr/lf translation is performed).
12179
12180 ** browse-url changes
12181
12182 *** New methods for: Grail (browse-url-generic), MMM (browse-url-mmm),
12183 Lynx in a separate xterm (browse-url-lynx-xterm) or in an Emacs window
12184 (browse-url-lynx-emacs), remote W3 (browse-url-w3-gnudoit), generic
12185 non-remote-controlled browsers (browse-url-generic) and associated
12186 customization variables.
12187
12188 *** New commands `browse-url-of-region' and `browse-url'.
12189
12190 *** URLs marked up with <URL:...> (RFC1738) work if broken across
12191 lines. Browsing methods can be associated with URL regexps
12192 (e.g. mailto: URLs) via `browse-url-browser-function'.
12193
12194 ** Changes in Ediff
12195
12196 *** Clicking Mouse-2 on a brief command description in Ediff control panel
12197 pops up the Info file for this command.
12198
12199 *** There is now a variable, ediff-autostore-merges, which controls whether
12200 the result of a merge is saved in a file. By default, this is done only when
12201 merge is done from a session group (eg, when merging files in two different
12202 directories).
12203
12204 *** Since Emacs 19.31 (this hasn't been announced before), Ediff can compare
12205 and merge groups of files residing in different directories, or revisions of
12206 files in the same directory.
12207
12208 *** Since Emacs 19.31, Ediff can apply multi-file patches interactively.
12209 The patches must be in the context format or GNU unified format. (The bug
12210 related to the GNU format has now been fixed.)
12211
12212 ** Changes in Viper
12213
12214 *** The startup file is now .viper instead of .vip
12215 *** All variable/function names have been changed to start with viper-
12216 instead of vip-.
12217 *** C-\ now simulates the meta-key in all Viper states.
12218 *** C-z in Insert state now escapes to Vi for the duration of the next
12219 Viper command. In Vi and Insert states, C-z behaves as before.
12220 *** C-c \ escapes to Vi for one command if Viper is in Insert or Emacs states.
12221 *** _ is no longer the meta-key in Vi state.
12222 *** The variable viper-insert-state-cursor-color can be used to change cursor
12223 color when Viper is in insert state.
12224 *** If search lands the cursor near the top or the bottom of the window,
12225 Viper pulls the window up or down to expose more context. The variable
12226 viper-adjust-window-after-search controls this behavior.
12227
12228 ** Etags changes.
12229
12230 *** In C, C++, Objective C and Java, Etags tags global variables by
12231 default. The resulting tags files are inflated by 30% on average.
12232 Use --no-globals to turn this feature off. Etags can also tag
12233 variables which are members of structure-like constructs, but it does
12234 not by default. Use --members to turn this feature on.
12235
12236 *** C++ member functions are now recognized as tags.
12237
12238 *** Java is tagged like C++. In addition, "extends" and "implements"
12239 constructs are tagged. Files are recognised by the extension .java.
12240
12241 *** Etags can now handle programs written in Postscript. Files are
12242 recognised by the extensions .ps and .pdb (Postscript with C syntax).
12243 In Postscript, tags are lines that start with a slash.
12244
12245 *** Etags now handles Objective C and Objective C++ code. The usual C and
12246 C++ tags are recognized in these languages; in addition, etags
12247 recognizes special Objective C syntax for classes, class categories,
12248 methods and protocols.
12249
12250 *** Etags also handles Cobol. Files are recognised by the extension
12251 .cobol. The tagged lines are those containing a word that begins in
12252 column 8 and ends in a full stop, i.e. anything that could be a
12253 paragraph name.
12254
12255 *** Regexps in Etags now support intervals, as in ed or grep. The syntax of
12256 an interval is \{M,N\}, and it means to match the preceding expression
12257 at least M times and as many as N times.
12258
12259 ** The format for specifying a custom format for time-stamp to insert
12260 in files has changed slightly.
12261
12262 With the new enhancements to the functionality of format-time-string,
12263 time-stamp-format will change to be eventually compatible with it.
12264 This conversion is being done in two steps to maintain compatibility
12265 with old time-stamp-format values.
12266
12267 In the new scheme, alternate case is signified by the number-sign
12268 (`#') modifier, rather than changing the case of the format character.
12269 This feature is as yet incompletely implemented for compatibility
12270 reasons.
12271
12272 In the old time-stamp-format, all numeric fields defaulted to their
12273 natural width. (With format-time-string, each format has a
12274 fixed-width default.) In this version, you can specify the colon
12275 (`:') modifier to a numeric conversion to mean "give me the historical
12276 time-stamp-format width default." Do not use colon if you are
12277 specifying an explicit width, as in "%02d".
12278
12279 Numbers are no longer truncated to the requested width, except in the
12280 case of "%02y", which continues to give a two-digit year. Digit
12281 truncation probably wasn't being used for anything else anyway.
12282
12283 The new formats will work with old versions of Emacs. New formats are
12284 being recommended now to allow time-stamp-format to change in the
12285 future to be compatible with format-time-string. The new forms being
12286 recommended now will continue to work then.
12287
12288 See the documentation string for the variable time-stamp-format for
12289 details.
12290
12291 ** There are some additional major modes:
12292
12293 dcl-mode, for editing VMS DCL files.
12294 m4-mode, for editing files of m4 input.
12295 meta-mode, for editing MetaFont and MetaPost source files.
12296
12297 ** In Shell mode, the command shell-copy-environment-variable lets you
12298 copy the value of a specified environment variable from the subshell
12299 into Emacs.
12300
12301 ** New Lisp packages include:
12302
12303 *** battery.el displays battery status for laptops.
12304
12305 *** M-x bruce (named after Lenny Bruce) is a program that might
12306 be used for adding some indecent words to your email.
12307
12308 *** M-x crisp-mode enables an emulation for the CRiSP editor.
12309
12310 *** M-x dirtrack arranges for better tracking of directory changes
12311 in shell buffers.
12312
12313 *** The new library elint.el provides for linting of Emacs Lisp code.
12314 See the documentation for `elint-initialize', `elint-current-buffer'
12315 and `elint-defun'.
12316
12317 *** M-x expand-add-abbrevs defines a special kind of abbrev which is
12318 meant for programming constructs. These abbrevs expand like ordinary
12319 ones, when you type SPC, but only at the end of a line and not within
12320 strings or comments.
12321
12322 These abbrevs can act as templates: you can define places within an
12323 abbrev for insertion of additional text. Once you expand the abbrev,
12324 you can then use C-x a p and C-x a n to move back and forth to these
12325 insertion points. Thus you can conveniently insert additional text
12326 at these points.
12327
12328 *** filecache.el remembers the location of files so that you
12329 can visit them by short forms of their names.
12330
12331 *** find-func.el lets you find the definition of the user-loaded
12332 Emacs Lisp function at point.
12333
12334 *** M-x handwrite converts text to a "handwritten" picture.
12335
12336 *** M-x iswitchb-buffer is a command for switching to a buffer, much like
12337 switch-buffer, but it reads the argument in a more helpful way.
12338
12339 *** M-x landmark implements a neural network for landmark learning.
12340
12341 *** M-x locate provides a convenient interface to the `locate' program.
12342
12343 *** M4 mode is a new mode for editing files of m4 input.
12344
12345 *** mantemp.el creates C++ manual template instantiations
12346 from the GCC error messages which indicate which instantiations are needed.
12347
12348 *** mouse-copy.el provides a one-click copy and move feature.
12349 You can drag a region with M-mouse-1, and it is automatically
12350 inserted at point. M-Shift-mouse-1 deletes the text from its
12351 original place after inserting the copy.
12352
12353 *** mouse-drag.el lets you do scrolling by dragging Mouse-2
12354 on the buffer.
12355
12356 You click the mouse and move; that distance either translates into the
12357 velocity to scroll (with mouse-drag-throw) or the distance to scroll
12358 (with mouse-drag-drag). Horizontal scrolling is enabled when needed.
12359
12360 Enable mouse-drag with:
12361 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-throw)
12362 -or-
12363 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-drag)
12364
12365 *** mspools.el is useful for determining which mail folders have
12366 mail waiting to be read in them. It works with procmail.
12367
12368 *** Octave mode is a major mode for editing files of input for Octave.
12369 It comes with a facility for communicating with an Octave subprocess.
12370
12371 *** ogonek
12372
12373 The ogonek package provides functions for changing the coding of
12374 Polish diacritic characters in buffers. Codings known from various
12375 platforms are supported such as ISO8859-2, Mazovia, IBM Latin2, and
12376 TeX. For example, you can change the coding from Mazovia to
12377 ISO8859-2. Another example is a change of coding from ISO8859-2 to
12378 prefix notation (in which `/a' stands for the aogonek character, for
12379 instance) and vice versa.
12380
12381 To use this package load it using
12382 M-x load-library [enter] ogonek
12383 Then, you may get an explanation by calling one of
12384 M-x ogonek-jak -- in Polish
12385 M-x ogonek-how -- in English
12386 The info specifies the commands and variables provided as well as the
12387 ways of customization in `.emacs'.
12388
12389 *** Interface to ph.
12390
12391 Emacs provides a client interface to CCSO Nameservers (ph/qi)
12392
12393 The CCSO nameserver is used in many universities to provide directory
12394 services about people. ph.el provides a convenient Emacs interface to
12395 these servers.
12396
12397 *** uce.el is useful for replying to unsolicited commercial email.
12398
12399 *** vcursor.el implements a "virtual cursor" feature.
12400 You can move the virtual cursor with special commands
12401 while the real cursor does not move.
12402
12403 *** webjump.el is a "hot list" package which you can set up
12404 for visiting your favorite web sites.
12405
12406 *** M-x winner-mode is a minor mode which saves window configurations,
12407 so you can move back to other configurations that you have recently used.
12408
12409 ** movemail change
12410
12411 Movemail no longer needs to be installed setuid root in order for POP
12412 mail retrieval to function properly. This is because it no longer
12413 supports the RPOP (reserved-port POP) protocol; instead, it uses the
12414 user's POP password to authenticate to the mail server.
12415
12416 This change was made earlier, but not reported in NEWS before.
12417 \f
12418 * Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows.
12419
12420 ** Changes in handling MS-DOS/MS-Windows text files.
12421
12422 Emacs handles three different conventions for representing
12423 end-of-line: CRLF for MSDOS, LF for Unix and GNU, and CR (used on the
12424 Macintosh). Emacs determines which convention is used in a specific
12425 file based on the contents of that file (except for certain special
12426 file names), and when it saves the file, it uses the same convention.
12427
12428 To save the file and change the end-of-line convention, you can use
12429 C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system) to specify a different
12430 coding system for the buffer. Then, when you save the file, the newly
12431 specified coding system will take effect. For example, to save with
12432 LF, specify undecided-unix (or some other ...-unix coding system); to
12433 save with CRLF, specify undecided-dos.
12434 \f
12435 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 20.1
12436
12437 ** Byte-compiled files made with Emacs 20 will, in general, work in
12438 Emacs 19 as well, as long as the source code runs in Emacs 19. And
12439 vice versa: byte-compiled files made with Emacs 19 should also run in
12440 Emacs 20, as long as the program itself works in Emacs 20.
12441
12442 ** Windows-specific functions and variables have been renamed
12443 to start with w32- instead of win32-.
12444
12445 In hacker language, calling something a "win" is a form of praise. We
12446 don't want to praise a non-free Microsoft system, so we don't call it
12447 "win".
12448
12449 ** Basic Lisp changes
12450
12451 *** A symbol whose name starts with a colon now automatically
12452 evaluates to itself. Therefore such a symbol can be used as a constant.
12453
12454 *** The defined purpose of `defconst' has been changed. It should now
12455 be used only for values that should not be changed whether by a program
12456 or by the user.
12457
12458 The actual behavior of defconst has not been changed.
12459
12460 *** There are new macros `when' and `unless'
12461
12462 (when CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION (progn BODY...))
12463 (unless CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION nil BODY...)
12464
12465 *** Emacs now defines functions caar, cadr, cdar and cddr with their
12466 usual Lisp meanings. For example, caar returns the car of the car of
12467 its argument.
12468
12469 *** equal, when comparing strings, now ignores their text properties.
12470
12471 *** The new function `functionp' tests whether an object is a function.
12472
12473 *** arrayp now returns t for char-tables and bool-vectors.
12474
12475 *** Certain primitives which use characters (as integers) now get an
12476 error if the integer is not a valid character code. These primitives
12477 include insert-char, char-to-string, and the %c construct in the
12478 `format' function.
12479
12480 *** The `require' function now insists on adding a suffix, either .el
12481 or .elc, to the file name. Thus, (require 'foo) will not use a file
12482 whose name is just foo. It insists on foo.el or foo.elc.
12483
12484 *** The `autoload' function, when the file name does not contain
12485 either a directory name or the suffix .el or .elc, insists on
12486 adding one of these suffixes.
12487
12488 *** string-to-number now takes an optional second argument BASE
12489 which specifies the base to use when converting an integer.
12490 If BASE is omitted, base 10 is used.
12491
12492 We have not implemented other radices for floating point numbers,
12493 because that would be much more work and does not seem useful.
12494
12495 *** substring now handles vectors as well as strings.
12496
12497 *** The Common Lisp function eql is no longer defined normally.
12498 You must load the `cl' library to define it.
12499
12500 *** The new macro `with-current-buffer' lets you evaluate an expression
12501 conveniently with a different current buffer. It looks like this:
12502
12503 (with-current-buffer BUFFER BODY-FORMS...)
12504
12505 BUFFER is the expression that says which buffer to use.
12506 BODY-FORMS say what to do in that buffer.
12507
12508 *** The new primitive `save-current-buffer' saves and restores the
12509 choice of current buffer, like `save-excursion', but without saving or
12510 restoring the value of point or the mark. `with-current-buffer'
12511 works using `save-current-buffer'.
12512
12513 *** The new macro `with-temp-file' lets you do some work in a new buffer and
12514 write the output to a specified file. Like `progn', it returns the value
12515 of the last form.
12516
12517 *** The new macro `with-temp-buffer' lets you do some work in a new buffer,
12518 which is discarded after use. Like `progn', it returns the value of the
12519 last form. If you wish to return the buffer contents, use (buffer-string)
12520 as the last form.
12521
12522 *** The new function split-string takes a string, splits it at certain
12523 characters, and returns a list of the substrings in between the
12524 matches.
12525
12526 For example, (split-string "foo bar lose" " +") returns ("foo" "bar" "lose").
12527
12528 *** The new macro with-output-to-string executes some Lisp expressions
12529 with standard-output set up so that all output feeds into a string.
12530 Then it returns that string.
12531
12532 For example, if the current buffer name is `foo',
12533
12534 (with-output-to-string
12535 (princ "The buffer is ")
12536 (princ (buffer-name)))
12537
12538 returns "The buffer is foo".
12539
12540 ** Non-ASCII characters are now supported, if enable-multibyte-characters
12541 is non-nil.
12542
12543 These characters have character codes above 256. When inserted in the
12544 buffer or stored in a string, they are represented as multibyte
12545 characters that occupy several buffer positions each.
12546
12547 *** When enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, a single character in
12548 a buffer or string can be two or more bytes (as many as four).
12549
12550 Buffers and strings are still made up of unibyte elements;
12551 character positions and string indices are always measured in bytes.
12552 Therefore, moving forward one character can increase the buffer
12553 position by 2, 3 or 4. The function forward-char moves by whole
12554 characters, and therefore is no longer equivalent to
12555 (lambda (n) (goto-char (+ (point) n))).
12556
12557 ASCII characters (codes 0 through 127) are still single bytes, always.
12558 Sequences of byte values 128 through 255 are used to represent
12559 non-ASCII characters. These sequences are called "multibyte
12560 characters".
12561
12562 The first byte of a multibyte character is always in the range 128
12563 through 159 (octal 0200 through 0237). These values are called
12564 "leading codes". The second and subsequent bytes are always in the
12565 range 160 through 255 (octal 0240 through 0377). The first byte, the
12566 leading code, determines how many bytes long the sequence is.
12567
12568 *** The function forward-char moves over characters, and therefore
12569 (forward-char 1) may increase point by more than 1 if it moves over a
12570 multibyte character. Likewise, delete-char always deletes a
12571 character, which may be more than one buffer position.
12572
12573 This means that some Lisp programs, which assume that a character is
12574 always one buffer position, need to be changed.
12575
12576 However, all ASCII characters are always one buffer position.
12577
12578 *** The regexp [\200-\377] no longer matches all non-ASCII characters,
12579 because when enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, these characters
12580 have codes that are not in the range octal 200 to octal 377. However,
12581 the regexp [^\000-\177] does match all non-ASCII characters,
12582 guaranteed.
12583
12584 *** The function char-boundary-p returns non-nil if position POS is
12585 between two characters in the buffer (not in the middle of a
12586 character).
12587
12588 When the value is non-nil, it says what kind of character follows POS:
12589
12590 0 if POS is at an ASCII character or at the end of range,
12591 1 if POS is before a 2-byte length multi-byte form,
12592 2 if POS is at a head of 3-byte length multi-byte form,
12593 3 if POS is at a head of 4-byte length multi-byte form,
12594 4 if POS is at a head of multi-byte form of a composite character.
12595
12596 *** The function char-bytes returns how many bytes the character CHAR uses.
12597
12598 *** Strings can contain multibyte characters. The function
12599 `length' returns the string length counting bytes, which may be
12600 more than the number of characters.
12601
12602 You can include a multibyte character in a string constant by writing
12603 it literally. You can also represent it with a hex escape,
12604 \xNNNNNNN..., using as many digits as necessary. Any character which
12605 is not a valid hex digit terminates this construct. If you want to
12606 follow it with a character that is a hex digit, write backslash and
12607 newline in between; that will terminate the hex escape.
12608
12609 *** The function concat-chars takes arguments which are characters
12610 and returns a string containing those characters.
12611
12612 *** The function sref access a multibyte character in a string.
12613 (sref STRING INDX) returns the character in STRING at INDEX. INDEX
12614 counts from zero. If INDEX is at a position in the middle of a
12615 character, sref signals an error.
12616
12617 *** The function chars-in-string returns the number of characters
12618 in a string. This is less than the length of the string, if the
12619 string contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
12620
12621 *** The function chars-in-region returns the number of characters
12622 in a region from BEG to END. This is less than (- END BEG) if the
12623 region contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
12624
12625 *** The function string-to-list converts a string to a list of
12626 the characters in it. string-to-vector converts a string
12627 to a vector of the characters in it.
12628
12629 *** The function store-substring alters part of the contents
12630 of a string. You call it as follows:
12631
12632 (store-substring STRING IDX OBJ)
12633
12634 This says to alter STRING, by storing OBJ starting at index IDX in
12635 STRING. OBJ may be either a character or a (smaller) string.
12636 This function really does alter the contents of STRING.
12637 Since it is impossible to change the length of an existing string,
12638 it is an error if OBJ doesn't fit within STRING's actual length.
12639
12640 *** char-width returns the width (in columns) of the character CHAR,
12641 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
12642
12643 *** string-width returns the width (in columns) of the text in STRING,
12644 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
12645
12646 *** truncate-string-to-width shortens a string, if necessary,
12647 to fit within a certain number of columns. (Of course, it does
12648 not alter the string that you give it; it returns a new string
12649 which contains all or just part of the existing string.)
12650
12651 (truncate-string-to-width STR END-COLUMN &optional START-COLUMN PADDING)
12652
12653 This returns the part of STR up to column END-COLUMN.
12654
12655 The optional argument START-COLUMN specifies the starting column.
12656 If this is non-nil, then the first START-COLUMN columns of the string
12657 are not included in the resulting value.
12658
12659 The optional argument PADDING, if non-nil, is a padding character to be added
12660 at the beginning and end the resulting string, to extend it to exactly
12661 WIDTH columns. If PADDING is nil, that means do not pad; then, if STRING
12662 is narrower than WIDTH, the value is equal to STRING.
12663
12664 If PADDING and START-COLUMN are both non-nil, and if there is no clean
12665 place in STRING that corresponds to START-COLUMN (because one
12666 character extends across that column), then the padding character
12667 PADDING is added one or more times at the beginning of the result
12668 string, so that its columns line up as if it really did start at
12669 column START-COLUMN.
12670
12671 *** When the functions in the list after-change-functions are called,
12672 the third argument is the number of bytes in the pre-change text, not
12673 necessarily the number of characters. It is, in effect, the
12674 difference in buffer position between the beginning and the end of the
12675 changed text, before the change.
12676
12677 *** The characters Emacs uses are classified in various character
12678 sets, each of which has a name which is a symbol. In general there is
12679 one character set for each script, not for each language.
12680
12681 **** The function charsetp tests whether an object is a character set name.
12682
12683 **** The variable charset-list holds a list of character set names.
12684
12685 **** char-charset, given a character code, returns the name of the character
12686 set that the character belongs to. (The value is a symbol.)
12687
12688 **** split-char, given a character code, returns a list containing the
12689 name of the character set, followed by one or two byte-values
12690 which identify the character within that character set.
12691
12692 **** make-char, given a character set name and one or two subsequent
12693 byte-values, constructs a character code. This is roughly the
12694 opposite of split-char.
12695
12696 **** find-charset-region returns a list of the character sets
12697 of all the characters between BEG and END.
12698
12699 **** find-charset-string returns a list of the character sets
12700 of all the characters in a string.
12701
12702 *** Here are the Lisp facilities for working with coding systems
12703 and specifying coding systems.
12704
12705 **** The function coding-system-list returns a list of all coding
12706 system names (symbols). With optional argument t, it returns a list
12707 of all distinct base coding systems, not including variants.
12708 (Variant coding systems are those like latin-1-dos, latin-1-unix
12709 and latin-1-mac which specify the end-of-line conversion as well
12710 as what to do about code conversion.)
12711
12712 **** coding-system-p tests a symbol to see if it is a coding system
12713 name. It returns t if so, nil if not.
12714
12715 **** file-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
12716 for certain file names. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
12717 except that the PATTERN is matched against the file name.
12718
12719 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
12720 which file names the element applies to. PATTERN should be a regexp
12721 to match against a file name.
12722
12723 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
12724 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
12725 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
12726 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
12727 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
12728 specifies the coding system for encoding.
12729
12730 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
12731 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
12732
12733 **** The variable network-coding-system-alist specifies
12734 the coding system to use for network sockets.
12735
12736 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
12737 which network sockets the element applies to. PATTERN should be
12738 either a port number or a regular expression matching some network
12739 service names.
12740
12741 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
12742 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
12743 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
12744 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
12745 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
12746 specifies the coding system for encoding.
12747
12748 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
12749 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
12750
12751 **** process-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
12752 for certain subprocess. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
12753 except that the PATTERN is matched against the program name used to
12754 start the subprocess.
12755
12756 **** The variable default-process-coding-system specifies the coding
12757 systems to use for subprocess (and net connection) input and output,
12758 when nothing else specifies what to do. The value is a cons cell
12759 (OUTPUT-CODING . INPUT-CODING). OUTPUT-CODING applies to output
12760 to the subprocess, and INPUT-CODING applies to input from it.
12761
12762 **** The variable coding-system-for-write, if non-nil, specifies the
12763 coding system to use for writing a file, or for output to a synchronous
12764 subprocess.
12765
12766 It also applies to any asynchronous subprocess or network connection,
12767 but in a different way: the value of coding-system-for-write when you
12768 start the subprocess or connection affects that subprocess or
12769 connection permanently or until overridden.
12770
12771 The variable coding-system-for-write takes precedence over
12772 file-coding-system-alist, process-coding-system-alist and
12773 network-coding-system-alist, and all other methods of specifying a
12774 coding system for output. But most of the time this variable is nil.
12775 It exists so that Lisp programs can bind it to a specific coding
12776 system for one operation at a time.
12777
12778 **** coding-system-for-read applies similarly to input from
12779 files, subprocesses or network connections.
12780
12781 **** The function process-coding-system tells you what
12782 coding systems(s) an existing subprocess is using.
12783 The value is a cons cell,
12784 (DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM . ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM)
12785 where DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for decoding output from
12786 the subprocess, and ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for encoding
12787 input to the subprocess.
12788
12789 **** The function set-process-coding-system can be used to
12790 change the coding systems in use for an existing subprocess.
12791
12792 ** Emacs has a new facility to help users manage the many
12793 customization options. To make a Lisp program work with this facility,
12794 you need to use the new macros defgroup and defcustom.
12795
12796 You use defcustom instead of defvar, for defining a user option
12797 variable. The difference is that you specify two additional pieces of
12798 information (usually): the "type" which says what values are
12799 legitimate, and the "group" which specifies the hierarchy for
12800 customization.
12801
12802 Thus, instead of writing
12803
12804 (defvar foo-blurgoze nil
12805 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely.")
12806
12807 you would now write this:
12808
12809 (defcustom foo-blurgoze nil
12810 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely."
12811 :type 'boolean
12812 :group foo)
12813
12814 The type `boolean' means that this variable has only
12815 two meaningful states: nil and non-nil. Other type values
12816 describe other possibilities; see the manual for Custom
12817 for a description of them.
12818
12819 The "group" argument is used to specify a group which the option
12820 should belong to. You define a new group like this:
12821
12822 (defgroup ispell nil
12823 "Spell checking using Ispell."
12824 :group 'processes)
12825
12826 The "group" argument in defgroup specifies the parent group. The root
12827 group is called `emacs'; it should not contain any variables itself,
12828 but only other groups. The immediate subgroups of `emacs' correspond
12829 to the keywords used by C-h p. Under these subgroups come
12830 second-level subgroups that belong to individual packages.
12831
12832 Each Emacs package should have its own set of groups. A simple
12833 package should have just one group; a more complex package should
12834 have a hierarchy of its own groups. The sole or root group of a
12835 package should be a subgroup of one or more of the "keyword"
12836 first-level subgroups.
12837
12838 ** New `widget' library for inserting UI components in buffers.
12839
12840 This library, used by the new custom library, is documented in a
12841 separate manual that accompanies Emacs.
12842
12843 ** easy-mmode
12844
12845 The easy-mmode package provides macros and functions that make
12846 developing minor modes easier. Roughly, the programmer has to code
12847 only the functionality of the minor mode. All the rest--toggles,
12848 predicate, and documentation--can be done in one call to the macro
12849 `easy-mmode-define-minor-mode' (see the documentation). See also
12850 `easy-mmode-define-keymap'.
12851
12852 ** Text property changes
12853
12854 *** The `intangible' property now works on overlays as well as on a
12855 text property.
12856
12857 *** The new functions next-char-property-change and
12858 previous-char-property-change scan through the buffer looking for a
12859 place where either a text property or an overlay might change. The
12860 functions take two arguments, POSITION and LIMIT. POSITION is the
12861 starting position for the scan. LIMIT says where to stop the scan.
12862
12863 If no property change is found before LIMIT, the value is LIMIT. If
12864 LIMIT is nil, scan goes to the beginning or end of the accessible part
12865 of the buffer. If no property change is found, the value is the
12866 position of the beginning or end of the buffer.
12867
12868 *** In the `local-map' text property or overlay property, the property
12869 value can now be a symbol whose function definition is a keymap. This
12870 is an alternative to using the keymap itself.
12871
12872 ** Changes in invisibility features
12873
12874 *** Isearch can now temporarily show parts of the buffer which are
12875 hidden by an overlay with a invisible property, when the search match
12876 is inside that portion of the buffer. To enable this the overlay
12877 should have a isearch-open-invisible property which is a function that
12878 would be called having the overlay as an argument, the function should
12879 make the overlay visible.
12880
12881 During incremental search the overlays are shown by modifying the
12882 invisible and intangible properties, if beside this more actions are
12883 needed the overlay should have a isearch-open-invisible-temporary
12884 which is a function. The function is called with 2 arguments: one is
12885 the overlay and the second is nil when it should show the overlay and
12886 t when it should hide it.
12887
12888 *** add-to-invisibility-spec, remove-from-invisibility-spec
12889
12890 Modes that use overlays to hide portions of a buffer should set the
12891 invisible property of the overlay to the mode's name (or another symbol)
12892 and modify the `buffer-invisibility-spec' to include that symbol.
12893 Use `add-to-invisibility-spec' and `remove-from-invisibility-spec' to
12894 manipulate the `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
12895 Here is an example of how to do this:
12896
12897 ;; If we want to display an ellipsis:
12898 (add-to-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
12899 ;; If you don't want ellipsis:
12900 (add-to-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
12901
12902 ...
12903 (overlay-put (make-overlay beginning end) 'invisible 'my-symbol)
12904
12905 ...
12906 ;; When done with the overlays:
12907 (remove-from-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
12908 ;; Or respectively:
12909 (remove-from-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
12910
12911 ** Changes in syntax parsing.
12912
12913 *** The syntax-directed buffer-scan functions (such as
12914 `parse-partial-sexp', `forward-word' and similar functions) can now
12915 obey syntax information specified by text properties, if the variable
12916 `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil.
12917
12918 If the value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is nil, the behavior
12919 is as before: the syntax-table of the current buffer is always
12920 used to determine the syntax of the character at the position.
12921
12922 When `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil, the syntax of a
12923 character in the buffer is calculated thus:
12924
12925 a) if the `syntax-table' text-property of that character
12926 is a cons, this cons becomes the syntax-type;
12927
12928 Valid values of `syntax-table' text-property are: nil, a valid
12929 syntax-table, and a valid syntax-table element, i.e.,
12930 a cons cell of the form (SYNTAX-CODE . MATCHING-CHAR).
12931
12932 b) if the character's `syntax-table' text-property
12933 is a syntax table, this syntax table is used
12934 (instead of the syntax-table of the current buffer) to
12935 determine the syntax type of the character.
12936
12937 c) otherwise the syntax-type is determined by the syntax-table
12938 of the current buffer.
12939
12940 *** The meaning of \s in regular expressions is also affected by the
12941 value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties'. The details are the same as
12942 for the syntax-directed buffer-scan functions.
12943
12944 *** There are two new syntax-codes, `!' and `|' (numeric values 14
12945 and 15). A character with a code `!' starts a comment which is ended
12946 only by another character with the same code (unless quoted). A
12947 character with a code `|' starts a string which is ended only by
12948 another character with the same code (unless quoted).
12949
12950 These codes are mainly meant for use as values of the `syntax-table'
12951 text property.
12952
12953 *** The function `parse-partial-sexp' has new semantics for the sixth
12954 arg COMMENTSTOP. If it is `syntax-table', parse stops after the start
12955 of a comment or a string, or after end of a comment or a string.
12956
12957 *** The state-list which the return value from `parse-partial-sexp'
12958 (and can also be used as an argument) now has an optional ninth
12959 element: the character address of the start of last comment or string;
12960 nil if none. The fourth and eighth elements have special values if the
12961 string/comment is started by a "!" or "|" syntax-code.
12962
12963 *** Since new features of `parse-partial-sexp' allow a complete
12964 syntactic parsing, `font-lock' no longer supports
12965 `font-lock-comment-start-regexp'.
12966
12967 ** Changes in face features
12968
12969 *** The face functions are now unconditionally defined in Emacs, even
12970 if it does not support displaying on a device that supports faces.
12971
12972 *** The function face-documentation returns the documentation string
12973 of a face (or nil if it doesn't have one).
12974
12975 *** The function face-bold-p returns t if a face should be bold.
12976 set-face-bold-p sets that flag.
12977
12978 *** The function face-italic-p returns t if a face should be italic.
12979 set-face-italic-p sets that flag.
12980
12981 *** You can now specify foreground and background colors for text
12982 by adding elements of the form (foreground-color . COLOR-NAME)
12983 and (background-color . COLOR-NAME) to the list of faces in
12984 the `face' property (either the character's text property or an
12985 overlay property).
12986
12987 This means that you no longer need to create named faces to use
12988 arbitrary colors in a Lisp package.
12989
12990 ** Changes in file-handling functions
12991
12992 *** File-access primitive functions no longer discard an extra redundant
12993 directory name from the beginning of the file name. In other words,
12994 they no longer do anything special with // or /~. That conversion
12995 is now done only in substitute-in-file-name.
12996
12997 This makes it possible for a Lisp program to open a file whose name
12998 begins with ~.
12999
13000 *** If copy-file is unable to set the date of the output file,
13001 it now signals an error with the condition file-date-error.
13002
13003 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
13004 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a list of integers.
13005
13006 *** insert-file-contents can now read from a special file,
13007 as long as the arguments VISIT and REPLACE are nil.
13008
13009 *** The RAWFILE arg to find-file-noselect, if non-nil, now suppresses
13010 character code conversion as well as other things.
13011
13012 Meanwhile, this feature does work with remote file names
13013 (formerly it did not).
13014
13015 *** Lisp packages which create temporary files should use the TMPDIR
13016 environment variable to decide which directory to put them in.
13017
13018 *** interpreter-mode-alist elements now specify regexps
13019 instead of constant strings.
13020
13021 *** expand-file-name no longer treats `//' or `/~' specially. It used
13022 to delete all the text of a file name up through the first slash of
13023 any `//' or `/~' sequence. Now it passes them straight through.
13024
13025 substitute-in-file-name continues to treat those sequences specially,
13026 in the same way as before.
13027
13028 *** The variable `format-alist' is more general now.
13029 The FROM-FN and TO-FN in a format definition can now be strings
13030 which specify shell commands to use as filters to perform conversion.
13031
13032 *** The new function access-file tries to open a file, and signals an
13033 error if that fails. If the open succeeds, access-file does nothing
13034 else, and returns nil.
13035
13036 *** The function insert-directory now signals an error if the specified
13037 directory cannot be listed.
13038
13039 ** Changes in minibuffer input
13040
13041 *** The functions read-buffer, read-variable, read-command, read-string
13042 read-file-name, read-from-minibuffer and completing-read now take an
13043 additional argument which specifies the default value. If this
13044 argument is non-nil, it should be a string; that string is used in two
13045 ways:
13046
13047 It is returned if the user enters empty input.
13048 It is available through the history command M-n.
13049
13050 *** The functions read-string, read-from-minibuffer,
13051 read-no-blanks-input and completing-read now take an additional
13052 argument INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. If this is non-nil, then the
13053 minibuffer inherits the current input method and the setting of
13054 enable-multibyte-characters from the previously current buffer.
13055
13056 In an interactive spec, you can use M instead of s to read an
13057 argument in this way.
13058
13059 *** All minibuffer input functions discard text properties
13060 from the text you enter in the minibuffer, unless the variable
13061 minibuffer-allow-text-properties is non-nil.
13062
13063 ** Echo area features
13064
13065 *** Clearing the echo area now runs the normal hook
13066 echo-area-clear-hook. Note that the echo area can be used while the
13067 minibuffer is active; in that case, the minibuffer is still active
13068 after the echo area is cleared.
13069
13070 *** The function current-message returns the message currently displayed
13071 in the echo area, or nil if there is none.
13072
13073 ** Keyboard input features
13074
13075 *** tty-erase-char is a new variable that reports which character was
13076 set up as the terminal's erase character when time Emacs was started.
13077
13078 *** num-nonmacro-input-events is the total number of input events
13079 received so far from the terminal. It does not count those generated
13080 by keyboard macros.
13081
13082 ** Frame-related changes
13083
13084 *** make-frame runs the normal hook before-make-frame-hook just before
13085 creating a frame, and just after creating a frame it runs the abnormal
13086 hook after-make-frame-functions with the new frame as arg.
13087
13088 *** The new hook window-configuration-change-hook is now run every time
13089 the window configuration has changed. The frame whose configuration
13090 has changed is the selected frame when the hook is run.
13091
13092 *** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
13093 selected buffers, in its buffer-list frame parameter, so that the
13094 value of other-buffer is now based on the buffers recently displayed
13095 in the selected frame.
13096
13097 *** The value of the frame parameter vertical-scroll-bars
13098 is now `left', `right' or nil. A non-nil value specifies
13099 which side of the window to put the scroll bars on.
13100
13101 ** X Windows features
13102
13103 *** You can examine X resources for other applications by binding
13104 x-resource-class around a call to x-get-resource. The usual value of
13105 x-resource-class is "Emacs", which is the correct value for Emacs.
13106
13107 *** In menus, checkboxes and radio buttons now actually work.
13108 The menu displays the current status of the box or button.
13109
13110 *** The function x-list-fonts now takes an optional fourth argument
13111 MAXIMUM which sets a limit on how many matching fonts to return.
13112 A smaller value of MAXIMUM makes the function faster.
13113
13114 If the only question is whether *any* font matches the pattern,
13115 it is good to supply 1 for this argument.
13116
13117 ** Subprocess features
13118
13119 *** A reminder: it is no longer necessary for subprocess filter
13120 functions and sentinels to do save-match-data, because Emacs does this
13121 automatically.
13122
13123 *** The new function shell-command-to-string executes a shell command
13124 and returns the output from the command as a string.
13125
13126 *** The new function process-contact returns t for a child process,
13127 and (HOSTNAME SERVICE) for a net connection.
13128
13129 ** An error in running pre-command-hook or post-command-hook
13130 does clear the variable to nil. The documentation was wrong before.
13131
13132 ** In define-key-after, if AFTER is t, the new binding now always goes
13133 at the end of the keymap. If the keymap is a menu, this means it
13134 goes after the other menu items.
13135
13136 ** If you have a program that makes several changes in the same area
13137 of the buffer, you can use the macro combine-after-change-calls
13138 around that Lisp code to make it faster when after-change hooks
13139 are in use.
13140
13141 The macro arranges to call the after-change functions just once for a
13142 series of several changes--if that seems safe.
13143
13144 Don't alter the variables after-change-functions and
13145 after-change-function within the body of a combine-after-change-calls
13146 form.
13147
13148 ** If you define an abbrev (with define-abbrev) whose EXPANSION
13149 is not a string, then the abbrev does not expand in the usual sense,
13150 but its hook is still run.
13151
13152 ** Normally, the Lisp debugger is not used (even if you have enabled it)
13153 for errors that are handled by condition-case.
13154
13155 If you set debug-on-signal to a non-nil value, then the debugger is called
13156 regardless of whether there is a handler for the condition. This is
13157 useful for debugging problems that happen inside of a condition-case.
13158
13159 This mode of operation seems to be unreliable in other ways. Errors that
13160 are normal and ought to be handled, perhaps in timers or process
13161 filters, will instead invoke the debugger. So don't say you weren't
13162 warned.
13163
13164 ** The new variable ring-bell-function lets you specify your own
13165 way for Emacs to "ring the bell".
13166
13167 ** If run-at-time's TIME argument is t, the action is repeated at
13168 integral multiples of REPEAT from the epoch; this is useful for
13169 functions like display-time.
13170
13171 ** You can use the function locate-library to find the precise file
13172 name of a Lisp library. This isn't new, but wasn't documented before.
13173
13174 ** Commands for entering view mode have new optional arguments that
13175 can be used from Lisp. Low-level entrance to and exit from view mode
13176 is done by functions view-mode-enter and view-mode-exit.
13177
13178 ** batch-byte-compile-file now makes Emacs return a nonzero status code
13179 if there is an error in compilation.
13180
13181 ** pop-to-buffer, switch-to-buffer-other-window and
13182 switch-to-buffer-other-frame now accept an additional optional
13183 argument NORECORD, much like switch-to-buffer. If it is non-nil,
13184 they don't put the buffer at the front of the buffer list.
13185
13186 ** If your .emacs file leaves the *scratch* buffer non-empty,
13187 Emacs does not display the startup message, so as to avoid changing
13188 the *scratch* buffer.
13189
13190 ** The new function regexp-opt returns an efficient regexp to match a string.
13191 The arguments are STRINGS and (optionally) PAREN. This function can be used
13192 where regexp matching or searching is intensively used and speed is important,
13193 e.g., in Font Lock mode.
13194
13195 ** The variable buffer-display-count is local to each buffer,
13196 and is incremented each time the buffer is displayed in a window.
13197 It starts at 0 when the buffer is created.
13198
13199 ** The new function compose-mail starts composing a mail message
13200 using the user's chosen mail composition agent (specified with the
13201 variable mail-user-agent). It has variants compose-mail-other-window
13202 and compose-mail-other-frame.
13203
13204 ** The `user-full-name' function now takes an optional parameter which
13205 can either be a number (the UID) or a string (the login name). The
13206 full name of the specified user will be returned.
13207
13208 ** Lisp packages that load files of customizations, or any other sort
13209 of user profile, should obey the variable init-file-user in deciding
13210 where to find it. They should load the profile of the user name found
13211 in that variable. If init-file-user is nil, meaning that the -q
13212 option was used, then Lisp packages should not load the customization
13213 files at all.
13214
13215 ** format-time-string now allows you to specify the field width
13216 and type of padding. This works as in printf: you write the field
13217 width as digits in the middle of a %-construct. If you start
13218 the field width with 0, it means to pad with zeros.
13219
13220 For example, %S normally specifies the number of seconds since the
13221 minute; %03S means to pad this with zeros to 3 positions, %_3S to pad
13222 with spaces to 3 positions. Plain %3S pads with zeros, because that
13223 is how %S normally pads to two positions.
13224
13225 ** thing-at-point now supports a new kind of "thing": url.
13226
13227 ** imenu.el changes.
13228
13229 You can now specify a function to be run when selecting an
13230 item from menu created by imenu.
13231
13232 An example of using this feature: if we define imenu items for the
13233 #include directives in a C file, we can open the included file when we
13234 select one of those items.
13235 \f
13236 * For older news, see the file ONEWS
13237
13238 ----------------------------------------------------------------------
13239 Copyright information:
13240
13241 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
13242
13243 Permission is granted to anyone to make or distribute verbatim copies
13244 of this document as received, in any medium, provided that the
13245 copyright notice and this permission notice are preserved,
13246 thus giving the recipient permission to redistribute in turn.
13247
13248 Permission is granted to distribute modified versions
13249 of this document, or of portions of it,
13250 under the above conditions, provided also that they
13251 carry prominent notices stating who last changed them.
13252 \f
13253 Local variables:
13254 mode: outline
13255 paragraph-separate: "[ \f]*$"
13256 end:
13257
13258 arch-tag: 1aca9dfa-2ac4-4d14-bebf-0007cee12793